Você está na página 1de 374

Aspen Flare System Analyzer

Reference Manual

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Aspen Flare System Analyzer Version: 7.0


Copyright (c) 1981-2008 by Aspen Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. Aspen Flare System Analyzer, Aspen Flarenet, and the aspen leaf logo are trademarks or registered trademarks of Aspen Technology, Inc., Cambridge, MA. All other brand and product names are trademarks or registered trademarks of their respective companies. This document is intended as a guide to using AspenTech's software. This documentation contains AspenTech proprietary and confidential information and may not be disclosed, used, or copied without the prior consent of AspenTech or as set forth in the applicable license agreement. Users are solely responsible for the proper use of the software and the application of the results obtained. Although AspenTech has tested the software and reviewed the documentation, the sole warranty for the software may be found in the applicable license agreement between AspenTech and the user. ASPENTECH MAKES NO WARRANTY OR REPRESENTATION, EITHER EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED, WITH RESPECT TO THIS DOCUMENTATION, ITS QUALITY, PERFORMANCE, MERCHANTABILITY, OR FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. Aspen Technology, Inc. 200 Wheeler Road Burlington, MA 01803-5501 USA Phone: (781) 221-6400 Toll free: (888) 996-7001 Website http://www.aspentech.com

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Contents
1 Introduction .........................................................................................................2 About this document ...................................................................................... 2 Audience....................................................................................................... 2 Related Documentation ................................................................................... 2 Technical Support .......................................................................................... 3 2 Interface ..............................................................................................................2 Overview ...................................................................................................... 2 Terminology .................................................................................................. 3 Menu Bar ...................................................................................................... 5 Toolbar......................................................................................................... 5 Status Bar..................................................................................................... 7 Editing Data Views ......................................................................................... 8 Changing Column Width ........................................................................ 8 Changing Column Order ........................................................................ 9 Setting Preferences .......................................................................................10 General Tab........................................................................................10 Defaults Tab .......................................................................................12 Databases Tab ....................................................................................13 Reports Tab........................................................................................14 PFD Tab .............................................................................................15 Formatting Tab ...................................................................................16 Import/Export Tab...............................................................................17 Windows Menu .............................................................................................17 Help Menu....................................................................................................18 3 Creating and Saving Cases .................................................................................19 Creating a New Case .....................................................................................19 Opening an Existing Case ...............................................................................21 Saving a Case...............................................................................................22 4 Components .......................................................................................................23 Overview .....................................................................................................23 Selecting Components ...................................................................................24 Component Types ...............................................................................24 Component List...................................................................................24 Matching the Name String ....................................................................25 Removing Selected Components............................................................25 Adding/Editing Components............................................................................26 Add Hypothetical Component/Edit Component View .................................26 Identification Tab ................................................................................26

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 1 Introduction The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Editing Database Components...............................................................30 Estimating Unknown Properties .............................................................30 Organizing the Component List .......................................................................31 Sorting the Component List ..................................................................31 Move Single Component .......................................................................31 Swapping two components ...................................................................31 Changing the Components....................................................................31 Combining Components .......................................................................31 Binary Interaction Parameters.........................................................................32 5 Scenarios ...........................................................................................................34 Overview .....................................................................................................34 Scenario Manager .........................................................................................35 Adding/Editing Scenarios................................................................................36 General Tab........................................................................................36 Constraints Tab...................................................................................37 Sources Tab .......................................................................................38 Estimates Tab.....................................................................................38 Scenario Tools ..............................................................................................40 Adding Single Source Scenarios.............................................................40 6 Pipe Network......................................................................................................41 Overview .....................................................................................................41 Pipe Manager................................................................................................41 Ignoring/Restoring Pipes ................................................................................42 Connections Tab .................................................................................44 Dimensions Tab ..................................................................................45 Fittings Tab ........................................................................................47 Heat Transfer Tab ...............................................................................48 Methods Tab.......................................................................................50 Summary Tab .....................................................................................53 Multiple Editing ...................................................................................53 Pipe Class Editor .................................................................................54 7 Nodes .................................................................................................................55 Overview .....................................................................................................55 Node Manager ..............................................................................................55 Ignoring/Restoring Nodes...............................................................................56 Connection Nodes .........................................................................................57 Connector ..........................................................................................57 Flow Bleed .........................................................................................60 Horizontal Separator............................................................................62 Orifice Plate........................................................................................68 Tee ...................................................................................................72 Vertical Separator ...............................................................................76 Boundary Nodes ...........................................................................................81 Control Valve......................................................................................81 Relief Valve ........................................................................................90 Source Tools.......................................................................................97 Flare Tip ............................................................................................98

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

8 Calculations......................................................................................................103 Calculation Options .....................................................................................103 General Tab......................................................................................103 Scenarios Tab ...................................................................................106 Methods Tab.....................................................................................107 Warnings Tab ...................................................................................112 Initialization Tab ............................................................................... 116 Check Model .....................................................................................117 Starting the Calculations ..............................................................................118 Efficient Modeling Techniques ....................................................................... 119 Data Entry ....................................................................................... 120 Calculation Speed.............................................................................. 120 Sizing Calculations ............................................................................ 122 9 Databases ........................................................................................................123 Overview ................................................................................................... 123 Database Features ...................................................................................... 124 Selection Filter.................................................................................. 124 Maneuvering Through the Table .......................................................... 125 Printing............................................................................................125 Adding/Deleting Data......................................................................... 125 Setting The Password .................................................................................. 126 Pipe Schedule Database Editor ...................................................................... 126 Fittings Database Editor ............................................................................... 128 Component Database Editor ......................................................................... 129 Importing Component Data ................................................................ 129 10 Viewing Data and Results...............................................................................131 Overview ................................................................................................... 131 Components Data .......................................................................................131 Scenarios Data ...........................................................................................133 Pipes Data .................................................................................................133 Sources Data.............................................................................................. 134 Nodes Data ................................................................................................ 135 Messages ................................................................................................... 135 Problems Tab.................................................................................... 136 Data Echo Tab .................................................................................. 136 Solver Tab .......................................................................................137 Sizing Tab ........................................................................................ 137 Loops tab ......................................................................................... 138 Pressure/Flow Summary ..............................................................................139 Compositions..............................................................................................140 Physical Properties ...................................................................................... 140 Profile ....................................................................................................... 142 Flow Map ...................................................................................................143 Scenario Summary ...................................................................................... 145 Graph Control............................................................................................. 146 Control Tab ......................................................................................147 Axes Tab..........................................................................................149 ChartGroup Tab ................................................................................151 ChartStyles Tab ................................................................................154

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 1 Introduction The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Titles Tab .........................................................................................155 Legend Tab ...................................................................................... 157 ChartArea Tab ..................................................................................159 Plot Area Tab .................................................................................... 161 ChartLabel Tab .................................................................................163 View3D tab ...................................................................................... 165 Markers Tab ..................................................................................... 166 Trace Window............................................................................................. 167 11 PFD ................................................................................................................168 Overview ................................................................................................... 168 Object Inspection ........................................................................................ 170 PFD Toolbar ............................................................................................... 170 PFD Toolbar Icons ............................................................................. 171 Print Options .................................................................................... 173 Stream Label Options ........................................................................ 174 Viewports Option............................................................................... 174 Installing Objects ........................................................................................ 175 Connecting Objects ..................................................................................... 176 Manipulating the PFD ................................................................................... 176 Selecting PFD Objects ........................................................................ 176 Unselecting Objects ........................................................................... 177 Moving Objects .................................................................................177 Locating Objects on the PFD ............................................................... 177 Regenerate PFD ................................................................................ 178 Printing and Saving the PFD Image................................................................ 178 Changing the PFD View Options..................................................................... 179 12 Printing, Importing and Exporting.................................................................180 Overview ................................................................................................... 180 Printing .....................................................................................................182 FMT Files..........................................................................................183 Location-Specific Printing ................................................................... 185 Printer Setup ....................................................................................186 Import Wizard ............................................................................................ 186 Import Data Layouts.......................................................................... 186 Using the Import Wizard .................................................................... 187 Importing Source Data.................................................................................197 ASCII Text Files ................................................................................ 197 Importing HYSYS Source Data............................................................. 202 Export Wizard............................................................................................. 204 Export Data Layouts ....................................................................................204 Using the Export Wizard ..................................................................... 204 Import/Export Examples .............................................................................. 214 Default XML Import ........................................................................... 214 Access Database Import Using Select Criteria ........................................ 215 Import of Updated Source Data from Excel ........................................... 222 Export to Access Database For Flare System Analyzer 3.05 .................... 225 Export Pipe Data Table to Excel ........................................................... 226 Merge Cases Through Export/Import Wizards ........................................ 229

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

13 Automation ....................................................................................................231 Overview ................................................................................................... 231 Objects......................................................................................................232 Object Hierarchy ............................................................................... 232 The Flare System Analyzer Type Library ............................................... 233 Object Browser ................................................................................. 233 Automation Syntax ............................................................................ 236 Flare System Analyzer Object Reference......................................................... 242 Application .......................................................................................243 Bleed............................................................................................... 244 Bleeds ............................................................................................. 245 Component ...................................................................................... 245 Components ..................................................................................... 247 Connector ........................................................................................247 Connectors....................................................................................... 248 ControlValve..................................................................................... 248 ControlValves ................................................................................... 250 HorizontalSeparator........................................................................... 250 HorizontalSeparators ......................................................................... 251 Nodes..............................................................................................251 OrificePlate....................................................................................... 252 OrificePlates ..................................................................................... 252 Pipe ................................................................................................253 Pipes ............................................................................................... 256 ReliefValve ....................................................................................... 257 ReliefValves...................................................................................... 259 Scenario ..........................................................................................260 Scenarios ......................................................................................... 261 Solver ............................................................................................. 262 Tee ................................................................................................. 263 Tees ................................................................................................263 Tip ..................................................................................................264 Tips................................................................................................. 266 VerticalSeparator .............................................................................. 267 VerticalSeparators ............................................................................. 267 Example Automation In Visual Basic............................................................ 268 A Theoretical Basis.............................................................................................276 Pressure Drop............................................................................................. 276 Pipe Pressure Drop Method ................................................................. 276 Fittings Pressure Change Methods........................................................ 285 Vapor-Liquid Equilibrium .............................................................................. 295 Compressible Gas.............................................................................. 295 Vapor Pressure ................................................................................. 295 Soave Redlich Kwong......................................................................... 296 Peng Robinson .................................................................................. 297 Physical Properties ...................................................................................... 298 Vapor Density ...................................................................................298 Liquid Density................................................................................... 298 Vapor Viscosity ................................................................................. 299 Liquid Viscosity ................................................................................. 299 Thermal Conductivity .........................................................................302

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 1 Introduction The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Enthalpy .......................................................................................... 302 Noise ........................................................................................................306 B File Format ......................................................................................................308 Import/Export Details .................................................................................. 308 Process Descriptions .......................................................................... 308 Definition File Formats ....................................................................... 312 Recognized Objects and Items ............................................................ 319 FMT Files Format......................................................................................... 339 C References ......................................................................................................354 D Glossary of Terms ...........................................................................................356 Adiabatic Flow ............................................................................................ 356 Choked Flow............................................................................................... 356 Critical Pressure.......................................................................................... 356 Critical Temperature ....................................................................................356 Dongle ......................................................................................................356 Equivalent Length .......................................................................................357 Isothermal Flow .......................................................................................... 357 MABP ........................................................................................................357 Mach Number ............................................................................................. 357 Node ......................................................................................................... 357 Reduced Pressure........................................................................................ 357 Reduced Temperature.................................................................................. 358 Scenario ....................................................................................................358 Schedule....................................................................................................358 Security Device........................................................................................... 358 Source.......................................................................................................358 Static Pressure ...........................................................................................358 Tailpipe .....................................................................................................358 Total Pressure ............................................................................................358 Velocity Pressure ........................................................................................359 Index ..................................................................................................................360

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

1 Introduction

This section provides information on the following topics: About this Document Audience Related Documentation Technical Support

About this document


The guide provides a detailed description of all the features and functionality within Aspen Flare System Analyzer (previously called "Aspen Flarenet").

Audience
This guide is intended for process and process systems engineers.

Related Documentation
Title Flare System Analyzer Getting Started Guide Content Tutorials covering the basic use of Flare System Analyzer

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Technical Support
AspenTech customers with a valid license and software maintenance agreement can register to access the online AspenTech Support Center at: http://support.aspentech.com This Web support site allows you to: Access current product documentation Search for tech tips, solutions and frequently asked questions (FAQs) Search for and download application examples Search for and download service packs and product updates Submit and track technical issues Send suggestions Report product defects Review lists of known deficiencies and defects

Registered users can also subscribe to our Technical Support e-Bulletins. These e-Bulletins are used to alert users to important technical support information such as: Technical advisories Product updates and releases

Customer support is also available by phone, fax, and email. The most up-todate contact information is available at the AspenTech Support Center at http://support.aspentech.com.

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 1 Introduction The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

2 Interface

This section provides information on the following topics: Overview Menu bar Toolbar Status Bar Editing Data Views Setting Preferences Windows Menu Help Menu

Overview
Aspen Flare System Analyzer (previosly called "Aspen Flarenet") is designed to give you a great deal of flexibility in the way in which you enter, modify and view the data and results which comprise your model of a flare system. This chapter describes the various components of the Flare System Analyzer interface. If you need help with any particular task, the on-line help can give you step-by-step instructions.

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Terminology
The terminology used to describe these components throughout this manual is given in the following table.

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 2 Interface The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Term Button

Definition Most views contain buttons. They perform a specific action when selected (either by clicking the left mouse button or via the appropriate hot key combination). Icons are like buttons, they perform a specific action when selected (by clicking the left mouse button). Data items or settings that have an On/Off status are indicated by checkboxes. Selecting the checkbox will turn it on, selecting it again will turn it off. A window that contains a non-editable view of the model data and/or the calculation results. A modal window which allows you to enter the model data. You cannot access any other element in the model until this form has been closed. A drop-down list is indicated by a down arrow next to a field. If you click on this arrow, a list of available options for that field will be displayed. Data items that are alphanumeric in nature are entered into an input field. In general, the data that is entered in a field is checked for validity before you can continue. The Menu Bar displays all of the program functions, which can be accessed by clicking on the appropriate menu item. This is described in more detail later in the chapter. When a view is modal, you cannot access any other element in the simulation until you close it. Non-modal views do not restrict you in this manner. You can leave a non-modal view open and interact with any other view or menu item. This drop-down list shows the current scenario selected for the case. On clicking the down arrow, located beside the field, a list of all the scenarios will be displayed. This drop-down list shows the current calculation mode selected. Clicking the down arrow allows you to choose from Rating, Design or Debottleneck calculations. Whenever the information associated with a view or list exceeds what can be displayed, you may move through the view or list by using the scroll bar. Part of the Scroll Bar, allowing you to slide the list up or down, or left or right. This displays the current model status. For more information, see Status Bar. Indicates the Flare System Analyzer file currently loaded. The Toolbar contains a number of controls (icons/buttons) which give short-cut access to the most commonly used program functions. This is described in more detail later in this chapter. Whenever you pass the mouse pointer over one of the icons/buttons on the toolbar, a Tool Tip will be displayed. It will contain a summary description of the action that will take place if you click on that icon/button.

Icon Checkbox

Data View view

Drop-Down List

Input Field

Menu Bar

Modal/Non-Modal View

Scenario Selector

Calculation Mode Selector Scroll Bar

Scroll Button Status Bar Title Bar Toolbar

Tool Tip

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Menu Bar
The menu bar allows access to all the program functions via menus and submenus. The menu bar contains commands for each of the main areas of program functionality:
Menu File Description Work with files (New, Open, Save), supply Case Description, import/export files, print, adjust printer setup, and set preferences. Also a list of previously opened cases is displayed at the bottom of the menu. Access the Managers for Components, Scenarios, Pipes and Nodes. Access various Flare System Analyzer utilities. Set calculation options and start calculations. Manages the pipe schedule, pipe fittings, and pure component databases and allows you to set a password. Look at summaries of the Data, the Results, and the Process Flow Diagram (PFD). Arrange the display of windows (Cascade, Tile, etc.) Access on-line help and program version information.

Build Tools Calculations Database View Windows Help

As an alternative to using the mouse to click on the menu item, you can hit the alt key, then the underlined letter key. For example, to import source data from the HYSIM process simulator as shown above you would hit the alt key, and then while holding down the alt, press the f, I and h keys in sequence (abbreviated as alt f i h).

Toolbar
The Toolbar contains a set of controls which give short-cut access to some of the program functions without the need to navigate through a series of menus and/or sub-menus.
Name New Case Open Case Save Case Icon Description Starts a new case. Opens a case that has been previously saved to disk. Saves a case to disk using the current file name. If you want to save the case with a different file name, use the Save As command in the File menu. Opens a Print view, which allows you to print the entries from the Database, Data and Results groups. You can either print to a printer or to a file.

Print Data and Results

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 2 Interface The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Display Metric Units Display British Units Display PFD Display Pipe Data View Display Source Data View Display Node Data View Open Pressure/Flow Summary View Open Profile Graphical View Start Calculations Stop Calculations

Displays data and results in Metric units. Displays data and results in British units. Displays the Process Flow Diagram. Displays the Pipe data view. Displays the Source data view. Displays the Node data view. Displays the Pressure/Flow Summary view. Displays the graphical Profile view. Starts the Flare System Analyzer calculations. Stops the Flare System Analyzer calculations.

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

There are also two drop-down lists in the toolbar:


Name Calculation Mode Selector Description This drop-down list selects and displays the current calculation mode. The options are: Rating - It is used to check the existing flare system in a plant. This method calculates the pressure profile for the existing pipe network. Design - It is used to design a new flare system for the plant. During calculation it adjusts the diameters of all pipes until all the design constraints of MABP velocity, etc. have been met. These diameters can be smaller than the initially defined data. Debottleneck - It is used to determine which areas of the flare system must be increased in size due to either the uprating of the existing plant and hence flare loading, or the tie-in of new plant. This mode can only increase pipe diameters from their current size, it cannot reduce them. Scenario Selector This drop-down list show the current scenario selected for the case. On clicking the down arrow, located beside the field, a list of all the scenarios will be displayed.

The Tool Bar can be hidden by unchecking the Show Toolbar checkbox in the Preferences view.

Status Bar
Fig 1.3

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 2 Interface The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

The status bar displays the current status of the model. There are two general regions in the status bar: The calculation time can be reduced by hiding the status bar, which is particularly useful for large cases. The first region displays the program status - If Edit is displayed, you can make changes to your model. After calculations, this field will display Done. The second region displays important information during calculations, such as the iteration error and the current pipe being solved.

Note: The Status Bar can be hidden by unchecking the Show Status Bar checkbox in the Preferences view.

Editing Data Views


You can change the position and width of some of the columns in each of the data views such as the Pressure/Flow Summary view.

Changing Column Width


1. To change the width of a column, move the mouse pointer until it is over the vertical column separator line to the right of the column that you want to resize (e.g. Flowrate). The mouse pointer will change to a doubleheaded arrow. Fig 1.4

2. Click and hold down the primary mouse button, then drag the separator line to the new position. 3. The column width set here remains in effect for the duration of the current session and is saved when you exit Flare System Analyzer.

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Changing Column Order


1. To reposition columns, first select the columns by positioning the mouse pointer in the column heading(s) (you will see a down arrow), then clicking. The column heading will now be shaded. Fig 1.5

2. Now click anywhere in the shaded region and hold down the primary mouse button. The move column cursor will be shown, and there will be its now two colored arrows either side of the header which contains the cursor. While holding down the mouse button, drag the column(s) to their new position. The two colored arrows either side of the header will move as you drag the column(s) and indicate where the selected column(s) will be transferred. In this case, the Mass Flowrate and the Molar Flowrate columns will be positioned between the Noise and the Source Back Pressure columns. Fig 1.6

3. Release the mouse button. The selected column(s) will remain in their new location within the data view. Note: You can highlight multiple columns by clicking and dragging the mouse over the adjacent columns you want to select. Alternatively, you could hold the SHIFT key and click on the additional adjacent columns you want to select.

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 2 Interface The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Fig 1.7

4. The change in column order remains in effect for the duration of the current session and is saved when you exit Flare System Analyzer.

Setting Preferences
The Preferences view allows you to specify default information for the simulation case. 1. To access the Preferences view, select Preferences from the File menu (alt f p). The Preferences view will be displayed. The information on the Preferences view is divided into different tabs: General, Defaults, Databases, Reports, Import/Export and PFD tab.

General Tab
Fig 1.8

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

The following fields are available on this tab:


Options Show Status Bar Description Select this checkbox to display the Status bar. Unchecking this option to hide the Status Bar can speed up calculations in large cases. Activate this checkbox to display the Tool bar. Select this checkbox to activate a periodically backup of the current case. File is saved back to the directory as Backup.fnw. This field is only accessed if the Timed Backup checkbox is selected. The default value is 10 minutes. If checked, the data files will be saved in a compressed format that can reduce the file size of the saved cases by a factor of up to 50. On activating this checkbox, the editor view will be displayed as the nodes/pipes are added to the PFD. Specify the units set to be used for the simulation. The available unit sets are Metric and British. Specify the directory for temporary files, which should be writeable. Activate the Auto Flash Source Nodes checkbox to automatically flash the source fluid when it is edited. Otherwise sources are flashed during the calculation. Select this checkbox to display the total pressure, which is a sum of the static pressure and the velocity pressure, instead of the static pressure. Select this checkbox to display properties that are velocity dependant based upon the velocities derived from rated flow rather than from the nominal flow. Phase properties can be saved by activating this checkbox. The disk space/memory requirements are significantly effected by this option, especially for large cases. It is advised to select this option only if you have a high specification PC. Selecting this option will hide the results for pipes that have not been calculated in the last run of the model. This prevents cluttering of the results view with uncalculated values from sections of the flare network that might have been ignored. This field specifies the size in bytes of the text buffer displayed by the Trace window. Larger values will allow more text to be stored. The default value of 32000 is adequate for most cases.

Show Tool Bar Timed Backup

Backup Frequency Compress Files

Edit Objects On Add Units Work Directory Auto Flash Source Nodes

Display Total Pressure

Display Velocity Properties Used By Pressure Drop Calculation Save Phase Properties

Hide Results For Uncalculated Pipes

Trace Buffer Size

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 2 Interface The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

11

Defaults Tab
The default data values given on the Default tab applies only to new instances of pipe class of pipes and nodes. The value for each instance may be freely edited at any stage. Fig 1.9

The options available on this tab are:


Options Composition Basis Description Select composition basis for each of the relief sources: Molecular Weight - The molecular weight of the fluid is given. Mole fractions are estimated by Flare System Analyzer, based upon the list of installed components. Mole/Mass Fractions - A full component-by-component composition must be given for the fluid.

CS = Carbon Steel SS = Stainless Steel


Tee Type Select the tee type to be set as a default for all the tees in the model. The available tee types are 90o, 60o, 45o and 30o tee. This is the default material to be used in new pipes. The two materials available for selection are Carbon Steel and Stainless Steel. Activate this checkbox to use the pipe class to restrict the available uses for pipes. Set the material roughness to be used in calculation. The default CS Roughness is 0.04572 mm and SS Roughness is 0.02540 mm.

Pipe Material

Use Pipe Class CS/SS Roughness

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Databases Tab
The databases for the Components, Pipe Schedules and Pipe Fittings can be specified here. Fig 1.10

If the Save Database Directories With Model check box in checked then these locations are stored with the model. This is useful if the databases have been modified for use with specific models.

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 2 Interface The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

13

Reports Tab
You can specify the directories in which to save the report definition for each of the entries in the Report list Fig 1.11

If the Save Report Format Paths With Model check box in checked then these locations are stored with the model. This is useful if the report formats have been modified for use with specific models.

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

PFD Tab
Fig 1.12

The options available on this tab are:


Option Use Wire Frame Icons Description When selected, pipe and node icons in the PFD are drawn as wireframe outlines rather than shaded pictures. Selecting this option can speed the drawing of the PFD for large models. If the PFD is already open it must be closed and reopened to see the change. Allows selection of the font to be used for pipe and node labels in the PFD. Allows definition of the size of the font used for pipe and node labels in the PFD. The factor to be used by Flare System Analyzer to scale the PFD when importing models created in earlier versions of Flare System Analyzer.

Font Name Font Size 2.5 x Scale factor

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 2 Interface The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

15

Formatting Tab
Fig 1.13

The options available on this tab are:


Option Data Formatting Group Display Using Significant Figures Sig. Figures Printing Group Use Header Use Footer Binding margin Tiled Scale Factor Activate this check box to add a header at the top of each printed page. Activate this check box to add a footer at the Bottom of each printed page. A margin of this size is placed along the long side of printouts to allow for binding. For tiled printouts of the PFD view, the diagram will be scaled by this factor. Larger values will tile the printout over more pages. Activate this check box to display all results to a number of significant figures rather than to a fixed number of decimal places. The number of significant figures used for the display of results. Description

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Import/Export Tab
You can specify the name and location of the Import and Export definition files to be used when transferring information between Flare System Analyzer and Access, Excel or XML files. Entries allow specification of the default definition files and the base definition files to be used for creating new customized import export definition files. Fig 1.14

If the Save Import/Export Paths With Model check box in checked then these locations are stored with the model. This is useful if the definition files have been modified for use with specific models.

Windows Menu
This is a general Windows application function. The options are:
Option Cascade Tile Horizontally Tile Vertically Arrange Icons Description Cascade all currently-open windows. Tile all currently-open windows horizontally. Tile all currently-open windows vertically. Organize icons at the bottom of the screen.

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 2 Interface The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

17

Open All Close All

Open all the windows, which can be accessed through the View menu bar Close all windows.

Help Menu
The options under the Help menu are:
Option Contents Using Help Technical Support About Description Displays the Flare System Analyzer Help contents. Displays the general Windows Help on using Help. Displays a list of world wide Technical Support offices. The About option displays the About Flare System Analyzer view.

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

3 Creating and Saving Cases

This section provides information on the following topics: Creating a New Case Opening an Existing Case Saving a Case

Creating a New Case


When you start Flare System Analyzer, a new case is automatically created. When you start Flare System Analyzer, the Desktop area will be blank. Before you can work, you must either create a new case, or retrieve a saved case. 1. To start a new case, do one of the following: Select New from the File menu in the menu bar. Use the hot key combination alt f n. Click on the New Case icon in the toolbar.

The Case Description view will be displayed. Fig 2.1

www.cadfamily.com Saving Cases EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 3 Creating and The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

19

Enter appropriate data into the User Name, Job Code, Project, and Description fields and then click the OK button. Note: The case description can be modified later by selecting Description from the File menu. 2. After you enter the case description information, the Component Manager view appears as shown in the figure below: Fig 2.2

3. Select the desired components as described in Components and click OK. You can now set up the simulation.

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Opening an Existing Case


When you open a case that has previously been stored on disk, all data from the current case is cleared; however, the arrangement of any windows that are already open is maintained. 1 To open an existing case, do one of the following:
o o o

Select Open from the File menu. Use the hot key combination alt f o. Click the Open Case icon on the toolbar.

2 3

The File Open view appears. Select the file to be opened by doing one of the following:
o o

Type the file name (including exact directory path if necessary) into the Filename field and click the OK button. Search the directory using the Look in drop-down menu and upon finding the file, click once on the file name to highlight it and then click the OK button. Search the directory using the Look in drop-down menu and upon finding the file, double click the file name.

It is also possible to open a recently used file by selecting it from the list at the bottom of the File menu.

www.cadfamily.com Saving Cases EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 3 Creating and The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

21

Saving a Case
Cases may either be saved using the current case name or under a new name. 1 2 3 4 To save a case using the current file name, do one of the following: Select Save from the File menu. Use the hot key combination alt f s. Click on the Save Case icon on the toolbar. To save a case using a new name, do one of the following: Select Save As from the File menu. Use the hot key combination alt f a. When youre saving the case for the first time or with a new name, the Save Flare System Analyzer Model view will appears. Select the file to be saved by directly entering it, or selecting the appropriate file from the list in the view which contains all the files and folders. The Save in drop-down list can be used to change the directory and/or drive. Clear the Filename field, type in the file name you want to give to the case in and click on the OK button.

Note: You do not have to include the .fnw extension. Flare System Analyzer will add it on automatically. You will be asked to confirm that you want to overwrite if an existing file is named.

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

4 Components

This section provides information on the following topics: Overview Selecting Components Adding/Editing Components Organizing the Component List Binary Interaction Parameters

Overview
Data for all components that will be used in the simulation must be selected before the sources are defined. These components may be taken from the standard component library, or you may define your own components, known as hypothetical components. You may select components from the Component Manager, which can be accessed by selecting Components from the Build menu. The Component Manager view will be displayed:

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 4 Components The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

23

Fig 3.1

This view displays all of the Database and Selected components, and provides various tools which you can use to add and edit database and hypothetical components.

Selecting Components
Component Types
You may filter the list of available components to include only those belonging to a specific family. The All and None buttons turn all of the filters on and off, respectively, while the Invert button toggles the status of each checkbox individually. As an example, if only the Hydrocarbons (HC) and Misc options were on, and you pressed the Invert button, then these two options would be turned off, and the remaining options would be turned on.

Component List
Components can be chosen from the Database list, and added to the Selected group, using one of the following methods: Arrow Keys - The < > or < > arrow keys move the highlight up one component, and the < > or < > arrow keys move the highlight down one component. PageUp/PageDown - Use these keyboard keys to advance an entire page forward or backward.

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Home/End - The <Home> key moves to the start of the list and the <End> key moves to the end of the list. Scroll Bar - With the mouse, use the scroll bar to move up and down through the list.

You can highlight multiple components to add to the Selected list using the normal windows shift-click and ctrl-click options in the Database list. Enter a character - When you type a letter or number, you will move to the next component in the list which starts with that character. If you repeatedly enter the same character, you will cycle through all of the components which start with that character.
SHIFT

Note: You can select multiple components by using the you select components.

or

CTRL

keys as

To add a component, you must first highlight it (by moving through the list until that component is highlighted), then transfer it by double-clicking on it or clicking the Add button.

Matching the Name String


The interpretation of your input is limited to the Component Types which are checked. Another way to add components is through the Selection Filter feature. The Selection Filter cell accepts keyboard input, and is used to locate the component(s) in the current list that best matches your input. You may use wildcard characters as follows: ? - Represents a single character. * - Represents a group of characters of undefined length. Any filter string has an implied '*' character at the end.

Some examples are shown here: As you are typing into the Selection Filter cell, the component list is updated, matching what you have presently typed. You may not have to enter the complete name or formula before it appears in the component list.
Filter methan *anol ?-propanol *ane Result methanol, methane, etc. methanol, ethanol, propanol, etc. 1-propanol, 2-propanol methane, ethane, propane, i-butane, etc.

Removing Selected Components


You can remove any component from the Selected Component list: You can select multiple components using shift-click and ctrl-click options. 1 Highlight the component(s) you want to delete.

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 4 Components The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

25

Click either the Delete button on the Component Manager view, or press the delete key.

Once the component(s) are removed from the list, any source compositions that used this component will be normalized.

Adding/Editing Components
To create a new component (hypothetical), click the Hypothetical button. Hypothetical components are set up in the same manner as database components. Previously defined hypothetical components can be changed by selecting them in the Selected Component list and then clicking the Edit button.

Add Hypothetical Component/Edit Component View


Upon clicking either the Hypothetical button or the Edit button the Component Editor view opens up.

Identification Tab
The minimum data requirements for creating a component are specified here: Fig 3.2

Component Types: Hydrocarbon Miscellaneous Amine Alcohol Ketone


3

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Aldehyde Ester Carboxylic Acid Halogen Nitrile Phenol Ether The following fields are available on this tab:
Input Field Name Type Description An alphanumeric name for the component (e.g. - Hypo -1). Up to 15 characters are accepted. The type of component (or family) can be selected from the dropdown menu provided. There is a wide selection of families to choose from, which allows better estimation methods to be chosen for that component. The ID number is provided automatically for new components and cannot be edited. The molecular weight of the component. Valid values are between 2 and 500. The normal boiling point of the component. The density of the component as liquid at 1 atm and 60 F. The Watson characterization factor.

ID Mol. Wt. NBP Std. Density Watson K

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 4 Components The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

27

Critical Tab
Critical properties are specified here. Fig 3.3

The following fields are available on this tab:


Input Field Critical Pressure Description The critical pressure of the component. If the component represents more than a single real component, the pseudo critical pressure should be used. Valid values are between 0.01 bar abs and 500 bar abs. The critical temperature of the component. If the component represents more than a single real component, the pseudo critical temperature should be used. Valid values are between 5 K and 1500 K. The critical volume of the component. If the component represents more than a single real component, the pseudo critical volume should be used. Valid values are between 0.001 m3/kg and 10 m3/kg. The acentric factor of the component. Valid values are between -1 and 10. The Soave-Redlich-Kwong acentric factor of the component (also called the COSTALD Acentricity).

Critical Temp.

Critical Volume

Acentric Factor Acentric Factor (SRK)

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Other Tab
Coefficients for the polynomial equations for the prediction of Ideal Gas thermodynamic properties and parameters for the viscosity calculations are specified here: Fig 3.4

The following fields are available on this tab:


Input Field Hi A, Hi B, Hi C, Hi D, Hi E, and Hi F Description The coefficients for the ideal gas specific enthalpy equation:

H = A + BT + C T 2 + DT 3 + ET 4 + F T 5 i
Entropy Coef. Viscosity A and Viscosity B The coefficient for the entropy equation. Viscosity coefficients used in the NBS Method (Ely and Hanley, 1983).

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 4 Components The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

29

Editing Database Components


If you want to change the data for one of the database components, e.g. Methane, you will find that opening the Component Edit view for this component will display read only values that cannot be changed. Fig 3.5

In order to update the data for a database component it must first be changed to a hypothetical component. At the very minimum, you need to specify the Molecular Weight. However, it is a good practice to specify at least two of the following properties: Molecular Weight Normal Boiling Point Standard Density

This is done by clicking the Hypothetical button on the Component Editor view. Flare System Analyzer will convert the displayed database component to a hypothetical as indicated by the adding of a * character to the name and by changing the component ID to -1. The data values can then be updated.

Estimating Unknown Properties


If any of the above data is unknown, then click Estimate to fill-in the unknown properties. Supply as many properties as are known, so that the estimation can be as accurate as possible.

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Organizing the Component List


The Selected Components list can be organized in the following different ways.

Sorting the Component List


The Sort button allows the whole component list to be sorted by the criteria selected from the following pop up list:
Sorting Option Name Molecular Weight Normal Boiling Point (NBP) Group Description Arranged components alphabetically in descending order. Components are listed according to increasing molecular weight. Select this to arrange components in increasing NBP value. Group the components by type.

Move Single Component


A single component may be moved up and down the list by clicking on it in the list of selected components and then clicking either the up or down arrow buttons.

Swapping two components


In the Component Manager view, select the first component in the Selected Component list by clicking on it. Then select the second component either using the SHIFT key if the two are in sequence or pressing the ctrl key and then clicking on the component. Swap the two components by clicking the Swap button.

Changing the Components


You can switch the components in the Selected Component list with the ones in the Database list while maintaining the source mole fractions. In the Component Manager view, select the components in both the Selected Components and the Database lists. Click the Change button to switch the two components.

Combining Components
Multiple components can be combined and represented by a single component to reduce the number of components in the model.

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 4 Components The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

31

This is done by selecting the components you want to combine by controlclicking them in the Selected Components list and then clicking the Combine button. A pop-up view will then ask you to select which of these combined components should be used as the target component to combine your selected components into. Once the target component has been selected the combined components will update each source in the model by summing the composition of all of the combined components and assigning it to the target component. Reducing the number of components in this way is useful since it can greatly speed the calculations. This is especially true where a model contains sources defined with a long list of hypothetical components. For example consider a model containing the hypothetical components BP200, BP225, BP250, BP275, BP300 boiling at 200 C, 225 C, 250 C, 275 C and 300 C respectively. Since these components are likely to stay in the liquid phase throughout the flare system, they may be combined into a single component, BP250 without significant loss of accuracy. As another example, in a purely gas phase flare system it is possible to combine isomers such as iButane and n-Butane into a single component n-Butane without compromising results.

Binary Interaction Parameters


Binary Interaction Coefficients, often known as KIJs are factors that are used in equations of state to better fit the interaction between pairs of components and hence improve the accuracy of VLE calculations. Flare System Analyzer allows the user to specify binary interaction parameters for the Peng Robinson and Soave Redlich Kwong VLE methods or to estimate them through the Binary Coeffs tab of the Component Manager view as shown here. Fig 3.6

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

To define binary interaction coefficients first select either the Peng Robinson or Soave Redlich Kwong VLE method using the drop-down list at the top of the view. Note: Binary interaction coefficients are not used by either the Ideal Gas or Lee Kesler VLE methods at present. The view will show the binary interaction coefficient matrix for the selected VLE method. Individual binary interaction parameters are set by selecting the required entry in the matrix and typing in the new value. Note: The matrix is symmetrical i.e. KJI is the same value as KJI and updating an entry will also update the corresponding entry in the table. E.g. updating the entry in the Methane column, Propane row will also update the entry in the Propane column, Methane row. Individual binary interaction parameters may be estimated by selecting the required entry in the matrix and clicking the Estimate button. The estimation method is based on the components boiling point, standard liquid density and critical volume. It is possible to set several binary interaction parameters at the same time either by clicking the Select All button to select the whole matrix or by control-clicking the two corners of a rectangular area in the matrix. The selected entries can then be estimated by clicking the Estimate button or set to 0.0 by clicking the Zero HC-HC button. The Reset All button causes all interaction parameters to be set to their default values. Generally this is 0.0 for hydrocarbon components with non zero values being supplied only for common polar components. If the Auto Estimate check box is checked then the interaction parameters for new components are automatically estimated as they are added to the model.

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 4 Components The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

33

5 Scenarios

This section provides information on the following topics: Overview Scenario Manager Adding/Editing Scenarios Scenario Tools

Overview
A scenario defines a set of source conditions (flows, compositions, pressures and temperatures) for the entire network. The design of a typical flare header system will be comprised of many scenarios for each of which the header system must have adequate hydraulic capacity. Typical scenarios might correspond to: Plantwide power failure. Plantwide cooling medium or instrument air failure. Localized control valve failure. Localized fire or Depressurization.

The scenario management features within Flare System Analyzer allow you to simultaneously design and rate the header system for all of the possible relief scenarios. Note: Although the major relief scenarios will normally constrain the size of the main headers, care should be taken in the evaluation of velocities in the individual relief valve tailpipes and sub headers. When looking at relief valves which might operate alone, lower back pressures in the main headers may lead to localized high velocities and consequently choked flow in the tail pipes. As well as having different source conditions, each scenario can have unique design limitations that will be used either to size the pipes or to highlight problems when an existing flare system is being rated. For example, a Mach number limit of 0.30 might be applied for normal flaring compared to a Mach number limit of 0.50 or greater at the peak flows encountered during plant blowdown.

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Scenario Manager
Scenarios can also be selected by selecting the scenario in the Scenario selector on the tool bar. Scenarios are managed via the Scenario Manager view. This view has buttons that allow you to add, edit or delete scenarios as well as to select the current scenario for which scenario specific data is displayed. All cases have at least one scenario. 1. To access the Scenario Manager view, select Scenarios from the Build menu. The Scenario Manager view will be displayed. Fig 4.1

The Scenario Manager view displays all Scenarios in the case, and indicates the Current Scenario. Several buttons are available:
Button Add Edit Delete Sort Up and Down Arrow Swap Current OK Description Adds a new scenario. Edits the highlighted scenario. Removes the currently highlighted scenario. There must always be at least one scenario in the case. Arrange the scenario list alphabetically in descending order. Move the highlighted scenario up and down the Scenario list. Swap the two selected scenarios in the list. To make a scenario the current one, highlight the appropriate scenario, and then click on the Current button. Closes the Scenario Manager view.

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 5 Scenarios The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

35

Adding/Editing Scenarios
Flare System Analyzer has no pre-programmed limits on the number of scenarios which can be defined within a single case. To add a scenario, click the Add button on the Scenario Manager view. If there is already a scenario present in the Scenario list, clicking the Add button will show a Clone Scenario Form view. You can select an existing scenario from the list to be used to initialize the flows, compositions, pressures and temperatures of all the sources in the new scenario. The Next button allows you to continue adding scenarios without returning to the Scenario Manager. To edit a scenario, highlight it, and then click the Edit button. For adding and editing a scenario, the views are similar except for the Next button on the Scenario Editor view for adding a scenario.

General Tab
You may provide the following information on the General tab: Fig 4.2

Data Name System Back Pressure

Description An alphanumeric description of the scenario (e.g. Power Failure). Up to 40 characters are accepted. The system back pressure at the flare tip exit. This will normally be atmospheric pressure, but can be set to represent system design conditions at the exit point. If left empty, the value on the Calculation Options Editor view will be used. The minimum value is 0.01 bar abs.

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Constraints Tab
This tab requires the following information for both headers and tailpipes. Fig 4.3

Tailpipes are indicated by the Tailpipe field on the Connections tab of the Pipe Editor view. You may provide different design information (Mach Number, Noise at 1 m, Vapor Velocity, Liquid Velocity) for the Headers and Tailpipes. Any field may be left empty, in which case they will be ignored.
Data Mach Number Vapor Velocity Liquid Velocity Rho V2 Noise Description The maximum allowable Mach number for all pipe segments. Calculated values that exceed this number will be highlighted in the results. The maximum allowable vapor velocity. Calculated velocities that exceed this value will be indicated in the results. The maximum allowable liquid velocity. Calculated velocities that exceed this value will be indicated in the results. It is the density times the velocity square. This value is normally used as a limiting factor to prevent erosion. The maximum allowable sound pressure level at a distance of 1 meter for all pipe segments. This is an average value over the length of the pipe. Calculated values that exceed this specification will be highlighted in the results.

Note: Whilst rating the network you may define a Mach number constraint of 1.00, in order to highlight only choked flow conditions. This is not recommended for design calculations where a more reasonable value such as 0.5 or 0.7 will lead to a more rapid solution towards the maximum allowable back pressure constraints.

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 5 Scenarios The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

37

Sources Tab
If a source is ignored, the MABP constraint is ignored by sizing calculations. When you select the Sources tab, you will see a view similar to the one shown in Figure 4.4. All sources are displayed on this tab. Note: If you are setting up a new case, the Sources tab will not show any sources. Fig 4.4

This tab is useful in that you can easily toggle whether or not individual sources are to be included in the current scenario, without having to either unnecessarily delete sources or set the flow of a source to zero.

Estimates Tab
The Estimates tab allows some control over the selection and initialization of flowrates for pipes which are to be used as tears in the solution of looped systems. The use to which each field is put is dependant upon the Structure Analyzer setting on the Solver tab of the Calculation Options Editor view. The checkboxes in the No Tear column of the table allow you to prevent pipes from being used as tears - select the checkbox to prevent a pipe from being used as a tear or clear it to allow it. This setting has no effect if the Simultaneous structural analyzer is used. When the Convergent structural analyzer is used, the Molar Flow column recommends a tear location and initial value for the flow at the tear location.

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

If the structural analyzer does find that the pipe may be a valid tear location then this value is ignored. When the Simultaneous structural analyzer is used, the Molar Flow column is used to seed the analyzer. This value will always impact the initialization as long as the structural analysis succeeds but the pipe will not necessarily be selected as a tear pipe. In the event that the structural analysis fails with any Molar Flow estimates then the model will be initialized by the default values. Fig 4.5

Since the Simultaneous structural analyzer generally offers better performance than the Convergent analyzer it will rarely be necessary to specify information on the Estimates tab other than for the purpose of improving the speed of convergence of the model. In the event that a model proves problematic to converge, a number of additional columns are available to tune the convergence algorithms. These may be exposed by stretching the view horizontally.

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 5 Scenarios The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

39

Fig 4.6

The Max. Step column defines the maximum change to the flow in a tear pipe over a single iteration whilst the Max. Flow and Min. Flow columns constrain the flow in a tear pipe. Not all these values are used by all the Loop Solver algorithms.
Max. Step Newton-Raphson Brogden Force Convergent Levenberg-Marquardt Conjugate Gradient Minimization Quasi-Newton Minimization 3 3 3 3 Max. Flow 3 3 Min. Flow 3 3

Scenario Tools
The complete analysis of a flare system should ideally include analysis of the system for the scenarios in which each source relieves on its own. For a large network with many sources, it can become tedious to define each of these scenarios. These can automatically be added to your model as follows.

Adding Single Source Scenarios


Select Add Single Source Scenarios from the Tools menu or use the hot key combination alt t n. This will analyze your model and add a scenario for each source that has a non-zero flow rate defined in at least one scenario. Source data will be copied from the scenario in which it has the highest flow rate. Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

6 Pipe Network

This section provides information on the following topics: Overview Pipe Manager Ignoring/Restoring Pipes Multiple Editing

Overview
The pipe network comprises a series of interconnected pipes. These pipes can be added, edited and deleted from the Pipe Manager.

Pipe Manager
To access the Pipe Manager, select Pipes from the Build menu. Fig 5.1

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 6 Pipe Network The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

41

The following buttons are available:


Button Add Edit Delete Sort Up and Down Arrow Swap OK Description Adds a new pipe. This new pipe will be named with a number depending upon the number of pipes already added. Allows you to edit the currently highlighted pipe. Allows you to remove the currently highlighted pipe. Sort the pipes list alphabetically (in descending order) either by name or location. Move the highlighted pipes up and down the list.

Swap the two selected pipes in the list. Closes the view.

Ignoring/Restoring Pipes
When you ignore a single pipe, all upstream pipes are automatically ignored. You can ignore single or multiple pipes within the model. When you ignore a single pipe, all upstream nodes are automatically ignored. This enables you to do what if type calculations, where part of the network can be excluded from the calculation without the need for deletion and reinstallation of the appropriate nodes. To ignore a pipe: 1 2 Open the pipe editor view of the pipe that you want to ignore. On the Connections tab, activate the Ignore checkbox.

Fig 5.2

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

To restore a pipe that has previously been ignored: 1 2 Open the pipe editor view of the pipe that you want to restore. On the Connections tab, deactivate the Ignore checkbox.

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 6 Pipe Network The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

43

Connections Tab
The name of the pipe segment and connectivity information is specified here. Fig 5.3

The following fields are available on this tab:


Input Data Name Location Description An alphanumeric description of the pipe segment. Up to 30 characters are accepted. An alphanumeric description of the location within the plant for the segment. This is a useful parameter for grouping pipes together via the Sort command. This is the name of the node upstream of the pipe. The drop-down list allows you to select from a list of existing unconnected nodes in the model. Alternatively the name of a new node can be entered. If this is done you will be asked to specify the type of node through a pop-up list when you move to the next entry. This is the name of the node upstream of the pipe. The drop-down list allows you to select from a list of existing unconnected nodes in the model. Alternatively the name of a new node can be entered. If this is done you will be asked to specify the type of node through a pop-up list when you move to the next entry. This drop-down list allows you to select whether the pipe should be treated as a tailpipe. If set to Yes and the Rated Flow for Tailpipes calculation option is selected in the Calculation Options view, the pressure drop for this pipe will be calculated using the rated flow in place of the relieving flow rate. This checkbox may be selected to remove the pipe from calculations temporarily. When selected the pipe and all upstream nodes and pipes will be ignored during calculations.

Upstream Node

Downstream Node

Tailpipe

Ignore

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

You have the option of modeling a pipe segment as a main header or a tailpipe. The ability to classify a pipe as either a tailpipe or a header allows us to perform calculations in which the pressure drop for tailpipes is determined by the rated flow and that for headers is determined by the nominal flow. This is in accordance with API-RP-521. In the Scenario Editor view, you can set design limits for the Mach Number, Vapor and Liquid Velocities, Rho V2 and Noise separately for the main headers and the tailpipes.

Dimensions Tab
The physical dimensions and characteristics of the pipe segment are specified here. Fig 5.4

The following fields are available on this tab:


Input Data Length Description The physical length of the pipe segment. This length is used in association with the fittings loss coefficients to calculate the equivalent length of the pipe. If you have equivalent length data for your network, enter this data here as the sum of the actual length plus the equivalent length of the fittings and enter zero for the fittings loss coefficients. A positive elevation indicates that the outlet is higher than the inlet.

Elevation Change

Schedule Numbers: Carbon Steel: 10, 20, 30, 40, 60, 80, 100, 120, 140, 160, STD, XS, XXS

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 6 Pipe Network The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

45

Stainless Steel: 5S, 10S, 40S, 80S


Material Roughness The pipe material, either Carbon Steel or Stainless Steel. The surface roughness of the pipe segment. Whenever a material is selected, the absolute roughness is initialized to the default value for the material as defined on the Preferences view. Valid values are between 0.00001 inches and 0.1 inches. The thermal conductivity of the pipe wall. This is used by the heat transfer calculations when these are enabled. The nominal pipe diameter used to describe the pipe size. For pipes with a nominal diameter of 14 inches or more, this will be the same as the outside diameter of the pipe. If a pipe schedule other than "-" is selected, you will be able to select a nominal pipe diameter from the pipe databases. It will not be necessary to specify the internal diameter or the wall thickness for the pipe. If you select "-" you will be unable to select a nominal pipe diameter from the pipe databases and you will then have to specify both the internal diameter and wall thickness for the pipe. Internal Diameter Wall Thickness Pipe Class and Sizeable dropdown list The pipe diameter used for the pressure drop calculations. The thickness of the pipe wall. Valid values are any positive number or zero. If you want the pipe segment to be resized by sizing calculations, the Sizeable option should be set to Yes. You might set the Sizeable option to No when debottlenecking an existing plant containing sections of the flare network that would be difficult to change. Setting sizeable to No for these pipes would prevent sizing calculations from changing their size. Set the Use Pipe Class option to Yes to restrict the pipe sizes to those defined by the Pipe Class tool.

Thermal Conductivity Nominal Diameter Schedule Number

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Fittings Tab
A list of pipe fittings may be added to the pipe segment. These fittings will be modeled as an additional equivalent length applied linearly over the physical length of the pipe segment. Fig 5.5

The following fields are available on this tab:


Input Data Length Multiplier Description The length of the pipe is multiplied by this value to determine the equivalent length used for the pressure drop calculation. If left blank then the value on the Calculation Options Editor is used. This option is useful for making an allowance for bends and other fittings if these are not known. The fittings "K" factor is calculated from the following equation in which Ft is the friction factor for fully developed turbulent flow: K = A + BFt Valid values are any positive number or 0. External HTC This is the outside heat transfer coefficient.

Fittings Loss

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 6 Pipe Network The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

47

From the Database Fitting list, select the appropriate type of fitting, and then click the Add button to move the selection to the Selected Fitting list. You can select as many fittings as required. The final fitting loss equation, which will be a sum of all the selected fittings, will appear in a display field underneath the Selected Fitting list. Click Link to transfer the coefficients for this equation into the Fittings Loss field, while maintaining the list of fittings. Click Paste to transfer the coefficients for the fitting equation into the Fittings Loss field on the Pipe Editor view. The selected list of fittings will not be retained. To remove the selected fitting individually, select the fitting and click the Delete button. Note: The network cannot be sized correctly if you specify equivalent length data to model fittings losses, since the equivalent length of any pipe fitting is a function of the pipe diameter and will therefore be incorrect when the diameters change.

Heat Transfer Tab


The pipe segment may perform calculations taking into account heat transfer with the external air. Fig 5.6

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

The following fields are available on this tab:


Input Data External Conditions Group External Medium Select the external medium. Two options are currently available 1. Air & 2. Sea Water Enter the temperature of the external air. If this field is left blank then the global value set via the Calculation Options view is used. Enter the velocity of the external medium. If this field is left blank then the global value set via the Calculation Options view is used. This drop-down list selects whether heat transfer calculations are to be performed for the pipe. Furthermore, setting only enables heat transfer calculations if the Enable Heat Transfer option is also selected in the Calculation Options view. This drop-down list selects whether or not the external Radiative heat transfer coefficient is included within the heat transfer calculations Enter the fractional Emissivity to be used for Radiative heat transfer calculations. This drop-down list selects whether the heat transfer calculation is done using a single element or the same number of elements as the pressure drop calculation. If Yes is selected then the heat transfer calculation sues the same number of elements as the pressure drop calculation A brief description to identify the type of pipe insulation. Supply the insulation thickness. Enter the insulation thermal conductivity. You can explicitly set an outlet temperature for this segment, or leave it blank. A heater in a flare knockout drum is an example of process equipment that may require a fixed outlet temperature. Valid values are between -260oC and 999 o C. Enter the heating duty and the outlet temperature will be calculated based on the inlet temperature and the defined duty. Description

Temperature

External Medium Velocity

Heat Transfer Enabled

External Radiative HTC

Emissivity Multiple Element Calculation

Insulation Group Description Thickness Thermal Conductivity Heating Group Outlet Temp

Duty

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 6 Pipe Network The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

49

Methods Tab
Calculation methods are specified here. Fig 5.7

The following fields are available on this tab:


Input Field Description VLE Method Group
When you are sizing a flare system, the initial pipe diameters may affect the solution when there is a liquid phase and the liquid knockout drum is modeled. You should initially size a network using vapor phase methods.

VLE Method

The options for the Vapor-Liquid Equilibrium calculations are as follows (see Appendix A - Theoretical Basis for more details): Compressible Gas - Real Gas relationship Peng Robinson - Peng Robinson Equation of State Soave Redlich Kwong - Soave Redlich Kwong Equation of State Vapor Pressure - Vapor Pressure method as described in API Technical Data Book Volume 113. Model Default - If this is selected, the Default method for the VLE method (as defined on the Calculation Options Editor view) will be used.

Pressure Drop Group Horizontal and Inclined Pipes The Horizontal/Inclined methods apply only when you have selected Two-Phase pressure drop. The options are: Isothermal Gas - This is a compressible gas method that assumes isothermal expansion of the gas as it passes along the pipe. Flare System Analyzer uses averaged properties of the fluid over the length of the pipe. The outlet temperature from the pipe is calculated by adiabatic heat balance either with or without heat transfer. Pressure losses due to change in elevation are ignored.

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

continued Input Field Description Adiabatic Gas - This is a compressible gas method that assumes adiabatic expansion of the gas as it passes along the pipe. As with the Isothermal Gas method, pressure losses due to changes in elevation are ignored. Beggs & Brill - The Beggs and Brill method is based on work done with an air-water mixture at many different conditions, and is applicable for inclined flow. For more details, see Appendix A Theoretical Basis. Dukler - Dukler breaks the pressure drop in two-phase systems into three components - friction, elevation and acceleration. Each component is evaluated independently and added algebraically to determine the overall pressure drop. For more details, see Appendix A - Theoretical Basis. Lockhart Martinelli Lockhart Martinelli correlations models the two phase pressure drop in terms of a single phase pressure drop multiplied by a correction factor. Acceleration changes are not included. Beggs and Brill (No Acc.) The Beggs and Brill methods without the acceleration term. Beggs and Brill (Homog.) The Beggs and Brill methods with a homogeneous acceleration term. Model Default - If this is selected, the Default method for the Horizontal/Inclined method (as defined on the Calculation Options Editor view) will be used. Vertical Pipes The Vertical method applies only when you have selected Two-Phase pressure drop. The options are: Isothermal Gas - This is a compressible gas method that assumes isothermal expansion of the gas as it passes along the pipe. Flare System Analyzer uses averaged properties of the fluid over the length of the pipe. The outlet temperature from the pipe is calculated by adiabatic heat balance either with or without heat transfer. Pressure losses due to change in elevation are ignored. Adiabatic Gas - This is a compressible gas method that assumes adiabatic expansion of the gas as it passes along the pipe. As with the Isothermal Gas method, pressure losses due to changes in elevation are ignored. Beggs & Brill - Although the Beggs and Brill method was not originally intended for use with vertical pipes, it is nevertheless commonly used for this purpose, and is therefore included as an option for vertical pressure drop methods. For more details, see Appendix A Theoretical Basis. Dukler - Although the Dukler method is not generally applicable to vertical pipes, it is included here to allow comparison with the other methods. Orkiszewski - This is a pressure drop correlation for vertical, twophase flow for four different flow regimes - bubble, slug, annular-slug transition and annular mist. For more details, see Appendix A Theoretical Basis. Lockhart Martinelli Lockhart Martinelli correlations models the two phase pressure drop in terms of a single phase pressure drop multiplied by a correction factor. Acceleration changes are not

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 6 Pipe Network The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

51

included. Beggs and Brill (No Acc.) The Beggs and Brill methods without the acceleration term. Beggs and Brill (Homog.) The Beggs and Brill methods with a homogeneous acceleration term. Model Default - If this is selected, the Default method for the Vertical method (as defined on the Calculation Options Editor view) will be used. Two Phase Elements For two-phase calculations, the pipe segment is divided into a specified number of elements. On each element, energy and material balances are solved along with the pressure drop correlation. In simulations involving high heat transfer rates, many increments may be necessary, due to the non-linearity of the temperature profile. Obviously, as the number of increments increases, so does the calculation time; therefore, you should try to select a number of increments that reflects the required accuracy. Description The Friction Factor Method applies only when you have entered a value for friction factor. The options are: Round - This method has been maintained primarily for historical purposes in order for older Flare System Analyzer calculations to be matched. It tends to over predict the friction factor by up to 10% in the fully turbulent region. Chen - It should always be the method of preference since it gives better predictions at the fully turbulent flow conditions normally found within flare systems. Model Default - If this is selected, the Default method for the Friction Factor Method (as defined on the Calculation Options Editor view) will be used. Ignore Downflow Head Recovery Solver Group Damping Factor The damping factor used in the iterative solution procedure. If this is left blank, the value in the Calculation Options Editor view is used. The Elevation Pressure change may be ignored for downflow (negative elevation change).

Input Field Friction Factor Method

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Summary Tab
The results of the calculation are displayed. Fig 5.8

Multiple Editing
You can edit multiple pipe segments simultaneously by highlighting them in the Pipe Manager with the mouse cursor while keeping the shift key pressed. After you have finished selecting pipe segments, double click any of them to open the common Pipe Editor view. The common pipe editor view differs from that of the single pipe editor view in the following respects: Only fields that can be edited in multiple mode are displayed. Drop-down list boxes have an additional entry, *. This entry indicates that the value should remain at the pre edit value. In the following figure of the Dimensions tab; we enter * for the Length and Elevation Change fields to indicate that these must not be changed. We specify new values for the Roughness and the Thermal Conductivity. We select * for the Use Class and Sizeable drop down lists to indicate that these must be changed.

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 6 Pipe Network The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

53

Fig 5.9

Pipe Class Editor


The Pipe Class Editor allows you to edit the allowable schedules for each nominal diameter, for both Carbon Steel and Stainless Steel, during sizing calculations. It also allows you to restrict the range of pipe sizes that may be selected by Flare System Analyzer during design calculations. To access the Pipe Class Editor, select Pipe Class from the Tools menu. Fig 5.10

Note: If you have selected Use Pipe Class When Sizing in the Run Options view, these are the schedules which will be used.

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

7 Nodes

This section provides information on the following topics: Overview Node Manager Ignoring/Restoring Nodes Connection Nodes Boundary Nodes

Overview
Pipes are connected via nodes, which can be added, edited and deleted from the Node Manager. Sources are also added through the Node Manager view.

Node Manager
1. To access the Node Manager, select Nodes from the Build menu. Fig 6.1

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 7 Nodes The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

55

The following buttons are available:


Button Add Description You will be prompted to select the type of node. This new node will be named with a number depending upon the number of nodes of that type already added. Allows you to edit the currently highlighted node. The form varies, depending on the type of node, as discussed below. Allows you to remove the currently highlighted node. Sort the nodes list alphabetically (in descending order) either by name or location or type of node. Move the highlighted nodes up and down the list.

Edit Delete Sort Up and Down Arrow Swap OK

Swap the two selected nodes in the Node list. Closes the view.

Ignoring/Restoring Nodes
When you ignore a single node, all upstream nodes are automatically ignored. You can ignore single or multiple nodes within the model. When you ignore a single node, all upstream nodes are automatically ignored. This enables you to do what if type calculations, where part of the network can be excluded from the calculation without the need for deletion and reinstallation of the appropriate nodes. To ignore a node: 1 2 Open the node editor view of the node that you want to ignore. On the Connections tab, activate the Ignore checkbox. The following figure shows this for a connector node

Fig 6.2

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

To restore a node that has previously been ignored: 1 2 Open the node editor view of the node that you want to restore. On the Connections tab, deactivate the Ignore checkbox.

Connection Nodes
The following types of connection nodes are available in Flare System Analyzer. A connection node is one that links two or more pipe segments. Connector. Flow Bleed. Horizontal Separator. Orifice Plate. Tee. Vertical Separator.

Connector
The connector is used to model the connection of two pipes. The diameters of each pipe may be different.

Connections Tab
The name of the connector and connectivity information is specified here. Fig 6.3 The location can have an alphanumeric name. This feature is useful for large flowsheets, because you can provide a different location name to different sections to make it more comprehensible.

The following fields are available on this tab:

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 7 Nodes The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

57

Field Name Location Upstream/ Downstrea m At Ignore

Description The alphanumeric description of the node (e.g. - HP Connect 1). You may want to specify the location of the node in the plant. Either type in the name of the pipe segment or select from the dropdown list. You can specify the end of the pipe segment attached to the connector. Select the ignore checkbox to ignore this connector in the calculations. Clear the checkbox to re-enable it.

Calculations Tab
Calculation methods are specified here. Fig 6.4

The following fields are available on this tab:


Field Theta Length Fitting Loss Method Description Specify the connector expansion angle. If not defined, it will be calculated to the length. Enter the connector length. If not defined, it will be calculated from theta. The available options are; Equal Static Pressure Pressure drop calculation is ignored and static pressure is balanced. Calculated Pressure drop is calculated in accordance with the Swage method. Equal Total Pressure - Pressure drop calculation is ignored and total pressure is balanced. Isothermal Pressure Drop If this option is set to Yes, the inlet temperatures used for the size change calculations in the connector will not update during iterative calculations for pressure loss i.e. a PT flash will be used to update the inlet properties. If the option is set to No then a more rigorous PH flash will be used to update the inlet properties.

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

The connector will do one size change calculation between the inlet and outlet diameters selecting expansion or contraction as appropriate. Setting this option to Yes can speed up calculations in some cases at cost of a minor loss of accuracy. Swage Group Two Phase Correction If this option is set to Yes then the pressure loss coefficient in two phase flow will be calculated using properties corrected for liquid slip. If set to No then the homogenous properties of the fluid will be used in calculating the pressure loss coefficient. Description The following options are available: Compressible - pressure losses will be calculated assuming compressible flow through the connector at all times. Incompressible (Crane) - pressure losses will be calculated assuming incompressible flow through the connector at all times. Loss coefficients are calculated using Crane coefficients. Transition - pressure losses will be calculated initially using the assumption of incompressible flow. If the pressure loss expressed as a percentage of the inlet pressure is greater than the defined compressible transition value then the pressure drop will be recalculated using the compressible flow method. Incompressible (HTFS) - pressure losses will be calculated assuming incompressible flow through the connector at all times. Loss coefficients are calculated using HTFS correlations The Incompressible method calculations are faster but will be less accurate at higher pressure drops. The Transition method can cause instabilities in some cases if the calculated pressure drop is close to the transition value. Compressible Transition This entry defines the pressure drop as a percentage of the inlet pressure at which compressible flow pressure drop calculations should be used. It applies only when the Transition method is selected.

Field Swage Method

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 7 Nodes The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

59

Summary Tab
The result of the calculations at each of the pipe connections is displayed. Fig 6.5

Flow Bleed
The Flow Bleed is a simple calculation block that allows you to; Specify a fixed pressure drop Specify a constrained flow offtake where the flow offtake is calculated from the following equation Offtake = Multiplier x Inlet Flow + Offset The calculated Offtake is constrained to maximum and minimum values.

Connections Tab
The name of the flow bleed and connectivity information is specified here. Fig 6.6

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

The following fields are available on this tab:


Field Name Location Upstream/ Downstream At Ignore Description The alphanumeric description of the Flow Bleed (e.g. - HP Connect XX). You may want to specify the location of the Flow Bleed in the plant. Either type in the name of the pipe segment or select from the dropdown list. You can specify the end of the pipe segment attached to the Flow Bleed. Select the ignore checkbox to ignore this flow bleed in the calculations. Clear the checkbox to re-enable it.

Calculations Tab
Calculation methods are specified here. Fig 6.7

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 7 Nodes The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

61

The following fields are available on this tab:


Field Offtake Multiplier Offtake Offset Offtake Minimum Offtake Maximum Pressure Drop Description Specify the Offtake multiplier. The default value is 0. Specify the Offset for the Offtake to compensate for the changes in the inlet flow. Specify the minimum value for the Offtake. Specify the maximum value for the Offtake. Enter the pressure drop across the Flow Bleed.

Summary Tab
The result of the calculations at each of the pipe connections is displayed. Fig 6.8

Horizontal Separator
Horizontal separators are used to allow liquid to separate from the feed stream so that it can be removed from the flare system. The liquid phase in the Horizontal Separator feed is removed from network. In Flare System Analyzer, the Horizontal Separator has one primary inlet, one secondary inlet/ outlet, and one vapor outlet stream.

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Connections Tab
The name of the horizontal separator and connectivity information is specified here. Fig 6.9

The following fields are available on this tab: You only need to provide 2 of 3 connections to be able to solve the separator. This allows for solution(s) to partially built networks.
Field Name Location Description The alphanumeric description of the Horizontal Separator (e.g. - HP KO Drum). You may want to specify the location of the Horizontal Separator in the plant. The location can have an alphanumeric name. This feature is useful for large flowsheets, because you can provide a different location name to different sections to make it more comprehensible. Primary Inlet/Secondary Inlet/Vapor Outlet At Ignore Either type in the name of the pipe segment or select from the drop-down list. You can specify the end of the pipe segment attached to the horizontal separator. Select the ignore checkbox to ignore this horizontal separator in the calculations. Clear the checkbox to reenable it.

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 7 Nodes The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

63

Calculations Tab
Calculation methods are specified here. Fig 6.10

The following fields are available on this tab:


Field Diameter Liquid Level Methods Group Fittings Loss Method The available options are; Equal Static Pressure Pressure drop calculation is ignored and static pressure is balanced. Calculated Pressure drop is calculated in accordance with the Swage method. Isothermal Pressure Drop If this option is set to Yes, the inlet temperatures used for the size change calculations in the separator will not update during iterative calculations for pressure loss i.e. a PT flash will be used to update the inlet properties. If the option is set to No then a more rigorous PH flash will be used to update the inlet properties. The horizontal separator does three size change calculations, one between each stream connection and the vessel body. Normally these will be expansion calculations for the primary and secondary inlets and a contraction calculation for the vapor outlet but they will automatically change if flows are reversed. Setting this option to Yes can speed up calculations in some cases at cost of a minor loss of accuracy. Size Change Group Field Description Description The internal diameter of the vessel. The liquid level in the vessel. Pressure drop is calculated based upon the vapor space above the liquid.

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Two Phase Correction

If this option is set to Yes then the pressure loss coefficient in two phase flow will be calculated using properties corrected for liquid slip. If set to No then the homogenous properties of the fluid will be used in calculating the pressure loss coefficient. The following options are available: Compressible - pressure losses will be calculated assuming compressible flow through the connector at all times. Incompressible (Crane) - pressure losses will be calculated assuming incompressible flow through the connector at all times. Loss coefficients are calculated using Crane coefficients. Transition - pressure losses will be calculated initially using the assumption of incompressible flow. If the pressure loss expressed as a percentage of the inlet pressure is greater than the defined compressible transition value then the pressure drop will be recalculated using the compressible flow method. Incompressible (HTFS) - pressure losses will be calculated assuming incompressible flow through the connector at all times. Loss coefficients are calculated using HTFS correlations The Incompressible method calculations are faster but will be less accurate at higher pressure drops. The Transition method can cause instabilities in some cases if the calculated pressure drop is close to the transition value.

Method

Compressible Transition

This entry defines the pressure drop as a percentage of the inlet pressure at which compressible flow pressure drop calculations should be used. It applies only when the Transition method is selected. If this option is set to Full Body Area the calculation for the primary inlet/vessel and secondary inlet/vessel size change will use the whole vessel area. If the Partial Body Area on Flow option is selected the vessel area is reduced in proportion to the appropriate flow i.e. if the secondary inlet volumetric flow is 20% of the total volumetric flow in the tee then 20% of the body area will be used in the size change calculation. The use of the Partial Body Area on Flow option has the effect of increasing the pressure loss calculated by simple fixed K factors.

Body Dimension

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 7 Nodes The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

65

Composition Tab
If the inlet feed flashes in the separator and as a result of the flash, the mixture is converted into liquid fully and the vapor outlet will have no flow. This can cause instability in the pressure solution of the whole network. To avoid this Flarenet creates an arbitrary vapor phase with very small vapor fraction for the vapor outlet (<0.001%). You can specify the composition of the vapor phase here.

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Design Tab

Input Data Min. Drop Diameter Drain Volume Maximum Holdup time Output Data Design Length

Description Enter the diameter of the minimum drop size to be removed. Enter the drain volume. Enter maximum holdup time before the horizontal separator will be drained. Description Minimum Length of the horizontal separator required to satisfy design conditions. Settling velocity of the minimum drop size to be removed.

Settling Velocity

Summary Tab
The result of the calculations at each of the pipe connections is displayed.

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 7 Nodes The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

67

Fig 6.11

Orifice Plate
An Orifice Plate is a thin plate, which has a clean-cut hole with straight walls perpendicular to the flat upstream face of the plate placed crossways in the pipe. Orifice plates are generally used to restrict the flow downstream of a blow down valve or restrict the flow from a high pressure section of a flare system to a low pressure section. They may also be used to allow flow measurement.

Connections Tab
The name of the orifice plate and connectivity information is specified here. Fig 6.12

The following fields are available on this tab:

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Field Name Location Upstream/Downstream At Ignore

Description The alphanumeric description of the Orifice Plate (e.g. - HP OP). You may want to specify the location of the Orifice Plate in the plant. Either type in the name of the pipe segment or select from the drop-down list. You can specify the end of the pipe segment attached to the Orifice Plate. Select the ignore checkbox to ignore this orifice in the calculations. Clear the checkbox to re-enable it.

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 7 Nodes The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

69

Calculations Tab
Calculation methods are specified here. Fig 6.13

The following fields are available on this tab: You only need to provide 1 of 3 sizing parameters. For Example, if you entered the Diameter then Flare System Analyzer will calculate the Upstream Diameter Ratio and the Downstream Diameter Ratio.
Field Diameter Upstream Diameter Ratio Downstream Diameter Ratio Methods Group Fittings Loss Method The Fitting Loss drop-down list have the following three options available: Ignored - If this option is selected, the fitting losses for the orifice plate would not be calculated. Static pressure is balanced. Thin Orifice - The fitting losses for the orifice plate will be calculated using the equations for the thin orifice plate. Contraction/Expansion - For this method, orifice plates will be modeled as a sudden contraction from the inlet line size to the diameter of the hole followed by a sudden expansion from the diameter of the hole to the outlet line size. Isothermal Pressure Drop
3

Description The diameter of the orifice hole. Valid values are between 0 and 1000 mm. This is the ratio of the throat diameter to the Upstream pipe diameter.

This is the ratio of the throat diameter to the Downstream pipe diameter.

If this option is set to Yes, the inlet temperatures used for the size change calculations in the orifice plate will not update during iterative calculations for pressure loss i.e. a PT flash will be used to update the

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

inlet properties. If the option is set to No then a more rigorous PH flash will be used to update the inlet properties. The orifice plate will do one contraction calculation and one expansion calculation if the Fittings Loss method is set to Contraction/Expansion. Field Description Setting this option to Yes can speed up calculations in some cases at cost of a minor loss of accuracy. Size Change Group Two Phase Correction If this option is set to Yes then the pressure loss coefficient in two phase flow will be calculated using properties corrected for liquid slip. If set to No then the homogeneous properties of the fluid will be used in calculating the pressure loss coefficient. The following options are available: Compressible - pressure losses will be calculated assuming compressible flow through the connector at all times. Incompressible (Crane) - pressure losses will be calculated assuming incompressible flow through the connector at all times. Loss coefficients are calculated using Crane coefficients. Transition - pressure losses will be calculated initially using the assumption of incompressible flow. If the pressure loss expressed as a percentage of the inlet pressure is greater than the defined compressible transition value then the pressure drop will be recalculated using the compressible flow method. Incompressible (HTFS) - pressure losses will be calculated assuming incompressible flow through the connector at all times. Loss coefficients are calculated using HTFS correlations The Incompressible method calculations are faster but will be less accurate at higher pressure drops. The Transition method can cause instabilities in some cases if the calculated pressure drop is close to the transition value. Compressible Transition This entry defines the pressure drop as a percentage of the inlet pressure at which compressible flow pressure drop calculations should be used. It applies only when the Transition method is selected.

Method

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 7 Nodes The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

71

Summary Tab
Fig 6.14

The result of the calculations at each of the pipe connections is displayed.

Tee
The connector is used to model the connection of two pipes. The diameters of each pipe may be different.

Connections Tab
The name of the tee and connectivity information is specified here. Fig 6.15

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

The following fields are available on this tab: You only need to provide 2 of 3 connections to be able to solve the tee. This allows for solution(s) to partially built networks.
Field Name Location Description The alphanumeric description of the node (e.g. - HP Tee 1). You may want to specify the location of the node in the plant. The location can have an alphanumeric name. This feature is useful for large flowsheets, because you can provide a different location name to different sections to make it more comprehensible. Either type in the name of the pipe segment or select from the drop-down list. You can specify the end of the pipe segment attached with the tee. Select the ignore checkbox to ignore this tee in the calculations. Clear the checkbox to re-enable it.

Upstream/Downstream/Branch At Ignore

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 7 Nodes The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

73

Calculations Tab
Calculation methods are specified here. Fig 6.16

The following fields are available on this tab:


Field Theta Body Description Specify the angle of the branch to the inlet of the tee. Specify the diameter of the body of the tee. Allowable choices are: Run - the diameter will be that of the inlet pipe. Tail - the diameter will be that of the outlet pipe. Branch - the diameter will be that of the branch pipe. Auto - Flare System Analyzer will set the body diameter to be larger of the inlet and branch pipe diameters. Methods Group Fittings Loss Method The available options are: Ignored - Flare System Analyzer will not calculate the fitting loss if this is selected. Simple - Flare System Analyzer uses a constant, flow ration independent K factor for the loss through the branch and run. Miller - This method uses a K factor which is interpolated using Miller Curves, which are functions of the flow and area ratios of the branch to the total flow as well as the branch angle. Loss coefficients at low values of the branch are to body area are extrapolated from the data presented on the charts. Miller (Area Ratio Limited) This method uses a K factor which is interpolated using Miller Curves, which are functions of the flow and area ratios of the branch to the total flow as well as the branch angle. The ratio of the branch area to body area is constrained by the lower limit presented on the charts.

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Field Connector If Incomplete

Description If this option is set to Yes, Flare System Analyzer will treat the Tee as a straight connector, ignoring the effect of the branch on pressure drop.

The tee will do three size change calculations between; inlet/body, branch/body and body/outlet selecting expansion or contraction calculations as appropriate. Setting this option to Yes can speed up calculations in some cases at cost of a minor loss of accuracy.
Isothermal Pressure Drop If this option is set to Yes, the inlet temperatures used for the size change calculations in the tee will not update during iterative calculations for pressure loss i.e. a PT flash will be used to update the inlet properties. If the option is set to No then a more rigorous PH flash will be used to update the inlet properties. If this option is set to Yes then the pressure loss coefficient in two phase flow will be calculated using properties corrected for liquid slip. If set to No then the homogenous properties of the fluid will be used in calculating the pressure loss coefficient. The following options are available: Compressible - pressure losses will be calculated assuming compressible flow through the connector at all times. Incompressible (Crane) - pressure losses will be calculated assuming incompressible flow through the connector at all times. Loss coefficients are calculated using Crane coefficients. Transition - pressure losses will be calculated initially using the assumption of incompressible flow. If the pressure loss expressed as a percentage of the inlet pressure is greater than the defined compressible transition value then the pressure drop will be recalculated using the compressible flow method. Incompressible (HTFS) - pressure losses will be calculated assuming incompressible flow through the connector at all times. Loss coefficients are calculated using HTFS correlations The Incompressible method calculations are faster but will be less accurate at higher pressure drops. The Transition method can cause instabilities in some cases if the calculated pressure drop is close to the transition value. Compressible Transition This entry defines the pressure drop as a percentage of the inlet pressure at which compressible flow pressure drop calculations should be used. It applies only when the Transition method is selected. If this option is set to Full Body Area the calculation for the inlet/body and branch/body size change will use the whole body area. If the Partial Body Area on Flow option is selected the body area is reduced in proportion to the appropriate flow i.e. if the branch volumetric flow is 20% of the total volumetric flow in the tee then 20% of the body area will be used in the size change calculation. This option is ignored if the fittings loss method is set to Miller. The use of the Partial Body Area on Flow option has the effect of increasing the pressure loss calculated by simple fixed K factors bringing the results closer to those calculated by the ore accurate Miller K factors.

Swage Group Two Phase Correction

Method

Body Dimension

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 7 Nodes The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

75

Summary Tab
The result of the calculations at each of the pipe connections is displayed. Fig 6.16

Vertical Separator
Vertical separators are used to allow liquid to separate from the feed stream so that it can be removed from the flare system. The liquid phase in the Vertical Separator feed is removed from network. In Flare System Analyzer, the Vertical Separator has only one inlet and one vapor outlet stream.

Connections Tab
The name of the vertical separator and connectivity information is specified here. Fig 6.17

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

The location can have an alphanumeric name. This feature is useful for large flowsheets, because you can provide a different location name to different sections to make it more comprehensible. The following fields are available on this tab:
Field Name Location Inlet/Vapor Outlet At Ignore Description The alphanumeric description of the Vertical Separator (e.g. - HP KO Drum). You may want to specify the location of the Vertical Separator in the plant. Either type in the name of the pipe segment or select from the dropdown list. You can specify the end of the pipe segment attached to the Vertical Separator. Select the ignore checkbox to ignore this vertical separator in the calculations. Clear the checkbox to re-enable it.

Calculations Tab
Calculation methods are specified here. Fig 6.18

The following fields are available on this tab:


Field Diameter Methods Group Fittings Loss Method The available options are; Equal Static Pressure Pressure drop calculation is ignored and static pressure is balanced. Calculated Pressure drop is calculated in accordance with the Swage method. Description The internal diameter of the vessel.

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 7 Nodes The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

77

Isothermal Pressure Drop

If this option is set to Yes, the inlet temperatures used for the size change calculations in the separator will not update during iterative calculations for pressure loss i.e. a PT flash will be used to update the inlet properties. If the option is set to No then a more rigorous PH flash will be used to update the inlet properties. The vertical separator will do one expansion calculation for the inlet stream entering the vessel and one contraction calculation for the flow from the vessel to the outlet. These will automatically change if flows through the vessel are reversed.

Field

Description Setting this option to Yes can speed up calculations in some cases at cost of a minor loss of accuracy.

Size Change Group Two Phase Correction If this option is set to Yes then the pressure loss coefficient in two phase flow will be calculated using properties corrected for liquid slip. If set to No then the homogenous properties of the fluid will be used in calculating the pressure loss coefficient. The following options are available: Compressible - pressure losses will be calculated assuming compressible flow through the connector at all times. Incompressible (Crane) - pressure losses will be calculated assuming incompressible flow through the connector at all times. Loss coefficients are calculated using Crane coefficients. Transition - pressure losses will be calculated initially using the assumption of incompressible flow. If the pressure loss expressed as a percentage of the inlet pressure is greater than the defined compressible transition value then the pressure drop will be recalculated using the compressible flow method. Incompressible (HTFS) - pressure losses will be calculated assuming incompressible flow through the connector at all times. Loss coefficients are calculated using HTFS correlations The Incompressible method calculations are faster but will be less accurate at higher pressure drops. The Transition method can cause instabilities in some cases if the calculated pressure drop is close to the transition value. Compressible Transition This entry defines the pressure drop as a percentage of the inlet pressure at which compressible flow pressure drop calculations should be used. It applies only when the Transition method is selected.

Method

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Composition Tab
If the inlet feed flashes in the separator and as a result of the flash, the mixture is converted into liquid fully and the vapor outlet will have no flow. This can cause instability in the pressure solution of the whole network. To avoid this Flarenet creates an arbitrary vapor phase with very small vapor fraction for the vapor outlet (<0.001%). You can specify the composition of the vapor phase here.

Design Tab

Input Data Min. Drop Diameter

Description Enter the diameter of the minimum drop

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 7 Nodes The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

79

size to be removed. Output Data Design Diameter Description Minimum Diameter of the horizontal separator required to satisfy design conditions. Settling velocity of the minimum drop size to be removed.

Settling Velocity

Summary Tab
The result of the calculations at each of the pipe connections is displayed. Fig 6.19

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Boundary Nodes
The following types of boundary nodes are available in Flare System Analyzer. A boundary node is one that is connected to only one pipe segment. Control Valve. Relief Valve. Flare Tip.

The relief valve and control valve node types represent sources or inflows into the system. The control valve, in particular, may also be used to model alternative types of sources such as; blow down valves, rupture disks, purge valves, etc.

Control Valve
The control valve is used to model a constant flow source such as purge valves, bursting disks and blow down valves. The most significant difference to the relief valve is that the rated flow equals the nominal flow.

Connections Tab
The name of the control valve and connectivity information is specified here. 6.20

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 7 Nodes The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

81

The following fields are available on this tab: The location can have an alphanumeric name. This feature is useful for large flowsheets, because you can provide a different location name to different sections to make it more comprehensible.
Field Name Location Outlet At Ignore Description The alphanumeric description of the Control Valve (e.g. - FCV 1). You may want to specify the location of the Control Valve in the plant. Either type in the name of the pipe segment or select from the dropdown list. You can specify where the pipe segment is to be attached to the Control Valve. Select the ignore checkbox to ignore this control valve in the calculations. Clear the checkbox to re-enable it.

Conditions Tab
Fluid conditions are specified here. Fig 6.21

The following fields are available on this tab:


Field Description

It is recommended that a value for Outlet Temperature which corresponds to an isenthalpic flash from the upstream conditions down to the Allowable Back Pressure. This will give the highest probable entry temperature into the system which will in turn give the highest velocities.
Inlet Pressure The pressure of the source on the upstream side of the valve. Valid values are between 0.01 and 600 bar.

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Inlet Temp Spec.

The temperature specification of the source on the upstream side of the relief valve. Valid values are between -250oC and 1500oC. You can select the fluid condition from the drop-down list on the left side. The available option are: Actual - it uses the given inlet temperature as the actual fluid temperature. Subcool - If this option is selected, enter the amount of subcooling. Superheat - If this option is selected, enter the amount of superheat.

Allowable Back Pressure

The Allowed Back Pressure is the pressure that is allowed to exist at the outlet of a pressure relief device as a result of the pressure in the discharge system. It is the sum of the superimposed and built-up back pressure. Clicking the Set button calculates the Allowable Back Pressure as a function of the Inlet Pressure. Checking the Auto checkbox will automatically calculate the Description Allowable Back Pressure whenever the Inlet Pressure changes. Valid values are between 0.01 to 600 bar.

Field

Outlet Temperature

This is the temperature of the source at the flange on the downstream side of the valve. If the enthalpy method chosen is the Ideal Gas model, then this temperature is used to determine the enthalpy of the source at the entrance to the pipe network, otherwise this enthalpy is calculated from the upstream pressure and temperature. If the Set button was clicked and the enthalpy model is Peng Robinson, Soave Redlich Kwong or Lee Kesler then the outlet temperature will be calculated from the upstream temperature and pressure after isenthalpic expansion to the defined MABP. Valid values are between -250oC and 1500oC.

Mass Flow Flange Diameter

This is the mass flow of the source. Valid values are between 0 and 100,000,000 kg/hr. This is the diameter of the flange at the valve discharge. The flange diameter may be left unknown in which case it will be assumed to be the same as the outlet pipe.

Composition Tab
The fluid composition is specified here.

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 7 Nodes The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

83

Fig 6.22

The following fields are available on this tab:


Field Basis Mol. Wt. Description This is the composition basis, which may be either Mol. Wt., Mole Fraction or Mass Fraction. It is the molecular weight of the fluid. You can only enter data here if the composition basis selected is Molecular Weight. Valid values are between 2 and 500. If the composition basis selected is Mole or Mass Fraction, the molecular weight is updated when you enter or change the component fractions. Fluid Type If Molecular Weight is selected in the composition basis drop-down list, you need to select the Fluid Type to calculate a binary composition in order to match the molecular weight. If the two components of the specified fluid type are not found then the other components are used. This is the fluid composition in either mole or mass fractions. You can only enter data here if the composition basis selected is Mole or Mass Fraction. When you exit the Source view, you will be prompted about the Invalid Composition if the sum of these fractions is not equal to one. You can normalize the composition by either manually editing the component fractions or by clicking the Normalize button. If the composition basis selected is Molecular Weight, the component fractions are estimated when you change the molecular weight. Clone Composition From Normalise This button allows the copying of compositional data from another releif valve in the same scenario Normalises the composition such that the sum of the component fractions is 1.

Component Fractions

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Methods Tab
Calculation methods are specified here. Fig 6.23

The following fields are available on this tab:


Fields VLE Method Description The options for the Vapor-Liquid Equilibrium calculations are as follows (see Appendix A - Theoretical Basis): Compressible Gas - Real Gas relationship. Peng Robinson - Peng Robinson Equation of State. Soave Redlich Kwong - Soave Redlich Kwong Equation of State. Vapor Pressure - Vapor Pressure method as described in API Technical Data Book - Volume 1. Model Default - If this is selected, the Default method for the VLE method (as defined on the Calculation Options view) will be used. Swage Group Fittings Loss Method The available options are; Equal Static Pressure Pressure drop calculation is ignored and static pressure is balanced. Calculated Pressure drop is calculated in accordance with the Swage method. Isothermal Pressure Drop If this option is set to Yes, the inlet temperatures used for the size change calculations in the control valve will not update during iterative calculations for pressure loss i.e. a PT flash will be used to update the inlet properties. If the option is set to No then a more rigorous PH flash will be used to update the inlet properties. The control valve will do one size change calculation from the defined flange diameter to the outlet pipe diameter. This will normally be an expansion. Setting this option to Yes can speed up calculations in some cases at cost of a minor loss of accuracy.

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 7 Nodes The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

85

Two Phase Correction

If this option is set to Yes then the pressure loss coefficient in two phase flow will be calculated using properties corrected for liquid slip. If set to No then the homogeneous properties of the fluid will be used in calculating the pressure loss coefficient. The following options are available: Compressible - pressure losses will be calculated assuming compressible flow through the connector at all times. Incompressible (Crane) - pressure losses will be calculated assuming incompressible flow through the connector at all times. Loss coefficients are calculated using Crane coefficients. Transition - pressure losses will be calculated initially using the assumption of incompressible flow. If the pressure loss expressed as a percentage of the inlet pressure is greater than the defined compressible transition value then the pressure drop will be recalculated using the compressible flow method. Incompressible (HTFS) - pressure losses will be calculated assuming incompressible flow through the connector at all times. Loss coefficients are calculated using HTFS correlations The Incompressible method calculations are faster but will be less accurate at higher pressure drops. The Transition method can cause instabilities in some cases if the calculated pressure drop is close to the transition value.

Method

Compressible Transition

This entry defines the pressure drop as a percentage of the inlet pressure at which compressible flow pressure drop calculations should be used. It applies only when the Transition method is selected. Description

Fields Estimated Properties at Header Conditions Group Vapor Fraction

The initial estimates for the flow profile in looped systems are generated based on the assumption of vapor phase flow without any liquid knockout in the system. It is not uncommon for sources to pass through a knockout drum before connection to the main header (see Figure 6.17). Specification of an estimate of vapor fraction of the fluid at the knockout drum can considerably enhance the automatically generated flow profile. If this value is not specified then it is assumed to be all vapor. Specify the estimated vapor molecular weight for the vapor fraction given above. If this value is not specified then it is assumed to be the same as that of the total fluid.

Vapor Mol. Wt.

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Inlet Piping Tab


Details of the piping between the protected equipment and the inlet to the relief valve are specified here. This data is used to calculate the pressure drop in the inlet piping. The diameter of the inlet piping is also used to calculate the inlet velocity of the source fluid when the Include Kinetic Energy option is selected in the Calculation Options view. Fig 6.24

The available fields are:


Fields Length Elevation Change Properties Group Material Roughness The material of the inlet pipe either Carbon Steel or Stainless Steel. The surface roughness of the inlet pipe. Whenever a material is selected, the absolute roughness is initialized to the default value for the material as defined on the Preferences view. Valid values are between 0.00001 inches and 0.1 inches. The nominal pipe diameter used to describe the inlet pipe size. For pipes with a nominal diameter of 14 inches or more, this will be the same as the outside diameter of the pipe. If a pipe schedule other than - is selected, you will be able to select a nominal pipe diameter from the pipe databases. It will not be necessary to specify the internal diameter. If you select - you will be unable to select a nominal pipe diameter from the pipe databases and you will then have to specify both the internal diameter. The pipe diameter used for the pressure drop calculations. Description The length of the inlet piping. The change in elevation of the inlet piping. This cannot be greater than the length of the piping.

Diameter Nominal Diameter Schedule

Internal Diameter

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 7 Nodes The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

87

Use Pipe Class Fittings Groups Loss Coefficient

Select this checkbox to restrict the sizes of the inlet piping selected by Flare System Analyzer to those defined by the Pipe Class tool.

Enter the A and B parameters for the following fittings K factor equation in which Ft is the friction factor for fully developed turbulent flow: K = A + BFt . Valid values are any positive number or 0.

Summary Tab
The result of the calculations is displayed. Fig 6.25

Copy Source Data


The Copy To button may be used to copy source data to other scenarios. When this button is pressed you will see a view similar to the following:

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Fig 6.26

Select the scenarios to which the data should be copied by activating the corresponding check box in the Copy column. This technique for copying source data may also be applied to relief valves. The Clone From button may be used to copy source data for other controls valves in the same scenario. When this button is pressed you will see a view similar to the following: Fig 6.27

Select the control valve from which the data should be copied or using the esc key to cancel. This technique for cloning source data may also be applied to relief valves.

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 7 Nodes The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

89

Relief Valve
The Relief Valve source can be used to model types of spring loaded relief valves. Relief valves are used frequently in many industries in order to prevent dangerous situations occurring from pressure build-ups in a system.

Connections Tab
The name of the relief valve and connectivity information is specified here. Fig 6.28

The following fields are available on this tab: The location can have an alphanumeric name. This feature is useful for large flowsheets, because you can provide a different location name to different sections to make it more comprehensible.
Field Name Location Outlet At Ignore Description The alphanumeric description of the Control Valve (e.g. - FCV 1). You may want to specify the location of the Control Valve in the plant. Either type in the name of the pipe segment or select from the dropdown list. You can specify where the pipe segment is to be attached to the Control Valve. Select the ignore checkbox to ignore this control valve in the calculations. Clear the checkbox to re-enable it.

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Conditions Tab
Fluid conditions are specified here. Fig 6.29

The following fields are available on this tab:


Field Inlet Pressure Description The pressure of the source on the upstream side of the valve. Valid values are between 0.01 and 600 bar.

It is recommended that a value for Outlet Temperature which corresponds to an isenthalpic flash from the upstream conditions down to the Allowable Back Pressure. This will give the highest probable entry temperature into the system which will in turn give the highest velocities.
Inlet Temp Spec. The temperature specification of the source on the upstream side of the relief valve. Valid values are between -250oC and 1500oC. You can select the fluid condition from the drop-down list on the left side. The available option are: Actual - it uses the given inlet temperature as the actual fluid temperature. Subcool - If this option is selected, enter the amount of subcooling. Superheat - If this option is selected, enter the amount of superheat. Allowable Back Pressure The Allowed Back Pressure is the pressure that is allowed to exist at the outlet of a pressure relief device as a result of the pressure in the discharge system. It is the sum of the superimposed and built-up back pressure. Clicking the Set button calculates the Allowable Back Pressure as a function of the Inlet Pressure. Checking the Auto checkbox will automatically calculate the Allowable Back Pressure whenever the Inlet Pressure changes. Valid values are between 0.01

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 7 Nodes The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

91

to 600 bar. Outlet Temperature This is the temperature of the source at the flange on the downstream side of the valve. If the enthalpy method chosen is the Ideal Gas model, then this temperature is used to determine the enthalpy of the source at the entrance to the pipe network, otherwise this enthalpy is calculated from the upstream pressure and temperature. If the Set button was clicked and the enthalpy model is Peng Robinson, Soave Redlich Kwong or Lee Kesler then the outlet temperature will be calculated from the upstream temperature and pressure after isenthalpic expansion to the defined MABP. Valid values are between -250oC and 1500oC. Field Mass Flow Flange Diameter Description This is the mass flow of the source. Valid values are between 0 and 100,000,000 kg/hr. This is the diameter of the flange at the valve discharge. The flange diameter may be left unknown in which case it will be assumed to be the same as the outlet pipe.

Composition Tab
The fluid composition is specified here. Fig 6.30

The following fields are available on this tab:


Field Basis Mol. Wt.
3

Description This is the composition basis, which may be either Mol. Wt., Mole Fraction or Mass Fraction. It is the molecular weight of the fluid. You can only enter data here if the

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

composition basis selected is Molecular Weight. Valid values are between 2 and 500. If the composition basis selected is Mole or Mass Fraction, the molecular weight is updated when you enter or change the component fractions. Fluid Type If Molecular Weight is selected in the composition basis drop-down list, you need to select the Fluid Type to calculate a binary composition in order to match the molecular weight. If the two components of the specified fluid type are not found then the other components are used. This is the fluid composition in either mole or mass fractions. You can only enter data here if the composition basis selected is Mole or Mass Fraction. When you exit the Source view, you will be prompted about the Invalid Composition if the sum of these fractions is not equal to one. You can normalize the composition by either manually editing the component fractions or by clicking the Normalize button. If the composition basis selected is Molecular Weight, the component fractions are estimated when you change the molecular weight. Clone Composition From Normalise This button allows the copying of compositional data from another releif valve in the same scenario Normalises the composition such that the sum of the component fractions is 1.

Component Fractions

Methods Tab
Calculation methods are specified here. Fig 6.31

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 7 Nodes The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

93

The following fields are available on this tab:


Fields VLE Method Description The options for the Vapor-Liquid Equilibrium calculations are as follows (see Appendix A - Theoretical Basis): Compressible Gas - Real Gas relationship. Peng Robinson - Peng Robinson Equation of State. Soave Redlich Kwong - Soave Redlich Kwong Equation of State. Vapor Pressure - Vapor Pressure method as described in API Technical Data Book - Volume 1. Model Default - If this is selected, the Default method for the VLE method (as defined on the Calculation Options view) will be used. Swage Group Fittings Loss Method The available options are; Equal Static Pressure Pressure drop calculation is ignored and static pressure is balanced. Calculated Pressure drop is calculated in accordance with the Swage method. Isothermal Pressure Drop If this option is set to Yes, the inlet temperatures used for the size change calculations in the control valve will not update during iterative calculations for pressure loss i.e. a PT flash will be used to update the inlet properties. If the option is set to No then a more rigorous PH flash will be used to update the inlet properties. The control valve will do one size change calculation from the defined flange diameter to the outlet pipe diameter. This will normally be an expansion. Fields Description Setting this option to Yes can speed up calculations in some cases at cost of a minor loss of accuracy. Two Phase Correction If this option is set to Yes then the pressure loss coefficient in two phase flow will be calculated using properties corrected for liquid slip. If set to No then the homogeneous properties of the fluid will be used in calculating the pressure loss coefficient. The following options are available: Compressible - pressure losses will be calculated assuming compressible flow through the connector at all times. Incompressible (Crane) - pressure losses will be calculated assuming incompressible flow through the connector at all times. Loss coefficients are calculated using Crane coefficients. Transition - pressure losses will be calculated initially using the assumption of incompressible flow. If the pressure loss expressed as a percentage of the inlet pressure is greater than the defined compressible transition value then the pressure drop will be recalculated using the compressible flow method. Incompressible (HTFS) - pressure losses will be calculated assuming incompressible flow through the connector at all times. Loss coefficients are calculated using HTFS correlations The Incompressible method calculations are faster but will be less accurate at higher pressure drops. The Transition method can cause instabilities in some cases if the calculated pressure drop is close to
3

Method

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

the transition value. Compressible Transition This entry defines the pressure drop as a percentage of the inlet pressure at which compressible flow pressure drop calculations should be used. It applies only when the Transition method is selected. The four sizing method options available are: API (1976) American Petroleum Institute method in the 1976 edition of RP 520 pt 1. No account is made of liquid flashing as it passes through the relief valve, thus this method is not recommended for either two phase or flashing fluids. API (1993) American Petroleum Institute method in the 1993 edition of RP 520 pt 1. Liquid flashing is handled by a simplified approach in which the fluid is flashed to the outlet pressure. The relative quantities of each phase at the outlet condition are then used at the inlet of the valve to determine the two phase capacity API(2000) American Petroleum Institute method in the 1993 edition of RP 520 pt 1. This method is often referred to as the Diers or Leung method. This is the recommended method for all two phase fluids. HEM Homogeneous Equilibrium method. Back Pressure Multiphase Cd Liquid Cd Kb Back pressure to be used for rating the relief valve. If this value is not specified then the maximum allowable back pressure is used. Discharge coefficient to be used of relief valve in multiphase service Discharge coefficient to be used for relief valves in liquid service User defined back pressure correction factor. If this field is left blank then the back pressure correction factor is calculated. This value should only be specified in exceptional cases.

Sizing Group Sizing Method

Energy Balance Group Isentropic Flash Isentropic Efficiency Estimated Properties at Header Conditions Group Vapor Fraction The initial estimates for the flow profile in looped systems are generated based on the assumption of vapor phase flow without any liquid knockout in the system. It is not uncommon for sources to pass through a knockout drum before connection to the main header (see Figure 6.17). Specification of an estimate of vapor fraction of the fluid at the knockout drum can considerably enhance the automatically generated flow profile. If this value is not specified then it is assumed to be all vapor. Vapor Mol. Wt. Specify the estimated vapor molecular weight for the vapor fraction given above. If this value is not specified then it is assumed to be the same as that of the total fluid. Select Yes to use an isentropic flash between the inlet and outlet otherwise an isenthalpic flash will be done Fractional isentropic efficency for the isentropic flash

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 7 Nodes The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

95

Inlet Piping Tab


Details of the piping between the protected equipment and the inlet to the relief valve are specified here. This data is used to calculate the pressure drop in the inlet piping to ensure that it does not exceed the recommended limit of 3% of the inlet pressure. The diameter of the inlet piping is also used to calculate the inlet velocity of the source fluid when the Include Kinetic Energy option is selected in the Calculation Options view. Fig 6.32

The available fields are:


Fields Length Elevation Change Properties Group Material Roughness The material of the inlet pipe either Carbon Steel or Stainless Steel. The surface roughness of the inlet pipe. Whenever a material is selected, the absolute roughness is initialized to the default value for the material as defined on the Preferences view. Valid values are between 0.00001 inches and 0.1 inches. The nominal pipe diameter used to describe the inlet pipe size. For pipes with a nominal diameter of 14 inches or more, this will be the same as the outside diameter of the pipe. If a pipe schedule other than - is selected, you will be able to select a nominal pipe diameter from the pipe databases. It will not be necessary to specify the internal diameter. If you select - you will be unable to select a nominal pipe diameter from the pipe databases and you will then have to specify both the internal diameter. The pipe diameter used for the pressure drop calculations. Description The length of the inlet piping. The change in elevation of the inlet piping. This cannot be greater than the length of the piping.

Diameter Nominal Diameter Schedule

Internal

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Diameter Fields Use Pipe Class Fittings Groups Loss Coefficient Enter the A and B parameters for the following fittings K factor equation in which Ft is the friction factor for fully developed turbulent flow: K = A + BFt . Valid values are any positive number or 0. Description Select this checkbox to restrict the sizes of the inlet piping selected by Flare System Analyzer to those defined by the Pipe Class tool.

Summary Tab
The result of the calculations is displayed. Fig 6.33

Source Tools
The initial sizing of a flare system is time consuming both in terms of time taken to build the model and the computation time. Using an Ideal Gas method can speed up the calculation during the initial sizing estimation. Speed is an important issue during sizing calculations especially for a complex multiple scenario case. Typically, the back pressure should be used for calculations. Rigorous rating calculation for all scenarios can be done by the Peng Robinson enthalpy method or any other enthalpy methods with pressure dependency and provides the down stream temperature.

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 7 Nodes The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

97

Updating Downstream Temperatures


The downstream temperatures are only used to define the system entry temperature when ideal gas enthalpies are used. After several cycles of rating and sizing calculations, the original values for each source may no longer be valid. These values may be updated to reflect the results of the last calculation using an equation of state enthalpy method as follows. Select Refresh Source Temperatures from the Tools menu.

Adding Single Source Scenarios


The thorough evaluation of a flare network will require the evaluation of many scenarios. In most systems, there will be the possibility of each relief valve lifting on its own. In the case of a petrochemical complex, this could have several hundred relief valves and the task of setting up the scenarios for each relief valve would be time consuming and error prone. Once all the major scenarios have been defined, select Add Single Source Scenarios from the Tools menu. Click Yes to allow Flare System Analyzer to analyze the existing scenarios to determine the greatest flow rate for each relief valve and create a scenario using this data.

Flare Tip
The Flare tip is used to model outflows from the system. It can model either ignited combustible gas flare tips or open vents. Non physical equipment such as a connection to a fixed pressure exit at a plant boundary can also be modeled.

Connections Tab
The name of the flare tip and connectivity information is specified here. Fig 6.34

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

The location can have an alphanumeric name. This feature is useful for large flowsheets, because you can provide a different location name to different sections to make it more comprehensible. The following fields are available on this tab:
Field Name Location Inlet At Ignore Description The alphanumeric description of the node (e.g. - HP Flare Tip). You may want to specify the location of the node in the plant. Either type in the name of the pipe segment or select from the dropdown list. You can specify the end of the pipe segment attached to the flare tip. Select the ignore checkbox to ignore this flare tip in the calculations. Clear the checkbox to re-enable it.

Calculations Tab
Calculation methods are specified here. Fig 6.35

The following fields are available on this tab:


Field Diameter Description You can specify a diameter for the tip. If this value is not specified then the diameter of the connected pipe is used. Methods Group Use Curves Select this checkbox if you are supplying pressure drop curves to calculate the pressure drop of the flare tip. Data for these curves is entered on the Curves tab. The fitting loss coefficient will be used to calculate the pressure

Fittings Loss

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 7 Nodes The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

99

Coefficient Fittings Loss Coefficient Basis Isothermal Pressure Drop

drop through the flare tip. Select whether the supplied Fittings Loss Coefficient will calculate the Total Pressure loss including velocity pressure loss or Static Pressure loss only. If this option is set to Yes, the inlet temperatures used for the size change calculations in the flare tip will not update during iterative calculations for pressure loss i.e. a PT flash will be used to update the inlet properties. If the option is set to No then a more rigorous PH flash will be used to update the inlet properties. The flare tip will do a one size calculation for the change in diameter between inlet pipe and the flare tip. Setting this option to Yes can speed up calculations in some cases at cost of a minor loss of accuracy.

Pipe To Flare Tip Swage Group Two Phase Correction If this option is set to Yes then the pressure loss coefficient in two phase flow will be calculated using properties corrected for liquid slip. If set to No then the homogenous properties of the fluid will be used in calculating the pressure loss coefficient. Description The following options are available: Compressible - pressure losses will be calculated assuming compressible flow through the connector at all times. Incompressible (Crane) - pressure losses will be calculated assuming incompressible flow through the connector at all times. Loss coefficients are calculated using Crane coefficients. Transition - pressure losses will be calculated initially using the assumption of incompressible flow. If the pressure loss expressed as a percentage of the inlet pressure is greater than the defined compressible transition value then the pressure drop will be recalculated using the compressible flow method. Incompressible (HTFS) - pressure losses will be calculated assuming incompressible flow through the connector at all times. Loss coefficients are calculated using HTFS correlations The Incompressible method calculations are faster but will be less accurate at higher pressure drops. The Transition method can cause instabilities in some cases if the calculated pressure drop is close to the transition value. Compressible Transition This entry defines the pressure drop as a percentage of the inlet pressure at which compressible flow pressure drop calculations should be used. It applies only when the Transition method is selected.

Field Method

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Curves Tab
User specified pressure drop curves are specified here. These will only be used if the Use Curves field on the Calculation Tab is unchecked. Fig 6.36

The following fields are available on this tab:


Field Ref. Temp. Description Enter the reference temperature to which the pressure drop curves correspond. All curves must be for the same reference temperature. If checked then the static pressure correction takes into account density differences due to both the calculated inlet pressure and calculated inlet pressure. The temperature correction is automatically applied but this box must be checked in order for pressure effects to be modeled. This box should normally be checked Enter the molecular weight at which the pressure drop curve applies. The Add Mol. Wt button can be used to add additional curves. The drop-down list can then be used to select which pressure drop curve is displayed. The Delete Mol. Wt button will delete the selected pressure drop curve. These pairs of data define points in the pressure drop curve. Points may be added and removed from the curve by using the Add and Delete buttons. Up to 10 data points can be supplied for each curve. Pressure drops for flows between those in the table are calculated using linear interpolation. If this field is checked then extrapolation beyond the range of supplied molecular weight curves is performed if necessary, otherwise the bounding molecular weight curve is used. If this field is checked then extrapolation beyond the range of supplied mass flow rates is performed if necessary, otherwise the bounding mass flow is used.

Pressure Correction

Mol. Wt.

Mass Flow/Pres. Drop

Mol. Wt. Extrapolation Flow Extrapolation

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 7 Nodes The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

101

Summary Tab
The result of the calculation is displayed. Fig 6.37

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

8 Calculations

This section provides information on the following topics: Calculation Options Starting the Calculations Efficient Modeling Techniques

Calculation Options
The selection of settings and options for the calculations is managed from the Calculation Options Editor view. To access the Calculation Options Editor view, select Options from the Calculations menu.

General Tab
Global calculation parameters and calculation options are specified here.

Fig 7.1

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 8 Calculations The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

103

The following fields are available on this tab:


Field External Conditions Group Atmospheric Pressure Ambient Temperature Wind Velocity Enable Heat Transfer External Radiative HTC Specify the atmospheric pressure. The default values are 1.01325 bar abs or 14.696 psia. The Ambient temperature must be in the range -100oC to 100oC. The average wind velocity. If checked, heat transfer calculations between pipe segments and the surroundings are performed for those pipe segments that have Heat Transfer with Atmosphere enabled. If checked, heat transfer calculations between pipe segments and the surroundings will include the external radiative heat transfer coefficient for those pipe segments that have External Radiative HTC enabled Description

Energy Balance Group Include Kinetic Energy If checked the kinetic energy of the fluids entering and leaving each node is included in the energy balance. Specifically: If checked the energy balance equation is is constant across each node. If not checked the energy balance is across each node. Where: H0 = stagnation enthalpy H = fluid enthalpy v = fluid velocity Inlet Velocity This entry selects the velocity to be used to determine the kinetic energy of the fluids entering the flare system when required. The choices are: Inlet Pipe Velocity - The inlet pipe diameter defined for each relief valve and control valve is used to determine the inlet velocity. Zero Velocity - The velocity of the fluid at the inlet to each relief valve and control valve is 0.0. Mode Group Calculation Mode This drop-down list selects and displays the current calculation mode. The options are: Rating - It is used to check the existing flare system in a plant. This method calculates the pressure profile for the existing pipe network. Design - It is used to design a new flare system for the plant. During calculation it adjusts the diameters of all pipes until all the design constraints of MABP, velocity, etc, have been met. These diameters can be smaller than the initially defined data.

H0 = H +

v2 2

, which

H0 = H

, which is constant

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Debottleneck - It is used to determine sections of the flare system that must be increased in size due to either the uprating of the existing plant and hence flare loading, or the tie-in of new plant. It can only increase existing pipe sizes, not reduce them. The calculation mode can also be set using the selector on the main toolbar. Field Calculate Ignored Sources with Zero Use MABP for Inactive Sources When Sizing Description If checked this causes sources that have been ignored to be treated as if they have a zero flow. This will result in the back pressure being calculated and limit checked against the source MABP even if the source has been ignored. If checked this causes the back pressure for inactive sources to be calculated and then used to trigger pipe size changes during design calculations. Otherwise these sources will be ignored when determining required pipe sizes. An inactive source is one that is ignored or has a zero flow. If checked this causes the pressure loss resulting from the size change between flange diameter of control or relief valves and the outlet pipe to be ignored during design calculations. Selecting this option will speed up calculations and reduce instability in cases where the flange diameter has been set to an unrealistically small value. If left unchecked, velocities will not be limited to the sonic condition. This is useful in sizing calculations since the mach number limitations will still be met by the time the final solution is reached. Calculation speed is greater at the risk of numerical instability and convergence failure. If checked, the rated flow will be used in the pressure drop calc calculations for the tailpipes (as opposed to the actual flowrates). The API guide for the Pressure-Relieving and Depressuring Systems recommends that tailpipes be sized based on the rated capacity. If checked, the rated flow will be used in the pressure drop calc calculations for the nodes attached to tailpipes (as opposed to the actual flowrates If checked, the pressure loss in the inlet piping to relief valves will be based upon the rated flow for the valve rather than the nominal flow. A warning will be issued if the non recoverable pressure loss in the inlet piping to a relief valve exceeds this percentage of the maximum allowable working pressure (set pressure)

Ignore Source to Pipe Pressure Loss in Design Mode

Choked Flow Check

Rated Flow for Tailpipes

Rated Flow For Nodes Attached To Tailpipes Rated Flow For Inlet Pipes Warn At

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 8 Calculations The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

105

Scenarios Tab
The Scenarios tab allows the selection of the scenarios that will be calculated. The options provided by the Calculate drop-down list are Current Scenario, All Scenarios and Selected Scenarios. Fig 7.2

If the option is set to Selected Scenarios the only scenarios calculated will be those where the checkbox is selected in the Calculate column next to the scenario name. The scenario selection setting is also used to determine which scenario data will be exported by the Data Export option i.e. only those scenarios which are selected for calculation will be exported. Note: The current scenario is displayed in the scenario selector on the main Flare System Analyzer toolbar. The current scenario may be changed either using the Scenario Selector on the main toolbar or by selecting a scenario in the Scenario Manager and clicking the Current. See Selecting Components.

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Methods Tab
Global calculation methods are specified here. Fig 7.3

The following fields are available on this tab: Refer to Appendix A Theoretical Basis for more details.

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 8 Calculations The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

107

Input Field Properties Group VLE Method (Overall)

Description

The options for the Vapor-Liquid Equilibrium calculations are as follows: Compressible Gas - Real Gas relationship. Peng Robinson - Peng Robinson Equation of State. Soave Redlich Kwong - Soave Redlich Kwong Equation of State. Vapor Pressure - Vapor Pressure method as described in API Technical Data Book - Volume 113.

Enthalpy Method (Overall)

The following calculation method for the determination of fluid enthalpies are available: Ideal Gas - This method uses the specified downstream temperature of a source to calculate the heat balance within the network. Peng Robinson - The Peng Robinson enthalpy is determined rigorously. Soave Redlich Kwong - The Soave Redlich Kwong enthalpy is determined rigorously. Lee-Kesler - This method uses the specified upstream temperature and pressure of a source to calculate the heat balance within the network. The Lee Kesler enthalpies may be more accurate than the Property Package enthalpies, but they require solution of a separate model.

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Input Field VLE Method (Source Outlet Temperature Estimation) Enthalpy Method (Source Outlet Temperature Estimation) Pressure Drop Group Horizontal and Inclined Pipes

Description The VLE method that will be used for the estimation of the temperature at the downstream flange for source nodes. The options are the same as for the Overall VLE Method.

The enthalpy method that will be used for the estimation of the temperature at the downstream flange for source nodes. The options are the same as for the Overall enthalpy Method.

The options are: Isothermal Gas - This is a compressible gas method that assumes isothermal expansion of the gas as it passes along the pipe. Flare System Analyzer uses averaged properties of the fluid over the length of the pipe. The outlet temperature from the pipe is calculated by adiabatic heat balance either with or without heat transfer. Pressure losses due to change in elevation are ignored. Adiabatic Gas - This is a compressible gas method that assumes adiabatic expansion of the gas as it passes along the pipe. As with the Isothermal Gas method, pressure losses due to changes in elevation are ignored. Beggs & Brill - The Beggs and Brill method is based on work done with an air-water mixture at many different conditions, and is applicable for inclined flow. For more details, see Appendix A Theoretical Basis. Dukler - Dukler breaks the pressure drop in two-phase systems into three components - friction, elevation and acceleration. Each component is evaluated independently and added algebraically to determine the overall pressure drop. For more details, see Appendix A - Theoretical Basis. Lockhart Martinelli Lockhart Martinelli correlations models the two phase pressure drop in terms of a single phase pressure drop multiplied by a correction factor. Acceleration changes are not included. Beggs and Brill (No Acc.) The Beggs and Brill methods without the acceleration term. Beggs and Brill (Homog.) The Beggs and Brill methods with a homogeneous acceleration term. Model Default - If this is selected, the Default method for the Horizontal/Inclined method (as defined on the Calculation Options Editor view) will be used.

Vertical Pipes

The options are: Isothermal Gas - This is a compressible gas method that assumes isothermal expansion of the gas as it passes along the pipe. Flare System Analyzer uses averaged properties of the fluid over the length of the pipe. The outlet temperature from the pipe is calculated by adiabatic heat balance either with or without heat transfer. Pressure losses due to change in elevation are ignored. Adiabatic Gas - This is a compressible gas method that assumes

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 8 Calculations The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

109

adiabatic expansion of the gas as it passes along the pipe. As with the Isothermal Gas method, pressure losses due to changes in elevation are ignored. Beggs & Brill - Although the Beggs and Brill method was not originally intended for use with vertical pipes, it is nevertheless commonly used for this purpose, and is therefore included as an option for vertical pressure drop methods. For more details, see Appendix A Theoretical Basis. Dukler - Although the Dukler method is not generally applicable to vertical pipes, it is included here to allow comparison with the other methods.

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Input Field

Description Orkiszewski - This is a pressure drop correlation for vertical, twophase flow for four different flow regimes - bubble, slug, annular-slug transition and annular mist. For more details, see Appendix A Theoretical Basis. Lockhart Martinelli Lockhart Martinelli correlations models the two phase pressure drop in terms of a single phase pressure drop multiplied by a correction factor. Acceleration changes are not included. Beggs and Brill (No Acc.) The Beggs and Brill methods without the acceleration term. Beggs and Brill (Homog.) The Beggs and Brill methods with a homogeneous acceleration term. Model Default - If this is selected, the Default method for the Vertical method (as defined on the Calculation Options Editor view) will be used.

Two Phase Elements

For two-phase calculations, the pipe segment is divided into a specified number of elements. On each element, energy and material balances are solved along with the pressure drop correlation. In simulations involving high heat transfer rates, many increments may be necessary, due to the non-linearity of the temperature profile. Obviously, as the number of increments increases, so does the calculation time; therefore, you should try to select a number of increments which reflects the required accuracy. The Friction Factor Method applies only when you have entered a value for friction factor. The options are: Round - This method has been maintained primarily for historical purposes in order for older Flare System Analyzer calculations to be matched. It tends to over predict the friction factor by up to 10% in the fully turbulent region. Chen - It should always be the method of preference since it gives better predictions at the fully turbulent flow conditions normally found within flare systems.

Friction Factor Method

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 8 Calculations The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

111

Warnings Tab
You can set the level of detail of the warnings by checking the appropriate checkboxes. By default, they are all checked. There are three groups available on the Warnings tab: Design Problems. Calculation Problems. Sizing Status.

Fig 7.4

Design Problems Group


The following options can be selected in this group: Mach Number. Velocity. Rho V2. Noise. Back Pressure. Choked Flow. Slug Flow. Temperature. Carbon Steel Min./Max Temp. Carbon Steel Min./Max Temp.

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Calculation Problems Group


The Calculation Problems group contains the following checkboxes: Physical properties Failure. Heat Balance Failure. Choke Pressure Failure. Pressure Drop Failure. Liquid With Vapor Only Method.

Sizing Status Group


The checkboxes available in this group are: Initialization. Size Change. Limited Reached.

Solver Tab
Solver control parameters are specified here. Fig 7.5

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 8 Calculations The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

113

The following fields are available on this tab:


Field Tolerances Group Properties Pressure This is the tolerance for the maximum difference between the pressure used to calculate physical properties and the calculated inlet and outlet pressures across the network. It should be tighter (i.e. smaller) than the Unit Operations pressure tolerance and the Loop pressure tolerance. This is the tolerance for the difference in pressure drop when iterating to calculate the pressure drop for each individual unit operation. This is the tolerance for the maximum pressure difference between two streams converging or diverging in a looped flare network. It should be slacker (i.e. higher) than the properties pressure tolerance and unit operations pressure tolerance. This is the tolerance for the maximum error in the mass balance over a node where streams converge or diverge in looped system calculations. Valid values are between 0.00001% and 10%; the default is 0.01%. Description

Unit Operations Pressure Loop Pressure

Loop Mass Balance

Iteration Limits Group Properties This is the maximum number of iterations allowed for converging the inner properties pressure loop of a looped flare system, or for overall convergence of a convergent flare system. The default of 25 should be adequate for most cases. This is the maximum number of iterations allowed for overall convergence of a looped flare system. The default is 500.

Loop Damping Factors Group Properties

This is the damping factor applied to the pressure step when solving the inner properties pressure loop. Values less than 1.0 may be specified to prevent oscillation in the properties pressure loop to improve convergence. This is the damping factor applied to the steps taken when solving the outer pressure / flow loop when solving looped systems. Values less than 1.0 may be specified to prevent oscillations in the pressure / flow loop to improve convergence. The following methods are available: Newton-Raphson - provides the best combination of solution speed vs convergence success. Broyden - provides a faster solution than Newton-Raphson since the Jacobian matrix computation is required less frequently, but requires better initial guesses. Force Convergent - this option may be used if you are modeling a convergent flare system with two flare tips. This type of system is commonly found on offshore production facilities. Use of the Newton-Raphson solver with the Simultaneous structural analyzer may be faster for these systems. Conjugate Gradient Minimization, Quasi-Newton Minimization provide a very robust but slow solution method. These methods

Loop

Loop Solver

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

can be useful if many Recycle warnings appear in the Trace number. One Step - performs a single iteration using user estimates for the molar flows. Structural Analyzer Field This option selects the analyzer used by Flare System Analyzer to detect and initialize looped systems. The options are: Description

The Simultaneous Structural Analyzer should always be used for new models.
Convergent - this uses a heuristic forwards and backwards algorithm to detect loops in the flare system and identify which pipes to use as tears. It allows the user to control the initialization of the loop solver by specifying the set of pipes that may be used as tears and flow estimates through the Estimates tab of the Scenario Edit view. Simultaneous - this generates a simplified linear model of the flare system and solves it to identify a set of tear stream. It will use the flow estimates supplied by the user but will repeat its calculation ignoring these if it does not find a valid solution. This analyzer always ignores any specification of pipes to be used as tears. In general the Simultaneous loop analyzer is faster and more reliable than the Convergent analyzer and will calculate better initial estimates. The Convergent analyzer should be used for compatibility with legacy Flare System Analyzer cases or when the user wishes to force a particular set of pipes to be used as tears and/or flow estimates. Echo Error History Preserve Unconverged Results for Looped Calculations Estimates When checked, it will generate additional messages giving details of intermediate calculations. This should be left unchecked unless you have convergence problems. When checked, failure of calculations will not erase the results after the final iteration. This can be useful for the diagnosis of difficult problems.

Upon completion of the calculations, the tear flow estimates for the scenario can be automatically updated. The options are: Do Not Update The estimates will not be updated. Update If Converged The estimates will only be updated if the calculations have fully converged. Always Update The estimates will be updated regardless of the convergence status.

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 8 Calculations The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

115

Initialization Tab
Global parameters that can enhance convergence speed and reliability are specified here: Fig 7.6

Field Pressure

Description This specifies the initial value for the pressure for physical property calculations. It should be at least equal to the system exit pressure. This specifies a global length multiplier to be applied to all the pipes in the system. It is useful in the early stages of flare system design to allow for bends and other fittings losses that will not be known until later. This global value is overridden by Length Multipliers defined for individual pipes. This drop-down list provides the following options: Multiphase - Flare System Analyzer will assume that two phase flow is possible in the flare system when determining the initial pipe sizes in Design mode. Vapor - Flare System Analyzer will assume that all flows are vapor phase when determining the initial pipe size in Design mode. Selection of the Vapor option will initialize calculations with larger pipe diameters than those selected for multiphase flow. This will speed up design calculations but there will be a risk that some pipes will be oversized.

Length Multiplier

Design Mode Initialization

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Check Model
The Check Model menu option allows the user to check the current status of the model to identify rapidly any data items that are likely to cause problems during calculations or invalidate the results. Any items that are identified as potential problems are displayed in the Model Check pop up view as shown below. Fig 7.7

The major checks carried out are: Ignored Pipes and Connector Nodes. A check is made for pipes and connector nodes that have the ignored option selected to remove them from the calculations. Since an ignored pipe or connector node will cause all upstream sources, pipes and nodes to be excluded from in calculations it is important that the user be aware of them. Source nodes are commonly ignored so they are not included in this check. Zero Length Pipes. A check is made for pipes with a length of 0.0. While it is legitimate to set a pipe length to 0.0 to temporarily eliminate its pressure loss in a model, it is more likely that this indicates an oversight on the part of the user or an incomplete data import. Zero Diameter Pipes. A check is made for pipes with a diameter of 0.0. A pipe diameter of 0.0 is likely to cause a calculation failure in all or part of the model and is a problem that should be corrected by the user. Incomplete Connectivity. A check is made that all nodes and pipes are completely connected without any dangling connections. While Flare System Analyzer may be able to solve the incomplete network, it is likely that any missing connections are a result of them being overlooked by the user or left unspecified during data import from an external file. Damaged Connectivity. A check is made that all nodes and pipes have specified connection points. Omission of these may result in a model that will not solve correctly. This problem is more likely to arise from an incomplete data import than normal interactive use of the program.

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 8 Calculations The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

117

The Memory Button displays a view that shows memory usage and instance counts for the components that comprise the model. This can be useful for diagnosing performance related issues. Fig 7.8

Starting the Calculations


The following words before the object on the status bar show the type of calculation being performed: B = Mass and Energy Calculations P = Pressure Drop Calculations To start the calculations, select Calculate from the Calculations menu. Alternatively, you could select the Start Calculations icon on the toolbar. The status of the rating calculations is shown on the status bar. In the following screen shot, the second display field on the status bar shows that the node mass and energy balance calculations have been performed for Tee 1. The third display field shows firstly the inner properties loop iteration number, then the maximum pressure error for that iteration and finally the name of the pipe segment responsible for the error. The fourth display field shows firstly the number of iterations taken by the loop solver and then the error in the objective function being solved by the loop solver.

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Fig 7.9

To abort calculations, click the Stop Calculations icon, which takes the place of the Start Calculations icon during calculations. Note: Due to speed considerations, it is recommended that sizing calculations be performed subject to the constraints: Compressible Gas VLE Ideal Gas Enthalpy Method No Heat Transfer Calculations

Efficient Modeling Techniques


Efficient modeling of a flare network requires some forethought in order to meet the primary objectives which are in general: 1 Definition of the design constraints for the flare system. These will usually be defined by company standards or by local health and safety regulations. If unavailable, standard texts such as API-RP-521 can be used to select preliminary acceptable values. Efficient acquisition of the data for the piping configuration and layout. Definition of the scenarios or contingencies which should be evaluated. Grass roots design will require analysis of a far wider range of scenarios to those required by the simple expansion of a flare system to incorporate a new relief valve. Rapid construction of the computer model of the flare system. Fast and efficient calculation of the computer model of the flare system.

2 3

4 5

Objectives 1 to 3 can only be achieved by the use of engineering skill and judgment. Once complete, the efficient use of Flare System Analyzer can lead to a satisfactory project conclusion.

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 8 Calculations The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

119

Data Entry
Flare System Analyzer has a wide range of methods for entering the data for each object within the model. In general, you should use the method that you are most comfortable with, but experience has shown that use of the PFD environment for definition of the piping configuration and layout can save many man days of labor with large flare networks. Although there is no set order in which the model must be built, the recommended sequence of data entry for building the model is: 1 2 Define the project description, user name, etc. by selecting Description under File in the menu bar. Set preferences for the default piping materials, type of tee, composition basis, etc. from the Preferences view, accessed via the File command in the menu bar. These may be overwritten on an object by object basis at any stage. Ensure that the Edit Objects On Add checkbox is active if you want to edit the object data as each new flowsheet object is created. Define a pipe class if appropriate. This will ensure that you only use pipe sizes as allowed by your project. Open the Pipe Class Editor using the Tools command in the menu bar. With the Calculation Options Editor, define default calculation methods for VLE, Pressure drop, etc. To open this view, select Options under the Calculations menu. Define all the source nodes (relief valves and control valves) for the first scenario. The first scenario should be the one that has the greatest level of common data amongst the complete set of scenarios. The recommended method of creation is to drag the nodes from the toolbox to the PFD. Define the design constraints on Mach number, noise, etc for the first scenario using the Scenario Manager. To access this view, select the Build menu, then Scenarios from the drop-down list. Define the pipe network (common to all scenarios). If the network is to be sized, some care must be taken in defining reasonable estimates for the pipe diameters. Add the next scenario by clicking the Add button on the Scenario Manager. The data for the sources should be cloned from the previously defined scenario that has the most similar data. Edit the design constraints of this scenario if necessary. Make the new scenario current. Highlight it on the Scenario Manager and click the Current button.

10 Edit the source data for each source for the new scenario. Double click sources on the PFD 11 Repeat steps #8 through #10 for all scenarios

Calculation Speed
Calculation time will often be only a small percentage of the time taken to construct the computer model. However, on low specification personal
3

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

computers, a sizing calculation for a complex multiple scenario model could take several hours, if not days, if care is not taken in the selection of the thermodynamic models or in the definition of the component slate. When considering the desired accuracy for the calculations, due consideration must be given to the fact that you are modeling a system that will rarely if ever come close to a steady state condition, with a steady state modeling tool.

Component Slate
As a rule of thumb you can assume that the calculation time is proportional to the square of the number of components. This is especially true when the VLE is calculated by an equation of state instead of treating the fluids as a simple compressible gas. Flare systems generally operate at conditions in which heavy components such as hexane or heavier will stay in the liquid phase throughout the system. You should therefore endeavor to characterize the heavy ends of petroleum fluids by as few components as possible. The properties that you use for the characterization should be optimized to: Ensure the component stays in the liquid phase. Match the liquid phase density.

VLE Method
Source compositions may be modeled either by definition of a molecular weight or by a detailed component by component analysis. When a composition is defined solely by molecular weight Flare System Analyzer analyzes the user defined component slate to select a pair of components whose molecular weights straddle the defined value. A binary composition is then calculated to match this value. This type of fluid characterization is only suitable for network analyses in which the fluids are assumed to be vapor, since the VLE behavior cannot be reasonably predicted from this level of detail. Thus the Compressible Gas VLE method is the only one that should ever be used in association with molecular weight modeling. When modeling using a detailed component by component analysis, if you are confident that the system will be liquid free then the Compressible Gas VLE method should be used since it does not have the overhead of determining the vapor/liquid equilibrium split. The computation time for the fluid properties then becomes several orders of magnitudes faster that those involving a liquid phase. When modeling a system in which two phase effects are important, consideration must be given to the pressures both upstream of the sources and within the flare piping. The Vapor Pressure VLE method, which is the fastest of the multiphase methods, is, strictly speaking, only valid for pressures below 10 bar. The reduced temperature of the fluid should also be greater than 0.3. Experience has shown that it also works to an acceptable degree of accuracy for flare system analysis at pressures well beyond this. If speed is an issue, then it is recommended that a scenario with as many active sources as possible be rated both using one of the cubic equations of state

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 8 Calculations The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

121

and this method. If acceptable agreement between the results is achieved then it may be reasonably assumed that the extrapolation is valid.

Sizing Calculations
The final calculations upon which a flare system is built should of course be made using the most detailed model consistent with the quality of data available, but for initial sizing calculations a number of points should be considered when selecting appropriate calculation methods. There is not generally a great deal of difference between the pressure drops calculated for a two phase system, whether calculated by treating the system as a compressible gas or as a two phase fluid. This occurs since as the fluid condenses the velocities will decrease but the two-phase friction factor will increase. Unless choked flow is allowed in the system, the back pressure on each source should not vary greatly with line size. The specification of a reasonable fixed downstream temperature for each source for use with the ideal gas enthalpy model should therefore give reasonable results. Build the network using reasonable estimates for the pipe diameters. Estimate the diameters from:

The recommended procedure for performing sizing calculations is as follows: 1

d=

W 300 PM

d = Diameter (m) W = Mass flow (kg/s) P = Tip pressure (bar abs) M = Design mach number 2 Rate the network for all the scenarios with your desired detailed model for the VLE and enthalpies. This will give reasonable temperatures downstream of each source. Copy the calculated temperatures downstream of each source to the source data by the Refresh Source Temperatures option under the Tools menu. Size the network for all scenarios using Compress Gas VLE and Ideal Gas enthalpies. Rate the network for all the scenarios with your desired detailed model for the VLE and enthalpies. If there are any design violations, make a debottlenecking calculation with these methods.

4 5

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

9 Databases

This section provides information on the following topics: Overview Database Features Setting the Password Pipe Schedule Database Editor Fittings Database Editor Component Database Editor

Overview
The data for the various installable components of the model are stored in user-modifiable database files. The database files are: SCHEDULE.MDB - The pipe schedule database. This contains data for both carbon steel and stainless steel pipe. FITTINGS.MDB - The pipe fittings database. COMPS.MDB - The pure component database.

These files are initially installed to the Database sub-directory in your main Flare System Analyzer directory. Note: You may add and edit your own data to the databases. However, you cannot edit or delete any of the original data. The databases may be password protected by a single password common to each. If the password has been disabled, or an incorrect access password has been entered, the databases may be reviewed in read-only mode. You must have defined an access password before any database can be edited. Note: Original data is always read-only.

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 9 Databases The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

123

Database Features
Selection Filter
The Selection Filter may be used to restrict the data which is shown. You may use the following wildcard characters: ? - Represents a single character. * - Represents a group of characters of undefined length. Any filter string has an implied * character at the end.

Some examples are shown below: As you navigate through the table, you will see that the standard database records are shown in black. User-defined records, which may be edited, are shown in blue.
Filter *0 1?0 1* *90* *Entrance* *thane M* Application Pipe Schedule Pipe Schedule Pipe Schedule Fittings Fittings Components Components Result 10, 20, 30, 40, 60, 80, 100, 120, 140, 160 100, 120, 140, 160 10, 100, 120, 140, 160 All 90 degree bends and elbows All Pipe Entrance fittings Methane, Ethane Methane, Mcyclopentane, etc.

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Maneuvering Through the Table


Click the table to select a record, and then navigate through the table using the navigator and scroll bar controls. Fig 8.1

Printing
Click the Print All button to print the pipe schedule, fittings or component data, depending on which editor you are currently using. Flare System Analyzer prints formatted output using the default printer settings.

Adding/Deleting Data
When the Add button is clicked, the cursor will move to the last record on the table and insert a new record that contains dummy data. You should override this data with your actual data. Note: User-defined data is shown in blue.
1. When you add items, they will then become immediately available to the

simulation.

2. Click the Delete button to delete the current record.

Note: You can only delete your own data.


3. Click OK to close the Database Editor view.

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 9 Databases The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

125

Setting The Password


To set or modify the password:
1. Select Set Password from the Database menu on the menu bar.

The Password Editor view will now be displayed. Fig 8.2

If you have already set your password, you first need to enter the existing password before supplying the new one.
1. Enter your existing password in the Old Password field. 2. Enter your new password in both the New Password and Confirm New

Password field and then click OK, or Cancel to abort the procedure.

Pipe Schedule Database Editor


The Pipe Schedule Database Editor allows you to view the pipe schedule data for all pipes in the database, and to add and edit user-defined entries.
1. To use the Pipe Schedule Database Editor, select Pipe Schedule from the

Database menu. After you enter the password, the Pipe Schedule Database Editor view will be displayed, as shown in Fig 8.3.

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Fig 8.3

2. If you have already set your password, you will need to enter the

password before accessing the databases.


3. Select the material you want to view using the Material drop-down list.

This may be either Carbon Steel or Stainless Steel. The Nominal Diameter, Schedule, Internal Diameter, Wall Thickness and Group for each entry are tabulated. The database can be modified by either adding or deleting the entries using the Add or Delete button, respectively. Click the Print All button to print the database to the printer defined in the Printer Setup view. For information on the Database view features that are common to the Pipe Schedule, Fittings and Components Databases, see Database Features.

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 9 Databases The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

127

Fittings Database Editor


The Fittings Database Editor allows you to view the pipe fittings data for all fittings types in the database, and to add and edit user-defined entries. To display the Fittings Database Editor, select Pipe Fittings from the Database menu. After you enter the password, the Fittings Database Editor view will be displayed, as shown in Fig 8.4. Fig 8.4

The description of each fitting, as well as the A and B term in the pipe fitting equation is tabulated. The Reference defines the literature source for the data. The pipe fitting equation is:

K = A + BFt
For information on the Database view features that are common to the Pipe Schedule, Fittings and Components Databases, see Database Features.

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Component Database Editor


The Component Database Editor allows you to view the component data for all the pure components in the database, and to add and edit user defined entries. To display the Component Database Editor, select Component from the Database menu. After you enter the password, the Component Database Editor view will be displayed, as shown in Fig 8.5. Fig 8.5

The data for each component in the database is tabulated. For information on the Database view features that are common to the Pipe Schedule, Fittings and Components Databases, see Database Features.

Importing Component Data


Additional components may be added to the database via an ASCII file whose format is given in Appendix B File Format. The component data file can be read into Flare System Analyzer by clicking the Import button on the Component Database Editor view. The Import button is unique to the Component Database Editor. This feature allows you to specify the text file, which must be created previously within HYSIM, on the Select Import File view.

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 9 Databases The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

129

Fig 8.6

A utility to create this file from a HYSIM case is supplied. Two steps are necessary in order to import component data from HYSIM Version 2.60 into the component database. 1 Export the component data from HYSIM. A calculator program must be executed within HYSIM in order to convert the component data to the proper format. Import the component data into Flare System Analyzer, via the component database editor. Load the HYSIM case containing the component data into HYSIM. At the main HYSIM command line prompt, type the command !EXPORT. You must previously have copied the file EXPORT.HCL into the HYSIM working directory from the \HYSIM directory under your main program directory. This need be done only once. When prompted for the name of the export file, enter the file name. This file will be given the extension .TXT. The transfer file will now be created (in your HYSIM directory).

In order to create the HYSIM transfer file: 1 2

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

10 Viewing Data and Results

This section provides information on the following topics: Components Data Scenarios Data Pipes Data Sources Data Nodes Data Messages Pressure/Flow Summary Compositions Physical Properties Profile Scenario Summary Graph Control Trace Window

Overview
Tabulated Data and Results can be viewed from the View menu in the menu bar. Note: For all of these views, columns can be resized and moved as described in Changing Column Width and Changing Column Order.

Components Data
Properties for all components in the current case can be viewed by selecting Data-Components from the View menu. Alternatively, you can use the key combination alt v d c.

www.cadfamily.com and Results 10 Viewing Data EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

131

Fig 9.1

Hypothetical components can be edited and database components viewed in the Component Editor view, by double clicking on any cell in the appropriate row. For more information on editing the components see Adding/Editing Components.

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Scenarios Data
Scenario data for all the scenarios in the case can be viewed by selecting Data-Scenarios from the View menu. Alternatively, you can use the key combination alt v d c. Fig 9.2

The Scenario Editor can be accessed by double clicking on any cell in the appropriate row. See Adding/Editing Scenarios for more information on editing scenarios.

Pipes Data
Properties of the pipe network on a segment-by-segment basis can be viewed by selecting Data-Pipes from the View menu. Alternatively, you can use the key combination alt v d p.

www.cadfamily.com and Results 10 Viewing Data EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

133

Fig 9.3

You can edit an individual segment by double clicking on any cell in the appropriate row. See Pipes Network for more information on editing pipe segments. Segments that are resizable are displayed in black and segments that are not resizable are displayed in blue. Once calculations are performed (and convergence is achieved), all segments whose size has been changed are displayed in magenta.

Sources Data
Source data can be viewed by selecting Data-Sources from the View menu. Alternatively, you can use the key combination alt v d p. Fig 9.4

To change scenarios, you could select the appropriate scenario tab, or select one from the Scenario Manager. You can edit an individual source by double clicking on any cell in the appropriate row. See Boundary Nodes for more information on editing sources. To view source data for a different scenario select the appropriate scenario in the scenario selector on the toolbar, and the Sources view will change accordingly.

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Nodes Data
Properties for all the nodes in the current case can be viewed by selecting Data and then Nodes from the View menu. Alternatively, you can use the key combination alt v d n. Fig 9.5

You can edit an individual node by double-clicking on any cell in the appropriate row. For information on editing nodes see Node Manager. The messages that are displayed depend on the Message options you have selected (see Warnings Tab).

Messages
Messages can be viewed by selecting Results-Messages from the View menu. Alternatively, you can use the key combination alt v r m. Note: The result messages can be viewed only after you have run the calculations.

www.cadfamily.com and Results 10 Viewing Data EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

135

Problems Tab
Any violations of the design constraints are shown on this tab. The following design constraints will be checked for violations: Mach Number Velocity pv2 Noise Back Pressure Temperature Slug Flow Ice Formation Fig 9.6

Data Echo Tab


The Data Echo tab shows the options chosen for the calculation. Fig 9.7

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Solver Tab
This tab displays any complications encountered by the solver. Fig 9.8

Sizing Tab
This tab displays the sequence of line size changes during sizing calculations. Fig 9.9

www.cadfamily.com and Results 10 Viewing Data EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

137

Loops tab
This tab displays the solution history for looped network calculations. Fig 9.10

The following variables are shown: Mass Flowrate Molar Flowrate Rated Flowrate Static Pressure Drop Noise Static Source Back Pressure Upstream (US) Static Pressure US Temperature US Velocity US Mach No. US Rho V2 US Energy Downstream (DS) Static Pressure DS Temperature DS Velocity DS Mach No. DS Rho V2 DS Energy Flow Regime Static Pipe Acceleration Loss Static Pipe Elevation Loss Static Pipe Fittings Loss Friction Factor Reynolds Number
3

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Duty Overall HTC External HTC Internal HTC Equivalent Length Physical Length

Pressure/Flow Summary
After running the case, you can view the Pressure/Flow Summary by selecting Results-Pressure/Flow Summary from the View menu. Fig 9.11

If any value violates a design limitation (e.g. - a Mach number is greater than the maximum allowable Mach number), it is displayed in emboldened red.

www.cadfamily.com and Results 10 Viewing Data EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

139

Compositions
After running the case, you can view the Compositions for each pipe segment by selecting Results-Compositions from the View menu. You can also use the alt v r c key combination to access the view. Fig 9.12

The Compositions view may not be available if Save Phase Properties is not active on the General tab of the Preferences Editor view.

Physical Properties
After running the case, you can view the Physical Properties for each pipe segment by selecting Results-Physical Properties from the View menu. The following properties are displayed (Upstream and Downstream): Density Enthalpy Entropy Phase Fraction Heat Capacity Molecular Weight Surface Tension Thermal Conductivity Viscosity Z Factor Alternatively, you can use the key combination alt v r r.

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Fig 9.13

The Physical Properties view may not be available if Save Phase Properties is not active on the General tab of the Preferences Editor view. You can view properties for different fluid phases by double-clicking anywhere inside the view. Each line expands to display properties for the various phases. Fig 9.14

F = Fluid (Overall) V = Vapor Phase L = Liquid Phase W = Water Phase M = Mixed (Water & Liquid) Double clicking again, inside the view, will contract the view to its original state.

www.cadfamily.com and Results 10 Viewing Data EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

141

Profile
After running the case, you can view the properties profile by selecting Results-Profile from the View menu or by pressing the key combination alt v r p. Fig 9.15

The following properties profiles are available: Pressure Temperature Mass Flow Molar Flow Mach No. Noise Rho V2 You can select the property type from the drop-down list. The Profile displays the profile from the selected Source (which may be chosen from the dropdown list at the top of the view) to the Flare.

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Five icons are available:


Name Print Icon Description Print the graph using the current printer settings. The output also includes important information such as the name of the file, the scenario, and the model statistics. Previews a summary of what the print out will look like. Save the graph to a windows metafile .wmf. You will be prompted for the file name and path. Copy the graph to the Windows clipboard. It can then be pasted in other applicable Windows applications (such as your word processor). Switch display from graph to table.

Preview Print Summary Save Copy

Toggle View Type

The plot can be modified by the 2D Chart Control Properties which is available on right clicking the mouse in the plot area. See Graph Control for more information on 2D Chart Control Properties view.

Flow Map
The flow map available in Flare System Analyzer displays the flow pattern correlation of Gregory Aziz and Mandhane which is currently the most widely used method. It was based on almost 6,000 flow pattern observations, from a variety of systems, and many independent studies and it is strictly applicable only to horizontal flow. Typically, the superficial gas and liquid velocities in a horizontal pipe are the most important single parameters influencing the flow pattern. After running the case, you can view the Gregory Aziz and Mandhane flow map by selecting Results-Flow Map from the View menu or by pressing the key combination alt v r w.

www.cadfamily.com and Results 10 Viewing Data EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

143

Fig 9.16

You can display the flow map for each pipe segment by selecting the desired pipe segment from the drop-down list on the top of the view. The upstream and downstream conditions are marked with a red dot and a label on the flow map. Unless the pipe segment has a single phase flow with a large pressure drop, both upstream and downstream pipe conditions will generally be close to each other. Four icons are available:
Name Print Icon Description Print the graph using the current printer settings. The output also includes important information such as the name of the file, the scenario, and the model statistics. Previews a summary of what the print out will look like. Save the graph to a windows metafile .wmf. You will be prompted for the file name and path. Copy the graph to the Windows clipboard. It can then be pasted in other applicable Windows applications (such as your word processor).

Preview Print Summary Save Copy

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Scenario Summary
After running the case, you can view the Scenario Summary by selecting Results-Scenario Summary from the View menu. Fig 9.17

You can select a source from the drop-down menu at the top of the view. Three icons are also available:
Name Print Icon Description Print the results using the current printer settings. The output also includes important information such as the name of the file, scenario, and the model statistics. Previews a summary of what the print out will look like. Save the results to an ASCII text file .txt. You will be prompted for the file name and path.

Preview Print Summary Save

www.cadfamily.com and Results 10 Viewing Data EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

145

Graph Control
The number of Pipe Segments, Nodes, Sources, Components and Scenarios is displayed, as well as the name and path of the current file. You can customize each individual plot in Flare System Analyzer using the Chart Control tool. You can modify many of the plot characteristics, which are categorized into the six tabs of the 2D Chart Control Properties view: Control, Axes, ChartStyles, Legend, ChartArea and PlotArea. Fig 9.18

You can open the 2D Chart Control Properties view by object inspecting any spot on an active plot.

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Control Tab
The Control tab is used to specify the background border, background and foreground colors and background image. Fig 9.19

The inner tabs available on the Control tab are: You can specify the color in three ways: Enter the hexadecimal number in the RGB box. Select the color from the Name drop-down list. Click on the color button and select the desired color from the Windows Color view by either double clicking on the color or clicking once and then clicking the OK button. The color button displays the current color
Inner Tab General Option IsBatched IsDoubleBuffered Load/Save buttons Description When checked, changes to the chart are not displayed on the screen. When checked, changes to the chart are buffered so the screen is updates as smoothly as possible. Click the Load button to load a new chart description file. You can save the current chart to a chart description file, using the Save button. Border Type Width Select the border type drawn around the area from the drop-down list. Enter the boarder type width in pixels. Valid values are between 0 and 20 pixels.

www.cadfamily.com and Results 10 Viewing Data EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

147

Interior

Background Color RGB

The colored square button labeled ... provides access to the standard Windows color picker dialogue view to allow selection of the background color for the graph. The color of the button shows the current selection. Select the color name from the drop-down list. Description The colored square button labeled ... provides access to the standard Windows color picker dialogue view to allow selection of the background color for the graph. The color of the button shows the current selection. Select the Color name from the drop-down list. Specifies the background image file either by entering the file path or by clicking the extension button and then selecting the appropriate file from the File Open view. Select the way you want the image to be displayed in the background. When checked, the image is embedded into the chart. When unchecked, the chart looks for the image in the specified location. Click this button to return the chart element background to its default.

Background Color Name Inner Tab Option Foreground Color RGB

Foreground Color Name Image File

Layout IsEmbedded

Reset button

When the Name drop-down list displays: Automatic. The background is transparent. Undefined. There is no matching color name for the specified color.

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Axes Tab
The Axes tab allows you to customize the plot area, using the following inner tabs: Fig 9.20

www.cadfamily.com and Results 10 Viewing Data EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

149

Inner Tab General

Option IsShowing IsLogarithmic IsReversed Is100Percent

Description Displays or hides the selected axis. When checked, the selected axis will be interpreted logarithmically (log base 10) instead of linearly. If checked, the selected axis will be displayed in reverse direction. When checked, each series in a Stacking Bar chart is scaled to represent 100 percent, and each value within the series is a given percentage of the total. Specifies how the axis is annotated. Click the button on the right to specify additional information for this annotation method. Specifies where to place the annotation. If this option is disabled, it does not apply to the selected axis. Specifies where to place the origin. If this option is disabled, it does not apply to the selected axis. Rotates annotation text at the angle you specify. You can specify whether to round axis numbering. Creates values for a second Y-axis (Y2) by multiplying Y-axis numbering by this value. This option is only enabled for the Y2axis. Add this value to Y2-axis numbering generated by Y Multiplier. This option is only enabled for Y2-axis. Specify the highest possible data value for the selected axis. Specify the lowest data value for the selected axis. Specify the maximum axis value. Specify the minimum axis value. Specify the origin of the selected axis. Enter the title text for the selected axis. Rotates title text at the angle you specify. The x-axis title text cannot be rotated. When checked, the GridStyle returns to the default. If this option is disabled, it does not apply to the selected axis. Specifies the grid increment. If this option is disabled, it does not apply to the selected axis. List the available line patterns. Specify the width of the line, in pixels. The colored square button labeled ... provides access to the standard Windows color picker dialogue view to allow selection of the color used for the selected axis and its label. The color of the button shows the current selection. List the name of the specified line color. To choose a new color by its name, click the down arrow or type the name of the color here. When displaying Undefined, there is no matching color name for the specified color.

Annotation

Annotation Method Annotation Place Origin Place Annotation Rotation Numerical Method Y Multiplier

Y Constant Scale Data Maximum Data Minimum Maximum Minimum Origin Title Text Title Rotation Grid IsStyleDefault Spacing AxisStyle & GridStyle Pattern Width Color RGB

Color name

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Font

Description Sample

List the current font setting for the text. Click the button on the right to choose a new font, size, or style. Shows a sample of how text will appear with the specified font setting. Specify where on the y-axis the x-axis is located. Specify the angle from the origin where the axis is annotated.

Polar/Radar

Origin Base Annotation Angle

ChartGroup Tab
This tab allows you to customize ChartGroups attributes, such as the chart type and the data itself. Fig 9.21

The inner tabs available on the ChartGroup tab are:


Inner Tab General Option ChartType DrawingOrder Data Layout Hole NumSeries NumPoints XValue Description Select the chart type, from the drop-down list, for the selected ChartGroup. Specifies the order that the selected ChartGroup is drawn. Specifies the format of the chart data. Specifies the value that represents the missing data values or holes. Specifies the number of series in the data. Specifies the number of points in the data. Lists an editable X data value at ThisSeries and ThisValue.

www.cadfamily.com and Results 10 Viewing Data EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

151

YValue ThisSeries

Lists an editable Y data value at ThisSeries and ThisValue. Selects a data series to view or edit. Use with ThisPoint to select a particular data point. XValue and YValue display the X and Y coordinates at this series/point. Selects a data point to view or edit. Use with ThisSeries to select a particular data point. XValue and YValue display the X and Y coordinates at this series/point. Description Load new data into the ChartGroup. Save the selected ChartGroups data to a file. Edit chart data Select the series you want to display. Sort the points in each series from lowest to highest X value. Enter the label text for the currently-defined Point-Label and Series-Label. Add a label after the selected Label in the list.

ThisPoint

Inner Tab

Option Load button Save button Edit button Series button Sort button

Labels

Text Add button

Internet Binding

Remove button Datapath Field Add button Remove button Bar Set ClusterOverlap

Remove the selected Label from the list. Specify a URL to load a chart description form. Specifies which field from the bound database is drawn. Add a bound database to the chart. Remove a bound database from the chart. Applies the field name typed in the Field dropdown list. Specifies the spacing within each bar cluster. Positive values overlap the bars, negative values space the bar apart. Specifies the percentage of space used by each bar cluster. Remove a bound database from the chart. Applies the field name typed in the Field dropdown list. Specifies the spacing within each bar cluster. Positive values overlap the bars, negative values space the bar apart.

ClusterWidth Remove button Bar Set ClusterOverlap

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

ClusterWidth Candle Polar HiLoOpenClose Pie IsHalfRange IsComplex

Specifies the percentage of space used by each bar cluster. When checked, the chart displays as a complex Candle type. When checked, the X-axis is represented as 180 degrees. X values that are greater than 180 degrees are represented as negative. When checked, the chart displays the Open value line. When checked, the chart displays the Close value line. When checked, the chart displays the Open and Close value lines. Specifies the order that pie slices are displayed. Specifies the method used to group low values into the other slice. Provides a place for you to enter the value used with ThresholdMethod. To disable creation of the other slice, set this to 0. Specifies the minimum number of pie slices to display before grouping values into the other slice. Change the text used to label the other pie slice. Lists the available fill patterns. Lists the RGB value of the fill color. Valid values are between #000000 and #ffffff. Lists the name of the specified fill color. To choose a new color by its name, click the down arrow or type the name of the color here. When displaying Undefined, there is no matching color name for the specified color.

IsShowingOpen IsShowingClose IsOpenCloseFullWidth SortOrder ThresholdMethod ThresholdValue

MinSlices OtherSlice

Text Pattern Color RGB Color Name

www.cadfamily.com and Results 10 Viewing Data EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

153

ChartStyles Tab
The ChartStyles tab allows you to customize how data series look in the chart. The inner tabs available on the ChartStyles tab are: Click the Add button to add a ChartStyle after the selected Style in the list. Click the Remove button to remove the selected ChartStyle from the list. Fig 9.22

Inner Tab FillStyle

Option Pattern Color RGB

Description This drop-down list lists the available fill patterns. The colored square button labeled ... provides access to the standard Windows color picker dialogue view to allow selection of the color used for the selected fill. The color of the button shows the current selection. Lists the name of the specified fill color. To choose a new color by its name, click the down arrow or type the name of the color here. When displaying Undefined, there is no matching color name for the specified color.

Color Name

LineStyle

Pattern Width Color RGB

Lists the available line patterns. Specifies the width of the line, in pixels. The colored square button labeled ... provides access to the standard Windows color picker dialogue view to allow selection of the color used for the selected line. The color of the button shows the current selection.

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Color Name

Lists the name of the specified fill color. To choose a new color by its name, click the down arrow or type the name of the color. When displaying Undefined, there is no matching color name for the specified color.

SymbolStyle Inner Tab

Shape Size Option Color RGB

Lists the available symbol shapes. Specifies the size of the symbol. Description The colored square button labeled ... provides access to the standard Windows color picker dialogue view to allow selection of the color used for the selected symbol. The color of the button shows the current selection. Lists the name of the specified symbol color. To choose a new color by its name, click the down arrow or type the name of the color here. When displaying Undefined, there is no matching color name for the specified color.

Color Name

Titles Tab
You can customize the header and footer on the following inner tabs of the Title tab. Fig 9.23

www.cadfamily.com and Results 10 Viewing Data EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

155

Inner Tab General

Option Adjust IsShowing

Description You can specify how to align multiple lines of header or footer. Displays the header or footer, if its label contains text. Provides a place for you to enter or change the text of this label. You can enter multiple lines of test by pressing enter at the end of each line. Specifies the distance from the left edge of the chart to the area, in pixels. If this option is disabled, you cannot change the position of this area. Specifies the distance from the top edge of the chart to the area, in pixels. If this option is disabled, the distance cannot be changed. Specifies the width of the area in pixels. If this option is disabled, the width cannot be changed. Specifies the height of the area in pixels. If this option is disabled, the height cannot be changed. Specifies the type of border drawn around the area. If this option is disabled, you cannot change the border type. Specifies the width of the border in pixels. Enter the RGB value for the specified background color. Valid values are between #000000 and #ffffff. List the name of the specified background color. To choose a new color by its name, click the down arrow or type the name of the color. Enter the RGB value for the specified foreground color. Valid values are between #000000 and #ffffff. List the name of the specified foreground color. To choose a new color by its name, click the down arrow or type the name of the color. List the current font setting for the text. Click the button on the right to choose a new font, size, or style. Shows a sample of how text will appear with the specified font setting. Specifies the file name and path of the image you want to load into the chart element. Select the way you want the image to be displayed in the background. When checked, the image is embedded into the chart. When unchecked, the chart looks for the image in the specified location. Click this button to return the chart element background to its default.

Label

Text

Location

Left

Top

Width Height Border Type

Width Interior Background Color RGB Background Color Name Foreground Color RGB Foreground Color Name Font Description

Sample Image File Layout IsEmbedded

Reset button

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Legend Tab
The Legend tab allows you to customize the legend on the following inner tabs: Fig 9.24

www.cadfamily.com and Results 10 Viewing Data EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

157

Inner Tab General

Option Anchor

Description Specifies where the legend is positioned, relative to the ChartArea. You can fine-tune the positioning with the Location inner tab. Specifies the layout of items in the Legend. Displays the label, if Series-labels have been defined. Specifies the distance from the left edge of the chart to the area, in pixels. If this option is disabled, you cannot change the position of this area. Specifies the distance from the top edge of the chart to the area, in pixels. If this option is disabled, the distance cannot be changed. Specifies the width of the area in pixels. If this option is disabled, the width cannot be changed. Specifies the height of the area in pixels. If this option is disabled, the height cannot be changed. Specifies the type of border drawn around the area. If this option is disabled, you cannot change the border type. Specifies the width of the border in pixels. The colored square button labeled ... provides access to the standard Windows color picker dialogue view to allow selection of the color used for the legend background. The color of the button shows the current selection. List the name of the specified background color. To choose a new color by its name, click the down arrow or type the name of the color. The colored square button labeled ... provides access to the standard Windows color picker dialogue view to allow selection of the color used for the legend label text. The color of the button shows the current selection. List the name of the specified foreground color. To choose a new color by its name, click the down arrow or type the name of the color. List the current font setting for the text. Click the button on the right to choose a new font, size, or style. Shows a sample of how text will appear with the specified font setting. Specifies the file name and path of the image you want to load into the chart element. Select the way you want the image to be displayed in the background. When checked, the image is embedded into the chart. When unchecked, the chart looks for the image in the specified location. Click this button to return the chart element background to its default.

Orientation IsShowing Location Left

Top

Width Height Border Type

Width Interior Background Color RGB

Background Color Name Foreground Color RGB

Foreground Color Name Font Description Sample Image File Layout IsEmbedded

Reset button

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

ChartArea Tab
The ChartArea tab allows you to customize the chart area in detail. Fig 9.25

www.cadfamily.com and Results 10 Viewing Data EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

159

Inner Tab General

Option IsHorizontal IsShowingOutlines AngleUnit

Description Reverses the orientation of X- and Y-axis, making the chart appear horizontal. When checked the chart outlines each series. For Polar, Radar and Filled Radar charts, specifies the angle of measurement. Specifies the distance from the left edge of the chart to the area, in pixels. If this option is disabled, you cannot change the position of this area. Specifies the distance from the top edge of the chart to the area, in pixels. If this option is disabled, the distance cannot be changed. Specifies the width of the area in pixels. If this option is disabled, the width cannot be changed. Specifies the height of the area in pixels. If this option is disabled, the height cannot be changed. Specifies the type of border drawn around the area. If this option is disabled, you cannot change the border type. Specifies the width of the border in pixels. The colored square button labeled ... provides access to the standard Windows color picker dialogue view to allow selection of the color used for the chart area background. The color of the button shows the current selection. List the name of the specified background color. To choose a new color by its name, click the down arrow or type the name of the color. The colored square button labeled ... provides access to the standard Windows color picker dialogue view to allow selection of the color used for the chart axes. This selection will be overridden by any axis setting (see Axes Tab). The color of the button shows the current selection. List the name of the specified foreground color. To choose a new color by its name, click the down arrow or type the name of the color. Specifies the file name and path of the image you want to load into the chart element. Select the way you want the image to be displayed in the background. When checked, the image is embedded into the chart. When unchecked, the chart looks for the image in the specified location. Click this button to return the chart element background to its default.

Location

Left

Top

Width Height Border Type

Width Interior Background Color RGB

Background Color Name Foreground Color RGB

Foreground Color Name Image File Layout IsEmbedded

Reset button

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Plot Area Tab


The plot area can be customized on the PlotArea tab using the following inner tabs: Fig 9.26

www.cadfamily.com and Results 10 Viewing Data EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

161

Inner Tab General

Option IsBoxed Top

Description Draws a box around the plot area. Specifies the distance from the top of the chart area to the axis. Positive values allow space for axis labels; negative values let you zoom in on a chart. Specifies the distance from the bottom of the chart area to the axis. Positive values allow space for axis labels; negative values let you zoom in on a chart. Specifies the distance from the left side of the chart area to the axis. Positive values allow space for axis labels; negative values let you zoom in on a chart. Specifies the distance from the right side of the chart area to the axis. Positive values allow space for axis labels; negative values let you zoom in on a chart. The colored square button labeled ... provides access to the standard Windows color picker dialogue view to allow selection of the color used for the plot area background. The color of the button shows the current selection. List the name of the specified background color. To choose a new color by its name, click the down arrow or type the name of the color. The colored square button labeled ... provides access to the standard Windows color picker dialogue view to allow selection of the color used for the plot area foreground. The color of the button shows the current selection. List the name of the specified foreground color. To choose a new color by its name, click the down arrow or type the name of the color. Specifies the file name and path of the image you want to load into the chart element. The button labeled ... allows you to use the standard Windows file browser to search for and select the file. Select the way you want the image to be displayed in the background. When checked, the image is embedded into the chart. When unchecked, the chart looks for the image in the specified location. Click this button to return the chart element background to its default.

Bottom

Left

Right

Interior

Background Color RGB

Background Color Name Foreground Color RGB

Foreground Color Name Image File

Layout IsEmbedded

Reset button

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

ChartLabel Tab
The ChartLabel tab allows you to customize chart labels and text annotation which you can add to the chart. Fig 9.27

The inner tabs available on this tab are:


Inner Tab General Option Name Offset Anchor IsShowing Adjust IsConnected Rotation AttachMethod Description Enter the name of the selected ChartLabel. Specifies the distance between the ChartLabel and its attachment point. Specifies where the ChartLabel is positioned, relative to where it is attached. Displays the selected ChartLabel, if the text is displayed on the Label tab. Specifies how to align multiple lines of text in the selected ChartLabel. Draw a line connecting the ChartLabel to its attachment location. Specifies the degree of rotation for the selected ChartLabel. Click this to set how and where to attach the selected ChartLabel to the chart. ChartLabels can be attached to screen coordinates, graph coordinates, a series and point in the data, or a Y-value at a series/point.

www.cadfamily.com and Results 10 Viewing Data EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

163

continued Inner Tab Label Option Text Description Provides a place for you to enter or change the text of this label. You can enter multiple lines of text by pressing enter at the end of each line. Specifies the type of border drawn around the area. If this option is disabled, you cannot change the border type. Specifies the width of the border in pixels. Enter the RGB value for the specified background color. Valid values are between #000000 and #ffffff. List the name of the specified background color. To choose a new color by its name, click the down arrow or type the name of the color. Enter the RGB value for the specified foreground color. Valid values are between #000000 and #ffffff. List the name of the specified foreground color. To choose a new color by its name, click the down arrow or type the name of the color. List the current font setting for the text. Click the button on the right to choose a new font, size, or style. Shows a sample of how text will appear with the specified font setting. Specifies the distance from the left edge of the chart to the area, in pixels. If this option is disabled, you cannot change the position of this area. Specifies the distance from the top edge of the chart to the area, in pixels. If this option is disabled, the distance cannot be changed. Specifies the width of the area in pixels. If this option is disabled, the width cannot be changed. Specifies the height of the area in pixels. If this option is disabled, the height cannot be changed. Specifies the file name and path of the image you want to load into the chart element. Select the way you want the image to be displayed in the background. When checked, the image is embedded into the chart. When unchecked, the chart looks for the image in the specified location. Click this button to return the chart element background to its default.

Border

Type

Width Interior Background Color RGB Background Color Name Foreground Color RGB Foreground Color Name Font Description

Sample Location Left

Top

Width

Height

Image

File Layout IsEmbedded

Reset button

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

View3D tab
The View3D tab allows you to customize 3D effect you can use with bar, sticking bar, or pie charts. Fig 9.28

Inner Tab General

Option Depth

Description Specifies depth of bar/pie 3D effect, as a percentage of the total width of the chart. This must be greater than zero to display any 3D effect. Specifies the elevation angle of the 3D effect, as degrees above the X-axis. Specifies the rotation angle of the 3D effect, as degrees to the right of the Y-axis. This is not applicable to the pie charts. Specifies the shading method for the 3D portions of the graph. The Dithering shading method uses the graph color and uses either white or blacks dots to make the resulting color lighter or darker, respectively. The Color shading method uses either a darker or lighter shade of the graph color to create the 3D effect.

Elevation Rotation

Shading

www.cadfamily.com and Results 10 Viewing Data EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

165

Markers Tab
The Markers tab allows you to add and customize markers on the chart using the following inner tabs: Fig 9.29

Inner Tab General

Option IsShowing IsStyleDefault

Description Display the marker, if a location has been specified on the Attach tab. When checked, the LineStyle returns to default. Locates the selected marker at graph coordinates. Use X, Y, and Group to specify the graph coordinates. Specifies the X coordinate at which to locate the marker. If this option is disabled, it does not apply to the selected marker. Specifies the Y coordinate at which to locate the marker. If this option is disabled, it does not apply to the selected marker. Specifies which ChartGroups data to use for the coordinates. Locates the selected marker at a data point (X marker only). Use Series, Point and Group to specify the data point. Specifies the series at which to locate the marker. This option is only enabled for the X marker. Specifies the point at which to locate the marker. This option is only enabled for the X marker. Specifies which ChartGroups data to use for the value. This option is only enabled for the X marker.

Attach

By Value

Group By Data

Series Point Group

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

continued Inner Tab LineStyle Option Pattern Width Color RGB Color Name Description Lists the available line patterns. Specifies the width of the line, in pixels. Lists the RGB value of the fill color. Valid values are between #000000 and #ffffff. Lists the name of the specified fill color. To choose a new color by its name, click the down arrow or type the name of the color. When displaying Undefined, there is no matching color name for the specified color.

Trace Window
The Trace window is opened using the Trace option from the View menu. When open, it is used by Flare System Analyzer to list the progress of calculations as they are carried out. It may also be used to list the actions taken during import of data from an Access, Excel or XML data file through the Import Wizard. The Trace window must be opened prior to starting calculations or the import process. The number of entries held in the Trace window can be set using the Trace Buffer option in the Preferences Editor view.

www.cadfamily.com and Results 10 Viewing Data EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

167

11 PFD

This section provides information on the following topics: Overview Object Inspection PFD Toolbar Installing Objects Connecting Objects Manipulating the PDF Printing and Saving the PFD Image Changing the PFD View Options

Overview
One of the key benefits of the Process Flow Diagram (PFD) is that it provides the best representation of the flare system model as a whole. From this one location, you have an immediate reference to your current progress in building the Flare network. The PFD has been developed to satisfy a number of functions. In addition to the graphical representation, you can build your flowsheet within the PFD using the mouse to install objects and make connections. You can also reposition objects, resize icons and reroute connections. The PFD also possesses analytical capabilities in that you can access the Edit views for nodes, pipe segments, and sources which are displayed.

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Each object has a specific icon to represent it:


Object Pipe-Segment Flare Tip Icon

Connector Tee

Relief Valve Control Valve

Vertical Separator

Horizontal Separator

Orifice Plate Flow Bleed

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 11 PFD The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

169

To open the PFD, select PFD-Open from the View menu. A separate view with its own tool bar is opened. Fig 10.1

Object Inspection
One of the key features of the Flare System Analyzer PFD is the ability to inspect objects in the flowsheet. If you double-click on any pipe-segment, source or node, the appropriate edit view will be opened for that object.

PFD Toolbar
There are several tools that help to simplify your interaction with the PFD. The most basic tools relate to what is displayed in the PFD view.

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

PFD Toolbar Icons


The PFD toolbar icons are arranged as follows: Fig 10.2

These icons perform the functions explained below:


Name Print PFD Preview Print PFD Save Image as Windows Metafile Copy Image to Clipboard Toggle Grid Display Coarser Grid Icon Description Print the PFD to the Printer. Previews a summary of what the print out will look like. Save the PFD to file. It is saved in .emf format (Enhanced Metafile). Copies the PFD to the clipboard, allowing you to paste it into other applications. Toggle the grid on and off. When the grid is on, this icon will be faded. This icon increases grid spacing. All objects you move or add "snap to" the current grid spacing. This icon decreases grid spacing. All objects you move or add "snap to" the current grid spacing. Toggles the snap to grid option on and off. When the snap to grid is on all pipe segments and nodes will be snapped to the closest grids. This icon zooms the display in. This icon zooms the display out. Fit PFD in the view. When you click this icon, the entire PFD will be reduced and enlarged to fit the PFD view. Zoom to the normal size (100%). At this size, all text and icons are easily readable. Rotate the selected pipe segments and nodes. Toggle between bent and straight connections. All current connections (and any connections you subsequently make) will conform to the connection method you have selected. Toggle between Arrange and Connect modes. Arrange mode allows you to move icons and labels. Connect mode allows you to graphically connect compatible objects. The status bar on the PFD shows which mode is activated.

W The ctrl SHIFT S hot key snaps the objects to the grid. While in the snap mode, the Status bar displays the word Snap.

Finer Grid Toggle Snap To Grid On/Off Zoom In Zoom Out Zoom to Fit

Zoom Full Rotate Selected PFD Objects Toggle Direct/Orthogonal connections Toggle Connect/Arrange Mode

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 11 PFD The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

171

Add Annotation

The Add Annotation icon allows you to add blocks of text or notes to the PFD. Clicking it displays the Annotation Editor view shown below as Figure 10.3. This icon toggles the Toolbox view.

Toggle Palette Display

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Fig 10.3

The data entry items and buttons on the Annotation Editor are as follows:
Item Text Description This panel allows you to enter the text to be displayed on the PFD. The text entered will not word wrap, but line breaks can be inserted using the shift enter key combination. This drop-down list allows selection of the alignment of the annotation. The options are Left, Right and Center. The Font button allows selection of the font to be used to display the annotation using the Windows Font Picker. The default font face and size that will be used may be set through the PFD tab of the Preferences Editor view see PFD Tab. Click this button to close the annotation view and display the annotation.

Alignment Font Button

OK Button

Print Options
You can specify the area of the PFD that you desire to print by selecting the following options available on the PFD toolbar.
Option Print Visible Print All Print Selected Description Print part of the PFD visible on the screen. Print the whole PFD. Print only the selected part of the PFD. You can highlight the part of the PFD by clicking once on the PFD and than dragging the section of PFD. The PFD is printed without the page header and footer to allow compilation of a multiple tiled image.

The following properties are available: Energy Flow Length Mach Number Mass Flow Molecular Weight

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 11 PFD The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

173

Molar Flow Noise Nominal Diameter Pressure Rho V2 Temperature Vapor Fraction (Molar) Velocity Velocity (Liq) Velocity (Vap) Pressure / Mass Flow option Pressure / Temperature Pressure / Mach No. Length / Nom. Diam MABP Approach.

Stream Label Options


By default, each object on the PFD has a label that displays its name. You can change all object name labels so that the current value of a key variable is shown in the place of each object name. You can choose between the type of labels for the pipe segments and nodes by selecting the property drop-down list on the PFD toolbar. Fig 10.4

The display field on the right side of the property drop-down list displays the default units for the chosen property. If the object label is red in color it indicates that the object violated the limits setup in the Scenarios Editor or the fluid is in the slug region. Some of the possible causes are ice formation, slug flow, temperature violation and source back pressure. If the object label is gray in color it indicates that the object is ignored for calculation by activating the Ignore checkbox on the object property view.

Viewports Option
You have the option to change the PFD viewports. By default, a single PFD viewport is defined as Overall. You can specify a different setting for each viewport including percent zoom and stream labels.

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Add a New Viewport


New viewports can be added to the PFD by right clicking the title bar of the PFD view and selecting Add Viewport from the displayed menu. The new viewport is created with the default PFD settings i.e. 100% size and No property labels but will show the same view as the PFD. The Viewport Selector on the PFD toolbar will show that a new view has been created. Once multiple viewports have been created, the Viewport Selector dropdown list on the PFD toolbar can be used to select the view required.

Delete an Existing Viewport


You can delete an existing viewport from the PFD by right clicking the PFD view title bar and selecting the Delete Viewport from the menu.

Print Viewport
Visible viewports can be printed to a selected printer by right clicking on the PFD view title bar and choosing the Print Window from the menu.

Installing Objects
The PFD can be used to install objects into the flowsheet, as well as connect compatible objects. Object specifications are then supplied via the appropriate Property view which can be accessed by double-clicking the object icon. The PFD Toolbox is used to install operations. The Toolbox can be accessed by doing one of the following: Open the View menu and then open the PFD sub-menu. Select Toolbox. Press the f4 key. Click the Toolbox icon on the PFD toolbar.

Fig 10.5

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 11 PFD The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

175

If the Edit Objects on Add checkbox is activated in the Preferences editor, the Object editor view will be open for each new object which is added to the PFD. The procedure for installing operations via the Toolbox is as follows: 1 2 3 Click the desired object in the PFD Toolbox. You will see the icon being depressed. Click in the specific area in the PFD where you want to place the object icon. The object then appears in the PFD. Drag and drop the desired object using the secondary mouse key.

To delete an object, select the object you want to delete, and then press the delete key.

Connecting Objects
To connect objects: 1 2 3 4 5 Enter connect mode by clicking the Connect icon on the toolbar. This toggles between connect and arrange modes. Click on the source object to select it. Move the mouse pointer over the central handle point (blue fill instead of white for this handle point) then press the left mouse button. Drag off the source object and over the destination object. Release the left mouse button.

The current mode is displayed on the left of PFD status bar.

Manipulating the PFD


Note: Flare System Analyzer allows you to select single objects as well as multiple objects, but in order to select an object, you must be in Arrange mode. There are a number of features built into the PFD interface to modify its appearance. The manipulations apply to all objects that are installed in the PFD.

Selecting PFD Objects


To select a single object, position the mouse pointer on top of the object, and then click once with the left mouse button. The selected object will have eight small boxes outlining its border. These small boxes are used to size an object. Note: The text must be selected separately; that is, when you select an object, the corresponding text is not also automatically selected.

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

There are two methods you can use to select multiple objects:

Method One
1 If the objects are all contained within the same area, the quickest and easiest way is to marquee select that group. Press the left mouse button (outside the group), and drag the mouse so that a box appears. Continue dragging until this box contains all the objects that you want selected. When you release the mouse button, each object will have its own rectangular box surrounding it, indicating it has been selected.

2 3

Method Two
1 2 3 Position the mouse pointer on the first object in the PFD you want to select. Press the left mouse button to select this object. To select a second object, hold down the SHIFT key or ctrl key, and then click on the second object with the left mouse button. Two objects will now be selected. Continue this method for the remainder of the objects you want to select.

Unselecting Objects
The following methods can be used: Click on an empty spot in the PFD with the left mouse button. To unselect only one item, press the shift key and click on the object with the left mouse button.

Moving Objects
If the grid is on, all objects which are moved will "snap to" the grid. Their movement will be constrained to the grid spacing. You can move objects individually, or as a group. 1 2 3 Select the item or items you want to move. Position the mouse pointer on one of the objects and press the left mouse button. Drag the mouse to the new position on the PFD and release the mouse button. All selected items will move to the new location.

Locating Objects on the PFD


You can locate individual objects on the PFD by pressing the ctrl shift f hot keys, which displays the Locate Object view. You can select individual objects from the list by clicking on them using the primary mouse key. The object will be highlighted on the PFD.

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 11 PFD The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

177

Regenerate PFD
Use this function to reposition all objects in a logical manner. Select PFDRegenerate from the View menu. This feature is a great time-saver especially when you have not laid out the PFD as you were building the case. Rather than placing all objects yourself, regenerate the PFD in this manner. You can then make additional changes to further fine-tune your PFD. Regenerate PFD option places all the objects along a vertical path in the best possible manner. It is not recommended to regenerate well laid out PFDs.

Printing and Saving the PFD Image


The first three toolbar icons are used to transfer the PFD to the printer, Windows Metafile and to memory. To print the PFD using the current Print Setup, click the Print PFD icon. For more information on the Print Setup, see Printer Setup. To save the PFD in .emf format (Enhanced Metafile), click the Save PFD icon. You will be prompted to enter a file name: Fig 10.6

Enter the file name and path and click OK. To view the PFD, you can then use a program which is capable of reading .emf files (such as Corel DrawTM). To copy the PFD to the clipboard, click the Copy PFD icon. You can then paste it into other Windows applications as you would with any Windows object.

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Changing the PFD View Options


When in the PFD view, Flare System Analyzer allows you to select several view options, namely, Grid, Rotate, and Connection. All of these options are available via toolbar. The following is a description of each icon:
Toolbar Object Toggle Grid Display icon Description When the Grid toolbar icon is selected, a grid is superimposed upon the existing PFD. There are also 3 icons beside the Grid toolbar icon. These icons allow you to either increase or decrease the grid density as well as snap the elements to grid. You can select to rotate or mirror (flip) the selected object about its center in one of the following five ways: Rotate 90 Rotate 180 Rotate 270 Flip Y Flip X Zoom There are four buttons associated with the Zoom feature of the PFD, Zoom in, Zoom out, Zoom to Fit and Zoom to Full Size. When the Zoom In Button is pressed, the current PFD view's resolution is increased, while its scope is decreased. Alternatively, when the Zoom Out button is pressed, the resolution is decreased while the scope is increased. When the Zoom to Fit button is selected, the view is redrawn in such a way as to include the entire PFD in one view. If the Zoom to Full Size button is pressed, the view will regenerate to its full size. All objects you move or add "snap to" the current grid spacing. The grid spacing is independent of the zoom. Toggle Direct/Orthogonal Connections These icons allow you to toggle between direct and orthogonal connecting lines.

Rotate Selected PFD Objects icon

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 11 PFD The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

179

12 Printing, Importing and Exporting

This section provides information on the following topics: Overview Printing Import Wizard Importing Source Data Export Wizard Export Data Layouts Import/Export Examples

Overview
Data can be either exported to, or imported from a number of external sources. The printing of data and results is included as an export function since the printing functionality incorporated within Flare System Analyzer can also be used to export data and results in a number of industry standard formats. The following data may be exported from Flare System Analyzer: All data and results may be printed on any Windows-compatible printer. All data and results may be saved as either ASCII text, Comma-separated text, or Tab-separated text. The Export Wizard allows selected data and results to be exported to Access database files, Excel spreadsheet files or XML data files.

The following data may be imported into Flare System Analyzer: Source data from the HYSIM and HYSYS process simulators. This data is transferred via an ASCII file. Consequently, it should be possible to import source data from any external source provided it conforms to this file format. Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Component data from the HYSIM process simulator, which is discussed in Importing Component Data. This data is transferred via an ASCII file. Consequently, it should be possible to import component data from any external source provided it conforms to this file format. The Import Wizard allows selected data to be imported from Access databases, Excel spreadsheets or XML data files.

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com and Exporting The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

12 Printing, Importing

181

Printing
In order to print either model data or calculation results that are not specific to a single source, select Print from the File menu. The Print view will be displayed. Fig 11.1

Select the items that you want to print by checking the appropriate checkboxes in the Database, Data and Results group. By default, the printout is only for the current scenario. Check the All Scenarios checkbox if you want printouts for all of the scenarios. If you want the results to be saved as an ASCII text file, check the Print To File checkbox. You will then be able to select the file format via the Text File Format drop-down menu. The following file formats are supported: Text - Saves the data in ASCII format, with all values separated by spaces. CSV, Comma Separated - Saves the data in ASCII format, with all values separated by commas. TSV, Tab Separated - Saves the data in ASCII format, with all values separated by tabs.

If you checked the Print To File checkbox, the Print To File view will be displayed when you click OK.

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Fig 11.2

Select or directly enter the file, then click OK. If you did not check the Print To File checkbox, the results will immediately be printed when you click OK on the Print view.

FMT Files
The printouts can be customized to a limited extent using a series of ASCII text files with the extension ".fmt". These files may be edited using any ASCII text editor such as the NOTEPAD application distributed with Microsoft Windows. The default ".fmt" files for each printed report are:
Report Component Database Pipe Fittings Database Pipe Schedules Database Components Scenarios Pipes Source Nodes Messages Pressure/Flow Summary Compositions Physical Properties Scenario Summary .fmt File DbComps.fmt DbFittings.fmt DbSchedules.fmt Comps.fmt Scenarios.fmt Pipes.fmt Sources.fmt Nodes.fmt Messages.fmt Summary.fmt MoleFracs.fmt Properties.fmt ScenSum.fmt

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com and Exporting The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

12 Printing, Importing

183

By default, these files are located in the Flare System Analyzer program directory. You can change the location and ".fmt" file for each report via the Reports tab on the Preferences Editor view. Fig 11.3

These files conform to the format shown in Appendix B - File Format.

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Location-Specific Printing
Results that are specific to a single source must be printed individually. The Profile, Flow Map and Scenario Summary views each have a Print icon which can be clicked to print the displayed data. The Profile view is shown here: Fig 11.4

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com and Exporting The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

12 Printing, Importing

185

Printer Setup
The Print Setup Options vary for different printers. To edit the printer setup, select Printer Setup from the File menu or press the alt f r key combination. This is used to select the default/ specific printer, print orientation, paper size, paper source, and any other settings applicable to your printer. It is similar to the Printer Setup commands in other Windows applications. Fig 11.5

Import Wizard
The Import Wizard is a general data import utility that allows Flare System Analyzer to import data from Access databases, Excel Spreadsheets or XML data files. The Import Wizard allows you full control over the data to be imported whether a complete Flare System Analyzer model or just a set of updated source flow rates. Customized import definitions can be created and saved for later use.

Import Data Layouts


The Import Wizard is capable importing data from a fairly wide range of data layouts within a particular data file type. The general rules for successful importing of data are: Import data must be grouped by data type e.g. data for all pipes must appear in one Access database table, on one Excel spreadsheet page or in within a single XML group element. Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Import data for a given type must be defined in a consistent layout e.g. in an Excel spreadsheet all the pipe data could be specified in 3 rows per pipe spaced one row apart.

Samples of the type of data layout that can be imported and the corresponding import definition file formats are given in Import/Export Examples. A detailed description of the import definition file structure is given in FMT Files Format.

Using the Import Wizard


You start the Import Wizard by selecting the Import Wizard option from the File menu. This may be done either immediately after starting Flare System Analyzer in order to import the data to create a Flare System Analyzer model from an external data source or after loading a Flare System Analyzer case to extend and modify it with data from the external source. Once started the Import Wizard presents you with a 4 step dialogue to allow you to specify the data you want to import. Three buttons are common to each step: Next moves the Import Wizard to the next stage. If the data on the current step is incomplete the Next button may be disabled i.e. grayed out. Clicking Next can also generate validation messages that prevent you moving to the next step. If this happens you will need to fix the problem described before continuing. Prev move the Import Wizard back to the previous stage. You can use this option to go back and change your mind about the type of file you want to import or change the definition settings. Cancel this button abandons the import process, closes the Import Wizard and returns you to the standard Flare System Analyzer environment.

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com and Exporting The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

12 Printing, Importing

187

Import Wizard - Step 1


Fig 11.6

The view for the first step of the Import Wizard is shown in Fig 11.6. This view asks you to enter the name of the data file containing the information you want to import. You may either type the name or use the Browse button to select it using the file browser view shown in Fig 11.7. Figure 11.7

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

The file selected must be one of the following types:


File Type Access Extension .MDB Description A Microsoft Access database file. Import of data from all versions of Access up to version 4.0 (Access 2000) is supported. You do not need a copy of Access on the PC that is running Flare System Analyzer in order to use this option. A Microsoft Excel spreadsheet file. Import of data from all versions of Excel up to Excel 2000 is supported. The PC that is running Flare System Analyzer must have an installed copy of Excel. An XML data file. XML data files that comply with the XML 1.0 reference document from W3C are supported.

Excel

.XLS

XML

.XML

Once the file name has been entered click the Next button to move to the next step.

Import Wizard Step 2


Fig 11.8

Step 2 of the Import Wizard view is shown in Figure 11.8. This view asks you to define the import definition file that will be used to control this import. Three options are provided Use Default Definition File. This option selects the default import definition file that has been defined through the Preferences view, Import/Export tab.

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com and Exporting The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

12 Printing, Importing

189

Create New Definition File. This option selects a blank definition file ready for you to begin creating a new import definition. The default blank definition file that will be selected is defined through the Preferences view, Import/Export tab. Use Following File. This option allows you to enter the name of the definition file to be use. The Browse button allows you to select the file using the standard file browser view. The extension for an import definition file is .fni. The definition file selected must have been created for the type of import file you are using.

Whichever import definition file option you use, you will be given the opportunity to update the definition in the next step. When you have selected the definition file option click the Next button to move to the next step of the import process.

Import Wizard Step 3

Fig 11.9 Step 3 of the Import Wizard is shown in Figure 11.9. This view allows you to update the import definition to define precisely which data items and data fields are to be imported. The view is divided into three sections: Object selector. Source tab. Field Details tab.

Object selector
This is a tree view showing the different data objects that may be imported to a Flare System Analyzer model. Selecting a data object in the tree by either
3

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

clicking on it or using the up or down arrow keys displays the import definition settings for that object on the Source and Field Details tab. Some data objects have subsections for which import options may be defined separately from the parent data object. These are indicated in the tree by a small + symbol. The tree will automatically expand to show the subsections when the parent data object is selected. The Object Selector view also provides a rapid overview of which data objects have been selected for import by displaying these with a bold font.

Source Tab
The precise layout of the Source tab will vary with the type of data file that is being imported. If an Access database file is being imported the following fields will be displayed:
Field Import this type of data Data is contained in parent Description This checkbox allows you to define whether this type of data object should be imported. If not selected then all objects of this type will be ignored during the import. This checkbox is only enabled for data subsections. If selected then the import process will expect to find all the data for this subsection in the same database table as the parent object and the remaining fields on the form will be disabled. Clearing this checkbox allows you to specify a different database table for the subsection data fields. E.g. All pipes and nodes allow PFDLayout data to be held in a separate table. This drop-down list allows you to select the database table that contains the data for this object type. The list displays the tables found in the Access data file that you specified in step 1. This field allows you to define selection criteria that may be used to select this type of data object from the defined database table. E.g. if the database you are importing contains data for all node types in a single table, it would require a field to identify the node type and you would define selection criteria based on that field.

Select Table

Select

If an Excel spreadsheet file is being imported the following fields will be displayed:
Field Import this type of data Data is contained in parent Description This checkbox allows you to define whether this type of data object should be imported. If not selected then all objects of this type will be ignored during the import. This checkbox is only enabled for data subsections. If selected then the import process will expect to find all the data for this subsection in the same worksheet as the parent object and the remaining fields on the form will be disabled. Clearing this checkbox allows you to specify a different worksheet within your spreadsheet workbook for

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com and Exporting The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

12 Printing, Importing

191

the subsection data fields. E.g. All pipes and nodes allow PFDLayout data to be held on a separate worksheet. Select Worksheet This drop-down list allows you to select the worksheet that contains the data for this object type. The list displays the worksheets found in the Excel spreadsheet file that you specified in step 1. This entry is ignored when importing data organized by Sheet - see below. This field allows you to define selection criteria that may be used to select this type of data object from the defined worksheet. E.g. if the spreadsheet workbook you are importing contains data for all node types on a single worksheet, it would require a row or column to identify the node type and you would define selection criteria based on that row or column.

Select

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

continued Field Data in Rows, Columns, Sheets Description These radio buttons allow you to specify whether the spreadsheet data for this item is organized by Row, Column or Sheet. Row means the import process will expect to find the data for this object in sets of one or more rows for each object. Column means the data is expected as a set of one or more columns for each object. Sheet means the import process will expect to find each data object on a dedicated worksheet. Start At Per Item This field is visible when the data is organized by Row or Column. It defines the starting row or column for the data. This field is visible when the data is organized by Row or Column. It defines the number of rows or columns occupied by a single data object. This number should include any blank rows or columns used to space out data. This field is visible when the data is organized by Sheet. It defines the name tag by which worksheets containing this type of data object can be identified. E.g. for a workbook containing pipe data worksheets Pipe-123A40, Pipe-456A40, Pipe-789A40 you would set the Sheet Tag to Pipe-

Sheet Tag

If an XML data file is being imported the following fields will be displayed:
Field Import this type of data Data is contained in parent Description This checkbox allows you to define whether this type of data object should be imported. If not selected then all objects of this type will be ignored during the import. This checkbox is only enabled for data subsections. If selected then the import process will expect to find all the data for this subsection in the same group tag as the parent object and the remaining fields on the form will be disabled. Clearing this checkbox allows you specify a different group tag for the subsection data fields. E.g. All pipes and nodes allow PFDLayout data to be held in a separate group. This drop-down list allows you to select the XML group tag or element that contains the data for this object type. The list displays the top level elements found in the XML data file that you specified in step 1. This field allows you to specify the item tag or element name used for each individual data object. This field allows you to define selection criteria that may be used to select this type of data object from the defined Group Tag. E.g. if the XML file you are importing contains data for all node types in a single group of elements, it would require an element to identify the node type and you would define selection criteria based on that element.

Select Group Tag Item Tag Select

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com and Exporting The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

12 Printing, Importing

193

Field Details Tab


Fig 11.10

The Field Details tab provides a table that allows you to specify which data fields are to be imported and where they can be found in the import data source. The columns of the table are:
Column Data Item Import Description This column lists the individual data items that may be imported for this object. The items in this column cannot be changed. This column of checkboxes allows you to select which data items are imported. Check the checkbox to import an item, clear it to ignore the data item. The Import All and Clear All buttons at the bottom of the table allow you to set or clear all of the Import checkboxes with a single click.

The letter number format (A1 etc) is not supported.


Location The actual heading of this column and its contents will depend on the type of data file being imported. Access Files. The column will be headed Database Field and allows you to specify the database field name that corresponds to the data item. The drop-down list contains a list of the default field names from the definition file or you can type in the name if it is not in the list. Excel Files. The column will be headed Row/Column Offset. It allows you to specify the Row/Column offset of the data item in the spreadsheet in the format R#,C#. i.e. the row and column number separated by a comma. If the data is contained in a single Row then just the column number can be specified or if the data is contained in a single Column the row number alone can be supplied.

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

XML Files. The column will be headed ItemTag and allows you to specify the element tag that corresponds to the data item. The drop-down list contains a list of the default item tag names from the definition file or you can type in the name if it is not in the list.

When you have finished updating the import definition, click the Next button to move to the final step of the Import Wizard.

Import Wizard - Step 4


Fig 11.11

The final step of the Import Wizard is shown in Figure 11.11. This view allows you to specify whether the definition file is to be saved and whether you want to create a log file detailing the results of the import process. The fields on this view are:
Entry Description

Import actions will be recorded in the Trace window if the checkbox was checked before starting the Import Wizard.
Select Import Options This set of radio buttons allows you to select whether the import definition file is to be saved and whether to run the import. The options are: Save import definition file then import data. If this option is selected you will be prompted to save the import definition file before the import process runs. Import data without saving import definition file. Select this option if you do not want to save changes to the definition file before running the import process. Save import definition file without importing data. Select this
12 Printing, Importing

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com and Exporting The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

195

option if you want to save the definition file without running the import process. Log Import Actions to File Log File Name Select this checkbox if you want to record the details of the import process to file. Enter the name of the file to be used to log details of import actions. The Browse button may be used to select this through the standard Windows file browser if required.

Once you have completed the entries on this form click the Finish button to complete the Import Wizard and start the import process.

Import Process
If you have asked to save the import definition file, Flare System Analyzer will display the standard Windows file browser to allow you to specify where the import definition file is to be stored. This option can be cancelled through the file browser if required. Then if you have asked to run the import process the progress view will be displayed as shown in Figure 11.12. The Cancel button can be used to interrupt and terminate the import process as required. When the import is complete the progress view will be closed and you will be returned to the normal Flare System Analyzer views. Fig 11.12

During the import process Flare System Analyzer reads each data object in turn from the import data source and checks its name. If the object already exists in the Flare System Analyzer model then the import data will be used to update the existing object. If not then a new data object will be created. Source data associated with relief valves and control valves will be assigned to the scenario that is active when the import process is run. If any data item cannot be found then it will be left set to the current value or default value in the case of new data objects.
3

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Importing Source Data


In addition to the Import Wizard features, Flare System Analyzer allows you to import source data from a specially formatted text file. Utilities are provided to export data in this format from the HYSYS process simulator or the HYSIM process simulator. Flare System Analyzer also allows you to import data directly from the HYSYS process simulator.

ASCII Text Files


To access the ASCII text files containing the source data, select Import Sources from the File menu and then select Text File Sources from the Import submenu. The Text Import of Source Data view will be displayed: Fig 11.13

The following objects are available on this view:


Object File Description Specify the file from which the source data will be imported. Clicking the Browse button opens the Text File For Source Data view. Select the text file from this view and click the OK button. Click the Open button to load the source data file in Flare System Analyzer. Specify the pressure and temperature location for the source. If Upstream is selected from the drop-down list, the relieving pressure and the actual Inlet temperature specification is copied from the source data file. If Downstream is selected from the drop-down list,

P/T Location

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com and Exporting The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

12 Printing, Importing

197

the allowable back pressure and the outlet temperature is copied from the source data file. Component Data Specify the action to be taken if similar components exist in the text file and the Flare System Analyzer case. The Ignore Existing selection does not copy the same components from the text file to the Flare System Analyzer case, whereas the Overwrite Existing copies all the component data from text file to the Flare System Analyzer case. List all the streams available to be imported in Flare System Analyzer. Select the source to which the source data will be imported. List all the scenarios available in the Flare System Analyzer case. You can select the scenarios to which the data will be copied.

Stream Source Scenarios

Example 1: Importing From HYSYS


Two steps are necessary in order to import source data from HYSYS though an ASCII text file. 1 Export the source data from HYSYS. A program must be executed externally to HYSYS in order to convert the source data to the proper format. Import the source data into Flare System Analyzer, using the File Import feature. Run the FNETEXPT.EXE program. This is initially installed in the HYSIM sub-directory under your main Flare System Analyzer program directory. The following view will be displayed.

In order to create the HYSYS transfer file: 1

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Fig 11.14

Enter the name of the HYSYS file containing the streams of interest, then click Open. The Flowsheet Streams list will then contain a list of all the material streams in the file. Select the streams to export as well as the location that the pressure and temperature represent (P&T Location). Click Export. Select a name for the transfer file then click OK. The transfer file will now be created. Select Import-Text File Sources from the File menu. When prompted for the Text Import File as shown below, enter the file name.

3 4

In order to import the HYSYS transfer file: 1

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com and Exporting The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

12 Printing, Importing

199

Fig 11.15

Blank source name fields means that the stream data is not imported. 2 On the Text Import Of Source Data view, enter the source number for the selected scenario within the Flare System Analyzer model that corresponds to each HYSYS stream. Specify the P/T Location and the Component Data from the drop-down list.

Example 2: Importing from HYSIM


Two steps are necessary in order to import source data from HYSIM Version 2.6 or later through an ASCII text file. 1 Export the source data from HYSIM. A calculator program must be executed within HYSIM in order to convert the source data to the proper format. Import the source data into Flare System Analyzer, using the File Import feature. Load the HYSIM case containing the source data into HYSIM. At the main HYSIM command line prompt, type the command !FNW26 as shown below. You must previously have copied the file FNW26.HCL into the HYSIM working directory from the \HYSIM program directory under your main program directory. This need be done only once.

In order to create the HYSIM transfer file: 1 2

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Fig 11.16

When prompted for the name of the export file as shown below, enter the file name. This file will be given the extension .PRN. Fig 11.17

When prompted for the pressure and temperature location as shown below, define whether the conditions for the streams within the simulation case represent either conditions upstream or downstream of the source valve. Fig 11.18

When prompted for the streams to export as shown below, select as many streams as you want (do not select energy streams), by using the standard HYSIM stream selection methods. Fig 11.19

The transfer file will now be created (in your HYSIM directory).

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com and Exporting The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

12 Printing, Importing

201

In order to import the HYSIM transfer file: 1 Select Import-Text File Sources from the File menu. When prompted for the Text Import File as shown below, enter the file name. Fig 11.20

On the Text Import Of Source Data view, enter the source number for the selected scenario within the Flare System Analyzer model that corresponds to each HYSIM stream. Specify the P/T Location and the Component Data from the drop-down list.

Importing HYSYS Source Data


The Source data can also be imported directly from HYSYS. To access the HYSYS files containing the source data, select Import Sources from the File menu and then select HYSYS Sources from the submenu. The HYSYS Import of Source Data view will be displayed: Note: You must have a copy of HYSYS installed on the PC on which you are running Flare System Analyzer to use this option.

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Fig 11.21

The following objects are available on this view:


Object File Description Specify the HYSYS file from which the source data will be imported. Clicking the Browse button opens the HYSYS File For Source Data view. Select the HYSYS file from this view and click the OK button. Click the Open button to load the source data file in Flare System Analyzer. Specify the pressure and temperature location for the source. If Upstream is selected from the drop-down list, the relieving pressure and the actual Inlet temperature specification is copied from the source data file. If Downstream is selected from the drop-down list, the allowable back pressure and the outlet temperature is copied from the source data file. Specify the action to be taken if similar components exist in the HYSYS file and the Flare System Analyzer case. The Ignore Existing selection does not copy the same components from the HYSYS file to the Flare System Analyzer case, whereas the Overwrite Existing copies all the component data from the HYSYS file to the Flare System Analyzer case. List all the streams available in HYSYS file which can be imported in Flare System Analyzer. Select the source to which the source data will be imported. List all the scenarios available in the Flare System Analyzer case. You can select the scenarios to which the data will be copied.

P/T Location

Component Data

Stream Source Scenarios

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com and Exporting The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

12 Printing, Importing

203

Export Wizard
The Export Wizard is a general data export utility that allows Flare System Analyzer to export data to Access databases, Excel Spreadsheets or XML data files. The Export Wizard allows you full control over the data to be exported whether a complete Flare System Analyzer model for archive purposes, a set of data sheets for a particular data type or a selected set of results. The Export Wizard also provides a mechanism for merging Flare System Analyzer cases. Customized export definitions can be created and saved for later use.

Export Data Layouts


The Export Wizard is capable of creating output of a fairly wide range of data layouts within a particular data file type. The general limits when exporting data are: Export data will be grouped by data type e.g. data for all pipes will appear in one Access database table, on one Excel spreadsheet page or in within a single XML group element. Export data for a given type will be output in a regular layout e.g. in an Excel spreadsheet all the pipe data could be output as 3 rows per pipe spaced one row apart.

Samples of the type of data layouts that can be generated and the corresponding definition file formats are given in Import/Export Examples. Detailed descriptions of the definition file structure are given in FMT Files Format.

Using the Export Wizard


The Export Wizard exports data from the Flare System Analyzer model that is currently loaded. You start the Export Wizard by selecting the Export Wizard option from the File menu. Once started the Export Wizard presents you with a 4 step dialogue to allow you to specify the data you want to export. Three buttons are common to each step: Next - moves the Export Wizard to the next stage. If the data on the current step is incomplete the Next button may be disabled i.e. grayed out. Clicking Next can also generate validation messages that prevent you moving to the next step. If this happens you will need to fix the problem described before continuing. Prev - move the Export Wizard back to the previous stage. You can use this button to go back and change your mind about the type of file you want to export to or change the definition settings. Cancel - this button abandons the export process, closes the Export Wizard and returns you to the standard Flare System Analyzer environment.

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Export Wizard - Step 1


Fig 11.22

The view for the first step of the Export Wizard is shown in Fig 11.22. This view asks you to enter the name of the data file which you want to export data to. You may either type the name or use the Browse button to select it using the file browser view shown in Fig 11.23. Fig 11.23

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com and Exporting The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

12 Printing, Importing

205

The file selected must be one of the following types:


File Type Access Extension .MDB Description A Microsoft Access database file. Export of data to either Access version 3.0 (Access 97) or Access version 4.0 (Access 2000) is supported. You do not need a copy of Access on the PC that is running Flare System Analyzer in order to use this option. A Microsoft Excel spreadsheet file. The export of data will be made to the version of Excel that is installed on the PC that is running Flare System Analyzer. An XML data file. XML data files that comply with the XML 1.0 reference document from W3C are generated.

Excel

.XLS

XML

.XML

Selecting the Clear all... option will clear ALL data even if it did not originate from a previous Flare System Analyzer export. The clearing of data will not take place until the export process runs. The remaining fields on this form are as follows:
Entry Clear all existing data before export Create new Access files as Description Select this checkbox if you want to clear the target file of all existing data before exporting the new values from Flare System Analyzer. These radio buttons allow you to specify whether a new Access database will be created as a version 3.0 file or a version 4.0 file. Existing databases are used at their current version level.

Once you have made these entries click the Next button to move to the next step.

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Export Wizard - Step 2


Fig 11.24

Step 2 of the Export Wizard view is shown in Figure 11.24. This view asks you to define the export definition file that will be used to control this export. Three options are provided Use Default Definition File. This option selects the default export definition file that has been defined through the Preferences view, Import/Export tab. Create New Definition File. This option selects a blank definition file ready for you to begin creating a new export definition. The default blank definition file that will be selected is defined through the Preferences view, Import/Export tab. Use Following File. This option allows you to enter the name of the definition file to be used. The Browse button allows you to select the file using the standard file browser view. The extension for an export definition file is .fne. The definition file selected must have been created for the type of export file you selected at step 1.

Whichever export definition file option you use, you will be given the opportunity to update the definition in the next step. When you have selected the definition file option click the Next button to move to the next step of the export process.

Export Wizard - Step 3

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com and Exporting The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

12 Printing, Importing

207

Fig 11.25

Step 3 of the Export Wizard is shown in Figure 11.25. This view allows you to update the export definition to define precisely which data items and data fields are to be exported. The view is divided into four elements: Object selector. Target tab. Field Details tab. Force default composition basis checkbox.

Object selector
This is a tree view showing the different data objects that may be exported from a Flare System Analyzer model. Selecting a data object in the tree by either clicking on it or using the up or down arrow keys displays the export definition settings for that object on the Target and Field Details tab. Some data objects have subsections for which export options may be defined separately from the parent data object. These are indicated in the tree by a small + symbol. The tree will automatically expand to show the subsections when the parent data object is selected. The object selector view also provides a rapid overview of which data objects have been selected for export by displaying these with a bold font.

Target Tab
The precise layout of the target tab will vary with the type of data file that is being exported.
3

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

If an Access database file is being exported the following fields will be displayed:
Field Export this type of data Data is contained in parent Description This checkbox allows you to define whether data for this type of object should be exported. If not selected then all objects of this type will be ignored during the export. This checkbox is only enabled for data subsections. If selected then the export process will write all the data for this subsection to the same database table as the parent object and the remaining fields on the form will be disabled. Clearing this checkbox allows you specify a different database table for the subsection data fields. E.g. All pipes and nodes allow PFDLayout data to be output to a separate table. This entry allows you to define the database table that will contain the data for this object type. The table will be created if it does not already exist in the database.

Table Name

If an Excel spreadsheet file is being exported the following fields will be displayed:
Field Export this type of data Data is contained in parent Description This checkbox allows you to define whether data for this type of object should be exported. If not selected then all objects of this type will be ignored during the export. This checkbox is only enabled for data subsections. If selected then the export process will write all the data for this subsection in the same worksheet as the parent object and the remaining fields on the form will be disabled. Clearing this checkbox allows you to specify a different worksheet within your spreadsheet workbook for the subsection data fields. E.g. All pipes and nodes allow PFDLayout data to be written to a separate worksheet. Description This entry allows you to specify the worksheet that will contain the data for this object type. The worksheet will be created if it does not already exist in the workbook. This entry is ignored when exporting data by Sheet but a dummy name must be entered - see below. These radio buttons allow you to specify whether the spreadsheet data for this item is output by Row, Column or Sheet. Row means the export process will write data for this object in sets of one or more rows for each object. Column means the data will be written as a set of one or more columns for each object. Sheet means the export process will write each data object on a dedicated worksheet. Start At Per Item This field is visible when the data is output by Row or Column. It defines the starting row or column for the data. This field is visible when the data is output by Row or Column. It defines the number of rows or columns occupied by a single data

Field Worksheet name

Data in Rows, Columns, Sheets

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com and Exporting The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

12 Printing, Importing

209

object. This number should include any blank rows or columns used to space out data. Sheet Tag This field is visible when the data is output by Sheet. It defines the name of a format worksheet that should be copied when creating a new worksheet to output data for the selected data object. These format worksheets must have a name that begins with a % character to allow them to be identified and preserved in the event that the Export Wizard is asked to clear a workbook before output.

If an XML data file is being exported the following fields will be displayed:
Field Export this type of data Data is contained in parent Description This checkbox allows you to define whether this type of data object should be exported. If not selected then all objects of this type will be ignored during the export. This checkbox is only enabled for data subsections. If selected then the export process will write all the data for this subsection in the same group tag as the parent object and the remaining fields on the form will be disabled. Clearing this checkbox allows you to specify a different group tag for the subsection data fields. E.g. All pipes and nodes allow PFDLayout data to be held in a separate group. This entry allows you to define the XML group tag or element that will contain the data for this object type. This field allows you to specify the item tag or element name used for each individual data object.

Group Tag Item Tag

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Field Details Tab


Fig 11.26

The Field Details tab provides a table that allows you to specify which data fields are to be exported and where they should be written in the target output file. The columns of the table are:
Column Data Item Export Description This column lists the individual data items that may be exported for this object. The items in this column cannot be changed. This column of checkboxes allows you to select which data items are exported. Check the checkbox to export an item, clear it to ignore the data item. The Export All and Clear All buttons at the bottom of the table allow you to set or clear all of the Export checkboxes with a single click.

The letter number format (A1 etc) is not supported.


Location The heading of this column and its contents will depend on the type of data file being exported. Access Files. The column will be headed Database Field and allows you to specify the database field name that will hold the data item. Excel Files. The column will be headed Row/Column Offset. It allows you to specify the Row/Column offset of the data item in the spreadsheet in the format R#,C#. i.e. the row and column number separated by a comma. If the data is contained in a single Row then just the column number can be specified or if the data is contained in a single Column the row number alone can be supplied. XML Files. The column will be headed Item Tag and allows you to specify the element tag that corresponds to the data item.

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com and Exporting The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

12 Printing, Importing

211

Force Default Composition Basis Checkbox


This checkbox provides a single global setting that tells the Export Wizard how to write composition data. Selecting this option will write out all compositions using the Composition Basis set in the Default tab of the Preferences Editor. If the option is clear the composition of each source will be written using the basis that it is currently set to. Note: There is a potential trap here. If you clear this checkbox and then omit to export the data item that defines the composition basis the exported file might contain compositions with an inconsistent basis i.e. mixed mole and mass fraction data with no way to distinguish which is which. When you have finished updating the export definition, click the Next button to move to the final step of the Export Wizard.

Export Wizard Step 4


Fig 11.27

The final step of the Export Wizard is shown in Fig 11.27. This view allows you to specify whether the definition file is to be saved and whether you want to create a log file detailing the results of the export process.

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

The fields on this view are:


Entry Select Export Options Description This set of radio buttons allows you to select whether the export definition file is to be saved and whether to run the export. The options are: Save definition file then perform data export. If this option is selected you will be prompted to save the export definition file before the export process runs. Export data without saving definition file. Select this option if you do not want to save changes to the definition file before running the export process. Save definition file without performing data export. Select this option if you want to save the definition file without running the export process.

Once you have completed the entries on this form click the Finish button to complete the Export Wizard and start the export process.

Export Process
If you have asked to save the export definition file, Flare System Analyzer will display the standard Windows file browser to allow you to specify where the export definition file is to be stored. This option can be cancelled through the file browser if required. Then if you have asked to run the export process the progress view will be displayed as shown in Fig 11.28. The Cancel button can be used to interrupt and terminate the export process as required. When the export is complete the progress view will be closed and you will be returned to the normal Flare System Analyzer views.

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com and Exporting The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

12 Printing, Importing

213

Fig 11.28

During the export process Flare System Analyzer works through each data object to be written in turn and checks for its name in the output file. If the object already exists in the output file then the current Flare System Analyzer data will be used to overwrite it. If not then a new entry for the data object will be created. Scenario data and results data will only be output for those scenarios that are set to be active in the Calculation Options view, Scenarios tab. E.g. if All Scenarios is set here, data will be exported for all scenarios. Source data associated with relief valves and control valves will be taken from the scenario that is active when the export process is run.

Import/Export Examples
A number of sample data files and the corresponding import or export definition files have been supplied in the samples directory. These examples show how different data source types and layouts can be read by the Import Wizard or generated by the Export Wizard.

Default XML Import


In this example we are going to import a complete Flare System Analyzer model from an XML data file. The structure of XML data file is the same as the default layout assumed by Flare System Analyzer. The steps are: 1 Start up Flare System Analyzer or, if Flare System Analyzer is already running with a case loaded, click the New Case button on the toolbar and then click the OK button to close both the Case Description and Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Component Manager views that will appear without entering any information. 2 3 Start the Import Wizard by selecting it from the File menu. In Import Wizard Step 1 either type in the name of the XML file to be imported: <Your Flare System Analyzer Directory>\Samples\ImportExport\Sample1.xml or use the Browse button to look for and select this file using the Windows file browser. Then click the Next button. 4 5 In Import Wizard Step 2 select the Use the default definition file radio button then click the Next button. In Import Wizard Step 3 you will see that all of the data objects listed in the tree view to the left of the screen are displayed in bold type indicating that import of all these data objects is selected. The default import definition files shipped with Flare System Analyzer are configured to import all data objects. In this case this is what we want to do so simply click the Next button to move to the next stage. In Import Wizard Step 4 select the second radio button, Import data without saving definition file. We will also select the checkbox Log import actions to file so that we will have a record of the data objects that will be imported. The log file name may be left at the default name; the file will be created in the default Flare System Analyzer working directory. Finally click Finish. You will see the Import Progress view report progress as the data objects are imported though it will probably update too quickly to read. When the import process is finished the view closes and you are returned to the main Flare System Analyzer environment from where you can use the various manager views and summary views to inspect the data that has been imported. You might also want to view or print the log file. Note: Only data items are imported and you will need to run the case to view the results.

Access Database Import Using Select Criteria


In this example we are going to import a flare system model from an Access database file. The structure of the database we are importing is different to the default database structure assumed by Flare System Analyzer so it will be necessary to create a new customized import definition file. The database to be imported is: <Your Flare System Analyzer Directory>\Samples\ImportExport\Sample2.mdb.

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com and Exporting The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

12 Printing, Importing

215

It contains the following 4 tables:

Components Table
Component Name Methane Ethane Propane n-Butane n-Pentane n-Hexane Boiling Point 111.63 184.55 231.05 272.65 309.21 341.88 Std Density 299.39 355.68 506.68 583.22 629.73 662.66 Mole Weight 16.043 30.07 44.097 58.124 72.151 86.178

Pipes Table
Name TP-123A TP-145A TP-112B BD-101A BD-112B BD-103A BD-104A FS-100A BD-102A Length 15 15 5 50 20 60 200 50 40 Elevation 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 50 0 Nominal Diameter 12 inch 8 inch 12 inch 16 inch 12 inch 24 inch 24 inch 24 inch 12 inch Fittings Loss 0.5 0.5 0.1 0.1 0.5 0.1 0.2 0.3 0.1 Inlet PSV-123A PSV-145A BDV112B T1 RO-112B T2 C2 C3 C1 Outlet T1 T1 RO-112B T2 C1 C2 C3 FT-100 T2

Nodes Table
Node Type PSV PSV BDV RO Manifold Join Manifold Join Join Tip Node Name PSV-123A PSV-145A BDV-112B RO-112B T1 C1 T2 C2 C3 FT-100 Param1 0 0 0 0.85 0 0 0 0 0 574.65 Param2 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

FlowData Table
Source Name PSV123A PSV145A BDV112B Pressure 10 8 5 Inlet Temp 20 15 15 MABP 4 3.5 3 Mass Flow 50000 40000 30000 Frac 1 0.75 0.05 0.8 Frac 2 0.1 0.1 0.2 Frac 3 0.06 0.8 0 Frac 4 0.05 0.05 0 Frac 5 0.03 0 0 Frac 6 0.01 0 0

The steps required to import this database are: 1 Start up Flare System Analyzer or, if Flare System Analyzer is already running with a case loaded, click the New Case icon on the toolbar and then click the OK button to close both the Case Description and Component Manager views that will appear without entering any information. Open the Preferences Editor and ensure that the default Composition Basis is set to Mole Fractions. The Import Wizard is capable of reading composition basis during the import process but in this case our database does not have entries defining this. Therefore we must set an appropriate default for the data we are importing. 3 4 Start the Import Wizard by selecting it from the File menu. In Step 1 either type in the name of the Access file to be imported: <Your Flare System Analyzer Directory>\Samples\ImportExport\Sample2.mdb or use the Browse button to look for and select this file using the Windows file browser. Then click the Next button. 5 In Step 2 select the Create a new import definition file radio button then click the Next button. When the Step 3 view appears you will see that no data objects have been selected for import i.e. all object names in the tree view are displayed in normal type. We now need to specify which objects will be imported. As an alternative you could select the pre-built import definition file for this sample: <Your Flare System Analyzer Directory>\Samples\ImportExport\Sample2.fni which contains the results of steps 6 to 19. If you do this it is still worth reading through these steps to see how the settings in the import definition file are used to tell the Import Wizard about the database we are importing. 6 Click on Components in the Object Selector tree view. On the Source tab select the checkbox Import this type of data and confirm that the Select Table drop-down list is displaying Components.

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com and Exporting The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

12 Printing, Importing

217

7 8

Click on the Field Details tab. On the Field Details tab we need to select the import checkboxes and specify the database field names as follows:
Data Item Name MolWt StdDensity NBP Database Field ComponentName MoleWeight StdDensity BoilingPoint

Next click on Connectors in the Object Selector tree view. On the Source tab select the checkbox Import this type of data and then select Nodes as the source table using the Select Table drop-down list. Since the Nodes table we are importing contains data for multiple node types we have to tell this Import Wizard which entries are connectors. This is done by typing selection criteria into the Select entry. In our case the Nodes database has a NodeType field that identifies Connectors as a Join so the select entry we need is: NodeType=Join

10 Now click on the Field Details tab and make the following entry, remembering to select the Import checkbox.
Data Item Name Database Field NodeName

11 Next click ControlValves in the Object Selector tree view. On the Source tab check the Import checkbox and select the Nodes table from the Select Table drop-down list. In the Select entry type NodeType=BDV. 12 In the Field Details define the entries to import the name field as in step 9. 13 Next click on the SourceData subsection entry beneath ControlValves in the Object Selector tree view. On the Source tab check the Import checkbox and select the FlowData table from the Select Table dropdown. Since our FlowData data table contains entries for all the sources we need to enter selection criteria to allow the import process to select the appropriate record for each control valve as we import it. This is done by entering the following selection criteria in the Select field. SourceName=.Name Here we are using a code .dataitem where dataitem is the name of a data item in the parent data object. The code tells the import process to substitute the value of that data item in the search string. Here the dataitem is set to Name so that the import process will substitute the name of the control valve it has read and use that to find the appropriate record in the FlowData table.

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

14 Still with the SourceData object selected move to the Field Details tab and define the following data items.
Data Item SourceName MassFlow RelievingPressure InletTemperatureSpec AllowableBackPressure Database Field SourceName MassFlow Pressure InletTemp MABP

15 Next click on the Composition subsection entry beneath the SourceData subsection under the ControlValves. On the Select tab check the Import checkbox and the Data is contained in parent checkbox. This latter checkbox indicates to the Import Wizard that the composition data for each source is in the same record as parent SourceData record. 16 On the Field Details tab for the Composition subsection make the following entry.
Data Item Fraction Database Field Frac+%Composition

The entry in the Database Field column is a code that tells the Import Wizard that this is a repeating data item and tells it how to build the field name. In this case the base field name is Frac to which we add the index number of the component. The %Composition part of the entry specifies that we want to work through our component list one by one. As an aside, if the composition entries were defined by name e.g. FracMethane, FracEthane etc. we would use the code Frac+?Composition to substitute each component name in turn instead of component index numbers. 17 The remaining entries are similar. Select OrificePlates and make the following entries: Source tab Select Table = Nodes Select entry = NodeType=RO Field Details tab
Data Item Name UpstreamDiameterRatio Database Field NodeName Param1

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com and Exporting The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

12 Printing, Importing

219

18 Select Pipes and make the following entries: Source tab Select Table = Pipes Select entry = <blank> Field Details tab
Data Item Name UpstreamConnection DownstreamConnection Length ElevationChange NominalDiameter FittingLossOffset Database Field Name Inlet Outlet Length Elevation NominalDiameter FittingsLoss

19 Select ReliefValves and its SourceData and Composition subsections in turn to setup the same entries as for the ControlValves data object, the only change being that the Select entry should read NodeType=PSV. 20 Select Tees and make the following entries: Source tab Select Table = Nodes Select entry = NodeType=Manifold Field Details tab
Data Item Name Database Field NodeName

21 Select Tips and make the following entries: Source tab Select Table = Nodes Select entry = NodeType=Tip Field Details tab
Data Item Name Diameter FittingLoss Database Field NodeName Param1 Param2

22 At this point our import definition is complete so click Next to move to the next step of the Import Wizard. On this step select the Save import definition file then Import Data radio button. Then check the Log import actions to file checkbox and either accept the default log file
3

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

name or specify an alternative name. Finally we are ready to click Finish to begin the import. 23 The Import Wizard will then display the windows File Browser view to allow us to specify where we want to save our import definition file. Enter your preferred location and name and click OK to continue. The import process itself will then run and then close the Import Wizard on completion. At this point we have completed the import process. You can view or print the log file that you specified in step 20 to confirm that it has imported all the data objects that you were expecting. A reference log file: <Your Flare System Analyzer directory>\Samples\ImportExport\Sample2.log is provided for comparison. 24 The final step is to review the data that has been imported. First open the PFD. You will see that all the data objects are displayed one on top of the other since the data we imported did not contain any PFD layout information. While you could manually arrange the objects, it is simpler to use the PFD - Regenerate option on the View menu to automatically layout the PFD. After regeneration the system should look something like Fig 11.29. Fig 11.29

You should also review the Pipe and Node data for the model through the summary views. Note: Notice how the standard Flare System Analyzer default values have been used where the data was not available in the imported database. This sample may seem rather long. However the setup of the import definition file is a one off task for each data format we want to import. Should we have another database with the same layout our saved import definition file will allow us to import it using the same few steps as Sample 1.

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com and Exporting The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

12 Printing, Importing

221

Import of Updated Source Data from Excel


In this example we are going to use the Import Wizard to update an existing Flare System Analyzer model with new source data from an Excel workbook. The workbook contains source data for multiple scenarios organized so that there is one Excel worksheet for each scenario. The workbook we will be importing is called: <Your Flare System Analyzer Directory>\Samples\ImportExport\Sample3.xls The layout of data on each worksheet is shown in Fig 11.30: Fig 11.30

The steps required to import the workbook are: 1 Start up Flare System Analyzer and load the model that we are updating: <Your Flare System Analyzer Directory>\Samples\ImportExport\Sample3.fnw. 2 Open the Preferences Editor and ensure that the default composition basis is set to Mole Fractions. The Import Wizard is capable of reading composition basis during the import process but in this case the workbook does not have entries defining this. Therefore we must set an appropriate default for the data we are importing. 3 4 Start the Import Wizard by selecting it from the File menu. In Step 1 either type in the name of the Excel file to be imported: <Your Flare System Analyzer Directory>\Samples\ImportExport\Sample3.xls or use the Browse button to look for and select this file using the Windows file browser. Then click the Next button.

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

In Step 2 select the Create a new import definition file radio button then click the Next button. When the Step 3 view appears you will see that no data objects have been selected for import i.e. all object names in the tree view are displayed in normal type. We now need to specify which objects will be imported As an alternative you could select the pre-built import definition file for this sample: <Your Flare System Analyzer Directory>\Samples\ImportExport\Sample3.fni which contains the results of steps 6 to 19. If you do this it is still worth reading through these steps to see how the settings in the import definition file are used to tell the Import Wizard about the Excel workbook we are importing.

Click the Scenarios object in the Object Selector tree view. On the Source tab, check the Import this type of data checkbox. Next select the first of the available worksheets in the Select Worksheet dropdown list. Then select the Data is in Sheets radio button since the data we are importing is organized as one scenario per sheet. Finally on this tab, enter Scenario- in the Sheet Tag field. When we tell the Import Wizard that data is organized in Sheets, it needs to know how to recognize the worksheets that contain the right type of data (scenario data in this case). The Import Wizard does this by assuming that the appropriate sheets have a name that begins with the text defined in the Sheet Tag entry. Although our workbook only contains scenario worksheets we still need to enter a tag by which they can be recognized. In our case they all begin with the tag Scenario-. Note: Any worksheet can be specified in the Select Worksheet dropdown when you select the Data is in Sheets option is selected since the import process will work through all worksheets with the appropriate tag. You cannot leave this field blank however.

Now click the Field Details tab. On this tab select the Import checkboxes against the following data items and enter their location as follows:
Data Item Name Pressure HeaderMach HeaderNoise TailpipeMach TailpipeNoise Row, Column Offset (#,#) 3,2 5,2 6,2 7,2 6,2 7,2

Note: It is possible to read the same data item into more than one Flare System Analyzer data field. Here the Mach number and Noise values from the worksheet will be imported to both the Header and Tailpipe limits for each scenario. 8 Now click the SourceData subsection under the Scenario object in the Object Selector tree view. On the Source tab, check the Import this

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com and Exporting The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

12 Printing, Importing

223

type of data checkbox and check the Data is contained in parent checkbox. This latter entry tells the Import Wizard that the source data is located on the same worksheet as the base scenario data and as a result the remaining fields on this tab are automatically set to the parent values and disabled to prevent them being independently modified. 9 Still on the SourceData subsection, select the Field Details tab. Check the Import checkboxes for the following data items and make the following Row, Column entries:
Data Item SourceName MassFlow RelievingPressure InletTemperatureSpec Row, Column Offset (#,#) 9+%SourceData,1 9+%SourceData,2 9+%SourceData,3 9+%SourceData,4

The entries in the Row, Column column are codes that tell the Import Wizard that these are repeating data items. Effectively they tell the Import Wizard how to calculate the row and column offset for each data item. In this case the %SourceData part of the entry specifies that we want to work through a list of source data items one by one. The source number is then added to the fixed row offset to give the correct row for that data item. For example when importing the second line of source data, the %SourceData tag will generate the value 2 which when added to 9 gives 11 - the correct row number for the second line of source data. 10 Next select the Composition subsection beneath SourceData subsection, still under the Scenario object in the Object Selector tree view. On the Source tab, check the Import this type of data checkbox and check the Data is contained in parent checkbox. Again this indicates that this data lies on the same worksheet as the Scenario data. 11 Still on the Composition subsection, select the Field Details tab. Check the Import checkbox for the Fraction data item and make the following Row, Column entry:
Data Item Fraction Row, Column Offset (#,#) 9+%SourceData,4+%Composition

Again the entries in the Row, Column column are codes that tell the Import Wizard that these are repeating data items. The 9+%SourceData part of the code allows the Import Wizard to calculate the correct row while the 4+%Composition allows it to calculate the correct column for each component fraction. 12 At this point our import definition is complete so click Next to move to the next step of the Import Wizard. On this step select the Save import definition file then import data radio button. Then check the Log import actions to file checkbox and either accept the default log file

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

name or specify an alternative name. Finally we are ready to click Finish to begin the import. 13 The Import Wizard will then display the windows File Browser view to allow us to specify where we want to save our import definition file. Enter your preferred location and name and click OK to continue. The import process itself will then run and then close the import wizard on completion. At this point we have completed the import process. You can view or print the log file that you specified in step 12 to confirm that it has updated the existing three scenarios and added data for two new scenarios. A reference log file: <Your Flare System Analyzer directory>\Samples\ImportExport\Sample3.log is provided if you want to make a comparison. You will also find an export definition file and format spreadsheet that can be used to generate Excel spreadsheets in this format: <Your Flare System Analyzer directory>\Samples\ImportExport\Sample3.fne <Your Flare System Analyzer directory>\Samples\ImportExport\Sample3Format.xls

Export to Access Database For Flare System Analyzer 3.05


In this example we are going to export a complete Flare System Analyzer model to an Access database using a structure for the Access database that would allow it to be imported by Flare System Analyzer version 3.05. To do this we will use a predefined export definition file that is shipped with Flare System Analyzer. 1 Start up Flare System Analyzer and load the Flare System Analyzer model that you want to export. In our case lets use the file from the previous case: <Your Flare System Analyzer directory>\Samples\ImportExport\sample3.fnw 2 3 Start the Export Wizard by selecting it from the File menu. In the Export Wizard Step 1 either type in the name of the Access file you want to create or use the Browse button to define this file using the Windows file browser. Once the file name has been entered ensure that the Create new Access files as radio button is set to Version 3.0 since Flare System Analyzer 3.05 cannot read Access 4.0 files. If the database name you entered in the previous step is an existing file then check the Clear all existing data before export checkbox to ensure that our database will contain only the data for this model. Finally click the Next button. 5 In Export Wizard Step 2 select the Use the following export definition file radio button then click the Browse button. Use the File Browser view to select the file:

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com and Exporting The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

12 Printing, Importing

225

<Your Flare System Analyzer directory>\Formats\Access305.fne When you have selected this definition file click the Next button to continue. 6 In Export Wizard Step 3 you will see that most of the data objects listed in the tree view to the left of the screen are displayed in bold type indicating that export of these data objects is selected. Some objects namely BIPs, Scenarios and Solver Options are not displayed in bold indicated that these objects will not be exported. This is because the fixed format Access import facility in Flare System Analyzer version 3.05 is not capable of importing this type of data. You do not need to, but you can select objects in the Object Selector tree view and click the Field Details tab to see which data items have been selected for export. Again those items that have not been selected have been omitted because they cannot be imported by Flare System Analyzer version 3.05. When you are finished browsing click the Next button to continue. 7 8 In Export Wizard Step 4 select the second radio button, Export data without saving definition file. Finally click Finish. You will see the Export Progress view report progress as the data objects are written though it will probably update too quickly to read. When the export process is finished the view closes and you are returned to the main Flare System Analyzer environment.

You may be interested to know that there is also an import definition file called Access305.fni in the <Your Flare System Analyzer directory>\Formats directory which allows the Import Wizard to import Access databases generated by Flare System Analyzer version 3.05.

Export Pipe Data Table to Excel


In this example we are going to generate a list of the piping that makes up our flare network in an Excel worksheet. In addition to the basic pipe information we are going to add the operating conditions for a selected scenario to the table. 1 Start up Flare System Analyzer and load the Flare System Analyzer model that you want to export. In this sample lets use the file weve used before: <Your Flare System Analyzer directory>\Samples\ImportExport\sample3.fnw 2 Open the Calculation Options view and go to the Scenarios tab to check that the Calculate option is set to Current Scenario. Then close this view and select Power Fail to be the current scenario using the Scenario Selector and Rating as the calculation mode using the Calculation Mode Selector. Finally click the Go button to run the rating calculations. The Export Wizard will export the same scenarios that are selected for calculation so this step selects the correct scenario for export as well as ensuring that the results are ready for export. 3 4 Start the Export Wizard using the option from the File menu. In the Export Wizard step 1 specify the name of the Excel workbook we want to output our results to. In this case lets use: Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

<Your Flare System Analyzer directory>\Samples\ImportExport\Sample5.xls Note: You can either type in this name or specify it through the file browser. 5 6 When you have specified the file name click the Next button to continue. In the Export Wizard step 2, select the option Create a new export definition file and then click the Next button to continue. As an alternative you could select the pre-built export definition file for this sample: <Your Flare System Analyzer Directory>\Samples\ImportExport\Sample5.fne which contains the results of steps 6 to 10. If you do this it is still worth reading through these steps to see how the settings in the export definition file are used to tell the Export Wizard how we want to write data to the Excel data file we are creating. 7 In the Export Wizard step 3 you will see that the default settings for a new export definition file do not select any data objects for export i.e. all object names in the tree view are displayed in normal type. We now need to specify which objects will be exported. Select the Pipes object in the Object Selector tree view. In the Target tab check the Export this type of data checkbox and enter PipeData in the Worksheet Name field. Finally select the Data is in Rows radio button and enter the values 5 in the Start at Row field and 1 in the Rows per Item field. These entries tell the Export Wizard that we want to write the pipe data to a worksheet called PipeData. The data will be written with each pipe taking 1 row per pipe, starting at row 5. 8 Click the Field Details tab. Check the Export checkbox against the following data items and enter the following column offsets.
Data Item Name Length ElevationChange InternalDiameter NominalDiameter WallThickness PipeSchedule InsulationType InsulationThickness InsulationConductivity Column or Row, Column Offset (#,#) 2 4 5 9 7 10 8 20 21 22

It is worth a word of explanation here to explain why we have asked the Export Wizard to write the pipe name in column 2 of our table rather than column 1. This is because we are going to output results data into the same set of rows as the pipe data so as to include operating conditions. Since the export process checks for the next free export area for each data object by looking at cell offset 1,1 of the target area, it would not
12 Printing, Importing

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com and Exporting The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

227

output data in the same row if it found the pipe name already there. By writing the name to column 2 we ensure that the same set of rows will be reused by the results output. 9 Select PFSummary in the Object Selector tree view. Select the Export checkbox and enter PFSummary in the Worksheet Name field on the Target tab. We are not going to export any data items associated with the PFSummary data object itself but we must select this parent data object in order to be able to export data from its subsections. 10 Select the EndResults subsection beneath PFSummary in the Object Selector. In the Target tab select the Export checkbox, enter PipeData in the Worksheet Name field, select the Data is in Rows radio button and set the Start at Row and Rows per Item fields to 5 and 1 respectively. Ensure that the Data is contained in parent checkbox is cleared. 11 Click the Field Details tab. Check the Export checkbox against the following data items and enter the following column offsets.
Data Item UpstreamPressure UpstreamTemperature UpstreamVelocity DownstreamPressure DownstreamTemperature DownstreamVelocity Column or Row, Column Offset (#,#) 12 13 14 16 17 18

When you have finished entering this data click the Next button to continue. 12 Select the first radio button, Save definition file then perform data export and click Finish. A standard file browser view will appear asking you to specify a location and name for your export definition file. Enter suitable values and click the OK button. The export process will then run. 13 You will see the Export Progress view report progress as the data objects are written. When the export process is finished the view closes and you are returned to the main Flare System Analyzer environment. 14 You can now use Excel to open the Excel workbook you have created. There will be an empty sheet called PFSummary that you can delete. The pipe data table we want will be on the PipeData worksheet. All you have to do now is delete the empty column 1, add some column headings and the pipe data table is ready for your report. <Your Flare System Analyzer Directory>\Samples\ImportExport\Sample5Final.xls shows our exported worksheet after adding headings.

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Merge Cases Through Export/Import Wizards


In this example we will use the Export Wizard to merge two Flare System Analyzer models. This could be done equally well using export to an Access database, an Excel spreadsheet or a XML file. For the sake of variety though, we will use XML files in this case. 1 Open Flare System Analyzer and load the first of the files we want to merge: <Your Flare System Analyzer directory>\Samples\ImportExport\Sample6a.fnw 2 Open the Calculation Options edit view, go to the Scenarios tab and ensure that the Calculate option is set to All Scenarios. The Export Wizard will only export those scenarios that are selected for calculation. Start the Export Wizard from the File menu In Step 1 of the Export Wizard, enter the name of the file to export as: <Your Flare System Analyzer directory>\Samples\ImportExport\Sample6.xml or use the Browse button to open the file browser before selecting this directory, the XML file type and entering the file name. If you are repeating this example and the file Sample6.xml already exists then select the checkbox Clear all existing data before export. When youve done this click the Next button. 5 6 In Step 2 of the Export Wizard select the Use the default export definition file radio button and click Next. In Step 3 of the Export Wizard select PFSummary in the Object Selector tree view. In the Target tab clear the checkbox Export this type of data since we are not interested in exporting results in this case. Click Next to continue. 7 In Export Wizard Step 4 select the Export data without saving definition file radio button since we do not want to overwrite the default definition file. Then click Finish. The export process will run and return you to the main Flare System Analyzer environment. Open the file: <Your Flare System Analyzer directory>\Samples\ImportExport\Sample6b.fnw using the Open option from the File menu. Again check that the All Scenarios option is set in the Scenarios tab of the Calculation Options edit view. 9 Start the Export Wizard from the File menu. <Your Flare System Analyzer directory>\Samples\ImportExport\Sample6.xml Ensure that the Clear all existing data before export checkbox is cleared before clicking Next to move to the next stage. 11 In Step 2 of the Export Wizard, select the Use the default export definition file radio button and click Next.
12 Printing, Importing

3 4

10 In the Export Wizard Step 1, use the Browse button to select the file:

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com and Exporting The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

229

12 In Step 3 of the Export Wizard select PFSummary in the Object Selector tree view and clear the Export this type of data checkbox in the Target tab. Click Next to continue. 13 In the final step of the Export Wizard, select the Export data without saving definition file radio button and click Finish. Again the export process will run and return you to the main Flare System Analyzer screens. We now have the data for our merged case in the file: <Your Flare System Analyzer directory>\Samples\ImportExport\Sample6.xml. 14 Import this file using the sequence of instructions given in the Default XML Import section. To summaries these they are:
o o o

Create a new case Start Import Wizard In step 1 Specify file

<Your Flare System Analyzer directory>\Samples\ImportExport\Sample6.xml


o o o

In step 2 select default import definition file Make no changes in step 3 In step 4 select import without saving definition file.

15 You can now use the standard Flare System Analyzer views to examine and update the merged case. Things that you might want to modify in your new case are:
o

Component lists for the two cases have been merged. This generates a requirement for new Binary Interaction Parameters which will have been set at default values. Do you need to update them? The list of scenarios will include all the scenarios from both cases. Default flow and other source data will have been generated for sources that were originally missing. Do you need to update these? Any nodes, sources or pipes that were common to both models will have their data values set to the values taken from the second model. Are these correct? (21-FT001 is a common node in this example). The calculation options will be set to those defined for the second model. Are these correct?

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

13 Automation

This section provides information on the following topics: Overview Objects Flare System Analyzer Object Reference Example

Overview
Automation, defined in its simplest terms, is the ability to drive one application from another. For example, the developers of Product A have decided in their design phase that it would make their product more usable if they exposed Product As objects, thereby making it accessible to automation. Since Products B, C and D all have the ability to connect to application that have exposed objects, each can programmatically interact with product A. The exposure of its objects makes Flare System Analyzer a very powerful and useful tool in the design of hybrid solutions. Since access to an application through Automation is language-independent, anyone who can write code in Visual Basic, C++ or Java, to name three languages, can write applications that will interact with Flare System Analyzer. There are a number of applications that can be used to access Flare System Analyzer through Automation, including Microsoft Visual Basic, Microsoft Excel and Visio. With so many combinations of applications that can transfer information, the possibilities are numerous and the potential for innovative solutions is endless.

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 13 Automation The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

231

Objects
The key to understanding Automation lies in the concept of objects. An object is a container that holds a set of related functions and variables. In Automation terminology, the functions of an object are call methods and the variables are called properties. Consider the example of a simple car. If it were an object, a car would have a set of properties such as; make, color, engine, etc. The car object might also have methods such as; drive, refuel, etc. By utilizing the properties and methods of the car object it is possible to define, manipulate and interact with the object. Fig 12.1

Each property of the car is a variable that has a value associated with it. The color could be either a string or a hexadecimal number associated with a specific color. The gas mileage could be a floating-point value. Methods are nothing more than the functions and subroutines associated with the object. An object is a container that holds all the attributes associated with it. An object could contain other objects that are a logical subset of the main object. The car object might contain other objects such as engine or tyre. These objects would have their own set of independent properties and methods. An engine would have properties related to the number of valves and the size of the pistons. The tyres would have properties such as the tread type or model number.

Object Hierarchy
The path that is followed to get to a specific property may involve several objects. The path and structure of objects is referred to as the object hierarchy. In Visual Basic the properties and methods of an object are accessed by hooking together the appropriate objects through a dot operator (.) function. Each dot operator in the object hierarchy is a function call. In many cases it is beneficial to reduce the number of calls by setting intermediate object variables.

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

For instance, expanding on our previous example involving the car, suppose there existed an object called Car and you wished to set the value of its engine size. You could approach the problem in one of two ways. Direct specification of object property Car.Engine.Size = 3 Indirect specification of object property Dim Eng1 as Object Set Eng1 - Car.Engine.Size Eng1 = 3 If the Engine size is a property that you wish to access quite often in your code, using the indirect method of specification might be easier as it reduces the amount of code thereby reducing the possibility of error.

The Flare System Analyzer Type Library


In order to do anything with objects it is first necessary to know what objects are available. When an application is exposed to Automation, a separate file is usually created that lists all the objects and their respective properties and methods. This file is called the type library and nearly all programs that support Automation have one of these files available. With the help of an Object Browser, such as the one built into Microsoft Excel, you now have a way to view all the objects, properties, and methods in the application by examining the type library. For Flare System Analyzer, the type library is contained within the application itself, flarenet.exe. The Flare System Analyzer type library reveals numerous objects that contain many combine properties and methods. For every object the type library will show its associated properties and methods. For every property the type library will show its return type. For every method, the type library will show what types of arguments are required and what type of value might be returned. Accessing a specific property or method is accomplished in a hierarchical fashion by following a chain of exposed objects. The first object in the chain should be an object from which all other objects can be accessed. This object will typically be the main application. In Flare System Analyzer, the starting object is the Application object. All other objects are accessible from this starting object.

Object Browser
The type library itself does not exist in a form that is immediately viewable to you. On order to view the type library, you require the use of an application commonly referred to as an Object Browser. The Object Browser will interpret the type library and display the relevant information. Microsoft Excel and Visual Basic both include a built in Object Browser.

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 13 Automation The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

233

Accessing the Object Browser in Excel 97


1 2 3 4 5 6 Press <Alt><F11> or select Visual Basic Editor from Macro group in the Tools menu. Within the Visual Basic Editor, choose References from the Tools menu. Check the box next to Flare System Analyzer 3.5. If this is not displayed, use the Browse button to locate fnet350.exe. Click OK. Choose Object Browser from the View menu or press <F2>. Select Flare System Analyzer under Libraries/Workbooks drop down.

Example: Navigating through the type library


This example shows how to navigate through the type library in order to determine the object hierarchy necessary to access a particular property. The desired property is the mass flow of a relief valve called PSV 1 in the currently active scenario. The first step is to start with the starting object that in the case of Flare System Analyzer is always the Application object. Fig 12.2

Selecting the Application object in the browser reveals all of its related properties and methods. Examination of the list of properties does not reveal a relief valve object so access to a particular relief valve must be through another object. The properties that are links to other objects can be determined by looking at the type shown when a property is selected. If the type is not String, Boolean, Variant, Double, Integer or Long then it is most likely an object. The object type shown will be found somewhere in the object list and the next step is to determine the object hierarchy. With prior experience in Flare System Analyzer, the ReliefValves object is a logical choice.
3

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Fig 12.3

The ReliefValves object is shown to be of type IReliefValve. This object is a simple object that is a collection of other objects with some properties and methods for navigation through the collection. Fig 12.4

The Item property is shown to return an indexed object of type IReliefValve, The argument named What is of type Variant which is the default argument type for an argument unless otherwise specified. All collection objects within Flare System Analyzer allow access to an individual member of the collection either by index number (like an array) or directly by name. Named arguments are case insensitive so PSV 1 is the same as psv 1. Either approach is equally valid. Examining the IReliefValve object type shows a property called PropertyByName, which is type Variant.

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 13 Automation The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

235

Fig 12.5

This property is a read/write property that is used to access all data for a relief valve. The first argument is a case insensitive string that describes the variable that we wish to access. In this case this string would have the valve MassFlow. A full list of property names for each type of object is given at the end of this chapter The second argument is a Variant to that describes the scenarios for which the mass flow will apply. As with the ReliefValves collection object, either an index number or the name may be used to define the scenario. This argument is optional as indicated by the square brackets, and if it is not specified then the currently active scenario will be used. The resulting syntax to access the desired property is: ReliefValves.Item(PSV1).PropertyByName(MassFlow)

Automation Syntax
Declaring Objects
An object in Visual Basic is another type of variable and should be declared. Objects can be declared using the generic type identifier object. The preferred method however uses the type library reference to declare the object variables by an explicit object name. Early Binding: Dim | Public | Private Objectvar as ObjectName as specified in the type library

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Late Binding: Dim | Public | Private objectvar as Object Once a reference to a type library has been established, the actual name of the object as it appears in the type library can be used. This is called early binding. It offers some advantages over late binding, including speed and access to Microsofts IntelliSense functionality when using Visual Basic or VBA.

Example: Object Declaration


Early Binding: Public fnApp as Object Public thisPsv as Object Late Binding: Public fnApp as Flarenet.IApplication Public thisPsv as Flarenet.IReliefValve

The Set Keyword


Syntax: Set objectvar = object.[object...].object | Nothing Connections or references to object variables are made by using the Set keyword. Example: Set Assuming fnApp is set to the Application Object Dim thisPsv as Flarenet.IReliefValve Set thisPsv - fnApp.ReliefValves.item(1)

CreateObject, GetObject
Syntax for creating an instance of an application: CreateObject (class) GetObject ([pathname] [,class]) Where class is the starting object as specified in the type library. In order to begin communication between the client and server applications, an initial link to the server application must be established. In Flare System Analyzer this is accomplished through the starting object Application. The CreateObject function will start a new instance of the main application. CreateObject is used in Flare System Analyzer with the Flarenet.Application class as defined in the type library. This connects to the main application interface of Flare System Analyzer. Example: CreateObject

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 13 Automation The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

237

Dim FnApp As Object Set FnApp = CreateObject (Flarenet.Application) The following example uses early binding in the object declaration to create an instance of Flare System Analyzer and then load a specified model. Example: CreateObject Dim FnApp As Flarenet.Application Set FnApp = CreateObject (Flarenet.Application) FnApp.OpenModel c:\flarenet\samples\ole\olesample.fnw The GetObject function will connect to an instance of the server application that is already running. If an instance of the application is not already running then a new instance will be started.

Object Properties, Methods and Hierarchy


Syntax for creating and accessing properties: Set objectvar = object.[object.object...] .object Variable = object.[object.object...] .object.property Syntax for accessing methods: Function Method returnvalue = object.method ([argument1, argument2, ...]) Subroutine method object.method argument1, argument2, ... The sequence of objects is set through a special dot function. Properties and methods for an object are also accesses through the dot function. It is preferable to keep the sequences of objects to a minimum since each dot function is a call to a link between the client and the server application. The object hierarchy is an important and fundamental concept for utilizing automation. A particular property can only be accessed by following a specific chain of objects. The chain always begins with the Application object and ends with the object containing the desired property. The methods of objects are accessed in the same fashion as properties by utilizing the dot function. A method for a particular object is nothing more than a function or subroutine whose behavior is related to the object in some fashion. Typically the methods of an object will require arguments to be passed when the method is called. The type library will provide information about which arguments are necessary to call a particular method. A function will return a value. Note: Subroutines in Visual Basic do not require parentheses around the argument list.

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Examples: Accessing Flare System Analyzer Object Properties


Dim FnApp As Flarenet .Application Dim SepDiam as Double Set FnApp = CreateObject (Flarenet.Application) FnApp.OpenModel c:\flarenet\samples\ole\olesample.fnw SepDiam - FnApp.VerticalSeparators.Item[1].PropertyByName (Diameter) This example starts up Flare System Analyzer and opens a specific case. The diameter of a specific vertical separator is then obtained. The diameter is obtained through a connection of the Application and VerticalSeparators objects. Dim FnApp As Flarenet.Application Dim Seps as Flarenet.IVerticalSeparators Dim Sep as Flarenet.IVerticalSeparator Dim SepDiam as Double Set FnApp = CreateObject (Flarenet.Application) FnApp.OpenModel c:\flarenet\samples\ole\olesample.fnw Set Seps = FnApp.VerticalSeparators Set Sep = Seps.Item[I] SepDiam = Sep.PropertyByName (Diameter) This example also gets the diameter of a specific vertical separator, but creates all the intermediate objects so that when the diameter value is actually requested the chain of objects only contains one object.

Collection Objects
Syntax: Properties of a Collection Object: Item(Index)Accesses a particular member of the collection by name or number CountReturns the number of objects in the collection Syntax: Enumeration of Objects: For Each element In group [statements] [Exit For] [statements] Next [element]

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 13 Automation The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

239

A collection object is an object that contains a set of other objects. This is similar to an array of objects. The difference between an array of objects and a collection object is that a collection object is that a collection object contains a set of properties and methods for manipulating the objects in the collection. The Count property returns the number of items in the collection and the Item property takes an index value or name as the argument and returns a reference to the object within the collection. A special type of For loop is available for enumerating through the objects within the collection. The For Each loop provides a means for enumerating through the collection without explicitly specifying how many items are in the collection. This helps avoid having to make additional function call to the Count and Item properties of the collection object in order to perform the same type of loop.

Examples: Accessing Collection Objects


Dim myPsvs as Flarenet.ReliefValves Dim name as String Dim i As Integer Set myPsvs = myApp.ReliefValves For i = 1 To myPsvs.Count name = myPsvs.Item(i).PropertyByName(Name) MsgBox name Next i This example connects to a collection of relief valves by setting the myPsvs object. A For loop is created that uses the Count and item properties of a collection in order to display a message box that display the name of each relief valve in turn. The items in the collection are indexed beginning at 1. The application object is assumed to have been already set to myApp. Dim myPsvs as Flarenet.ReliefValve Dim myPsvs as Flarenet.ReliefValves Dim name as String Set myPsvs = myApp.ReliefValves For Each myPsvs in myPsvs name = myPsv.PropertyByName(Name) MsgBox name Next This example is identical to the first example except that a For Each loop is used instead of the standard For loop in order to enumerate through the ReliefValves collection.

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Variants
Syntax: Using variant values: Dim myvariant as Variant myvariant = [object.property] To determine the upper and lower bound of the variant: UBound(arrayname[,dimension]) LBound(arrayname[,dimension]) A property can return a variety of variable type. Values such as Temperature or Pressure are returned as Doubles or 32-bit floating point values. The Name property returns a String value. Visual Basic provides an additional variable called Variant. A Variant is a variable that can take on the form of any type of variable including, Integer, Long, Double, String, Array, and Objects. If the property of an object returns an array whose size can vary depending upon the case, then a Variant is used to access that value. For example, the Composition property of a ControlValve returns an array of Doubles sized to the number of components in the model. In Visual Basic, if a variable is not explicitly declared then it is implicitly a Variant. Variants have considerably more storage associated with their use so for a large application it is good practice to limit the number of Variants being used. It is also just good programming practice to explicitly declare variables whenever possible.

Example: Using Variants in Flare System Analyzer


Dim myPsvs as Flarenet.ReliefValve Dim molefracs as Variant Dim i As Integer Set myPsv = myApp.ReliefValves.Item(1) molefracs = myPsv.PropertyByName (Composition) For i = LBound(molefracs) To Ubound (molefracs) Debug.Print molefracs(i) Next i This example shows how to get the mole fractions of a relief valve for the current scenario. The values are sent to the Visual Basic Immediate window. The application object is assumed to have been already set to myApp.

Unknown Values
There are a number of occasions where a variable may be unknown such as all the calculated values prior to the calculation or the flange size of a control valve. In all cases this is represented by the value fntUnknownValue.

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 13 Automation The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

241

Example: Using Unknown Values in Flare System Analyzer


Dim myValve as Flarenet.ControlValves Dim myValves as Flarenet.ControlValve Dim flange as Double Dim name as String Set myValves = myApp.ControlValves For Each myValve in myValves flange = myValve.PropertyByName (FlangeDiameter) if flange - fntUnknown Then name = myValve.PropertyByName(Name) MsgBox name EndIf Next i This example loops through all the control valves and displays the name of any whose flange diameter is unknown. The application object is assumed to have been already set to myApp.

Flare System Analyzer Object Reference


The following subsections summaries the methods and properties available in each of the objects available within Flare System Analyzer. These are ordered purely alphabetically. For each object the attributes comprises the type (or class) of object followed by the access characteristics which may be read only or read/write. In general, data will have the read/write attribute and calculated values will have the read only attribute. Each method is shown with the method name including any arguments, a description of the method and a description of the arguments. Each property is shown with the property name including any arguments, a description of the property, the property attributes and a description of the arguments. Optional arguments are shown in square brackets []. Many of the objects support a PropertyByName property. In such cases a further table gives the valid property names which are case insensitive as well as the property attributes and the units of measure where appropriate. The property names will generally match the field descriptions on the corresponding views but they never contain any space characters.

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Application
Description : Application object Attributes : Methods
Name OpenModel(fn As String) SaveModel(fn as String) DoImport(imType As importType, source As String, Definition As String, Flag As Integer) As Integer DoExport(exType As exportType, source As String, Definition As String, Flag As Integer) As Integer Description Open a Flare System Analyzer model Save a Flare System Analyzer model Import a Flarenet Model Arguments fn = fn = Model filename Model filename

IApplication, read only

imType = 0,1,2 for xml,xls,mdb files source = importfilename Definition = definitionfilename Flag = 0

Export a Flarenet Model

exType = 0,1,2 for xml, xls, mdb files source = exportfilename Definition = definitionfilename Flag = 0

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 13 Automation The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

243

Properties
Name Bleeds Components Connectors ControlValves HorizontalSeparat ors Nodes Pipes ReliefValves Scenarios Solver Tees Tips Description Collection of flow bleed node objects Collection of component objects Collection of connector objects Collection of control valve objects Collection of horizontal separator objects Collection of node objects Collection of pipe objects Collection of relief valve objects Collection of scenario objects Solver object Collection of tee objects Collection of flare tip objects Attributes IBleeds, read only IComponents, read only IConnectors, read only IControlValves, read only IHorizontalSepar ators, read only INodes, read only IPipes, read only IReliefValves, read only IScenarios, read only ISolver, read only ITees, read only ITips, read only IVerticalSeparato rs, read only Arguments

VerticalSeparators Collection of vertical separator objects Visible

Set visibility of the application Boolean, window read/write

Bleed
Description : Flow bleed node object Attributes : Methods
Name Connect(conidx as fntNodeEnd, pip as IPipe, pipeconidx as fntPipeEnd Disconnect(conidx as fntNodeEnd) Description Connect to a pipe Arguments conidx = Connection on bleed pip = Pipe to connect to pipeconidx = Connection on pipe Disconnect from a pipe conidx = Connection on bleed

IBleed, read only

Properties
Name PropertyByName(wh as String) PropertyNames Description Property value for a named property Variant array of all the property names Attributes Arguments Variant, read/write wh = Property name Variant, read only

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Named Properties For PropertyByName()


Name Ignored Location Name OfftakeMaximum OfftakeMinimum OfftakeMultiplier OfftakeOffset PressureDrop kg/hr bar kg/hr kg/hr Units Attributes fntYesNo, read/write String, read/write String, read/write Double, read/write Double, read/write Double, read/write Double, read/write Double, read/write

Bleeds
Description : Collection of flow bleed node objects Attributes : Methods
Name Add (Optional nm as Variant, Optional x as Single, Optional y as Single Delete (wh as Variant) Description Add a new bleed Arguments nm = Name. If omitted a new name is automatically generated x = X coordinate on PFD (Twips) y = Y coordinate on PFD (Twips) Delete a bleed wh = Index as Name (String) or Number (Integer/Long)

IBleed, read only

Properties
Name Count Item (wh as Variant) Description Number of items in the collection Indexed item in the collection Attributes Integer, read only IBleed, read only Wh = Index as Name (String) or Number (Integer/Long) Arguments

Component
Description : Component object Attributes : Methods
Name Clear EstimateUnknown Description Clear all component data Estimate all unknown component data Arguments

IComponent, read only

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 13 Automation The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

245

Properties
Name IsValid Description Validate component data is complete Attributes Boolean, read only Variant, read/write wh = Property name Variant, read only Arguments

PropertyByName(w Property value for a h as String) named property PropertyNames Variant array of all the property names

Named Properties For PropertyByName()


Name AcentricFactor AcentricFactorSrk CharacteristicVolume CriticalPressure CriticalTemperature CriticalVolume EnthalpyCoefficients m3/kgmole bar abs K m3/kgmole kJ/kgmole kJ/kgmole/K kJ/kgmole/K2 kJ/kgmole/K3 kJ/kgmole/K4 kJ/kgmole/K5 EntropyCoefficient Id MolecularWeight Name NormalBoilingPoint StandardDensity Type WatsonK ViscosityCoefficient K kg/m3 Double, read/write Integer, read/write Double, read/write String, read/write Double, read/write Double, read/write fntCompType, read/write Double, read/write Double(1 To 2), read/write Units Attributes Double, read/write Double, read/write Double, read/write Double, read/write Double, read/write Double, read/write Double(1 To 6), read/write

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Components
Description : Collection of component objects Attributes : Methods
Name AddLibrary(wh as Variant) AddHypothetical(wh as String) Delete(wh as Variant) Description Add a library component Add a named hypothetical component Delete a component Arguments wh = Component identifier as either name (String) or ID (Integer/Long) wh = Name for new component wh = Index as component as either Name (String) or Number (Integer/Long)

IComponents, read only

Properties
Name Count Item(What as Variant) Description Number of items in the collection Indexed item in the collection Attributes Integer, read only IComponent, read only What = Index as Name (String) Or Number (Integer/Long) Arguments

Connector
Description : Connector node object Attributes : Methods
Name Connect(conidx as fntNodeEnd, pip as IPipe, pipeconidx as fntPipeEnd) Disconnect(conidx as fntNodeEnd) Description Connect to a pipe Arguments conidx = Connection on connector pip = Pipe to connect to pipeconidx = Connection on pipe Disconnect from a pipe conidx = Connection on connector

IConnector, read only

Properties
Name Description Attributes Variant, read/write Variant, read only Arguments wh = Property name PropertyByName(w Property value for a h as String) named property PropertyNames Variant array of all the property names

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 13 Automation The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

247

Named Properties For PropertyByName()


Name Angle Ignored Length Location Name m Units radians Attributes Double, read/write fntYesNo, read/write Double, read/write String, read/write String, read/write

Connectors
Description : Collection of connector node objects Attributes : Methods
Name Add (Optional nm as Variant, Optional x as Single, Optional y as Single Delete (wh as Variant) Description Add a new connector Arguments nm = Name. If omitted a new name is automatically generated x = X coordinate on PFD (Twips) y = Y coordinate in PFD (Twips) Delete a Connector wh = Index as Name (String) or Number (Integer/Long)

IConnectors, read only

Properties
Name Count Item(What as Variant) Description Number of items in the collection Indexed item in the collection Attributes Integer, read only IConnector, read only What = Index as Name (String) Or Number (Integer/Long) Arguments

ControlValve
Description : Control valve node object Attributes : Methods
Name Connect(conidx as fntNodeEnd, pip as IPipe, pipeconidx as fntPipeEnd) Disconnect(conidx as fntNodeEnd)
3

IControlValve, read only


Description Connect to a pipe Arguments conidx = Connection on control valve pip = Pipe to connect to pipeconidx = Connection on pipe Disconnect from a pipe conidx = Connection on control valve

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Properties
Name Description Attributes Variant, read/write Arguments wh = Property name sc = Scenario Index as Name (String) or Number (Integer/Long) PropertyByName(w Property value for h as String, a named property [sc as Variant]) PropertyNames Variant array of all Variant, read the property only names

Named Properties For PropertyByName()


Name Composition CompositionBasis Energy Enthalpy Entropy FlangeDiameter FluidType Ignored Location LockMabp Mabp MassFlow MolecularWeight Name OutletMachNumber OutletSonicVelocity OutletTemperature OutletTemperatureSpecification OutletVelocity ReliefPressure StaticOutletPressure StaticInletPipePressureDrop Temperature TemperatureSepcification TotalOutletPressure TotalInletPipePressureDrop VapourFraction bar abs bar molar fraction m/s C C m/s bar abs bar abs bar C bar abs kg/hr kJ/hr kJ/kgmole kJ/kgmole/K mm Units fractions Attributes Double (1 To ?), read/write fntCompBasis, read/write Double, read only Double, read only Double, read only Double, read/write fntCompType, read/write fntYesNo, read/write String, read/write fntYesNo, read/write Double, read only Double, read/write Double, read/write String, read/write Double, read only Double, read only Double, read only Double, read only Double, read only Double, read only Double, read only Double, read only Double, read only fntTempSpec, read/write Double, read only Double, read only Double, read only

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 13 Automation The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

249

ControlValves
Description : Collection of control valve node objects Attributes : Methods
Name Add (Optional nm as Variant, Optional x as Single, Optional y as Single) Delete(wh as Variant) Description Add a new control valve Arguments nm = Name. If omitted a new name is automatically generated x = X coordinate on PFD (Twips) y = Y coordinate on PFD (Twips) Delete a control valve wh = Index as Name (String) or Number (Integer/Long)

IControlValves

Properties
Name Count Description Number of items in the collection Attributes Integer, read only IControlValve, read only wh = Index as Name (String) or Number (Integer/Long) Arguments

Item(wh as Indexed item in the Variant) collection

HorizontalSeparator
Description : Horizontal separator node object Attributes : Methods
Name Connect(conidx as fntNodeEnd, pip as IPipe, pipeconidx as fntPipeEnd) Disconnect(conidx as fntNodeEnd) Description Connect to a pipe Arguments conidx = Connection on horizontal separator pip = Pipe to connect to pipeconidx = Connection on pipe Disconnect from a pipe conidx = Connection on horizontal separator

IHorizontalSeparator, read only

Properties
Name PropertyByName( wh as String) PropertyNames Description Property value for a named property Variant array of all the property names Attributes Variant, read/write Variant, read only Arguments wh = Property name

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Named Properties For PropertyByName()


Name Diameter Ignored LiquidLevel Location Name mm Units mm Attributes Double, read/write fntYesNo, read/write Double, read/write String, read/write String, read/write

HorizontalSeparators
Description : Collection of horizontal separator node objects Attributes : Method
Name Add (Optional nm as Variant, Optional x as Single, Optional y as Single) Delete(wh as Variant) Description Add a new horizontal separator Delete a horizontal separator Arguments nm = Name. If omitted a new name is automatically generated x = X coordinate on PFD (Twips) y = Y coordinate on PFD (Twips) wh = Index as Name (String) or Number (Integer/Long)

IHorizontalSeparators, read only

Properties
Name Count Item(What as Variant) Description Number of items in the collection Indexed item in the collection Attributes Integer, read only IHorizontalSepar ator, read only What = Index as Name (String) Or Number (Integer/Long) Arguments

Nodes
Description : Collection of all node objects Attributes : Properties
Name Count Description Number of items in the collection Attributes Integer, read only Arguments

INodes, read only

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 13 Automation The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

251

OrificePlate
Description : Orifice plate node object Attributes : Method
Name Connect(conidx as fntNodeEnd, pip as IPipe, pipeconidx as fntPipeEnd) Disconnect(conidx as fntNodeEnd) Description Connect to a pipe Arguments conidx = Connection on orifice plate pip = Pipe to connect to pipeconidx = Connection on pipe Disconnect from a pipe conidx = Connection on orifice plate

IOrificePlate, read only

Properties
Name Description Attributes Variant, read/write Arguments wh = Property name PropertyByName Property value for a (wh as String) named property PropertyNames

Variant array of all the Variant, read only property names

Named Properties For PropertyByName()


Name Diameter DratioIn DratioOut Ignored Location Name Units mm Attributes Double, read/write Double, read/write Double, read/write fntYesNo, read/write String, read/write String, read/write

OrificePlates
Description : Collection of orifice plate node objects Attributes : Methods
Name Add (Optional nm as Variant, Optional x as Single, Optional y as Single) Description Ass a new orifice plate Arguments nm = Name. If omitted a new name is automatically generated x = X coordinate on PFD (Twips) y = Y coordinate on PFD (Twips)

IOrificePlates, read only

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Delete(wh as Variant)

Delete an orifice plate

wh = Index as Name (String) or Number (Integer/Long)

Properties
Name Count Description Number of items in the collection Attributes Integer, read only IOrificePlate, read only What = Index as Name (String) Or Number (Integer/Long) Arguments

Item(Wha Indexed item in the collection t as Variant)

Pipe
Description : Pipe object Attributes : Methods Name AddFitting(FittingName As String, Optional Count As Integer = 1) Description Add a fiitting to the fittings list Arguments FittingName = Name of fitting defined in the pipe fittings database Count = Number of fittings of this type to add Connect(conidx as fntPipeEnd, nod as Object, nodeconidx as fntNodeEnd) Connect to a node conidx = Connection on pipe nod = Node to connect to nodeconidx = Connection on DeleteAllFittings() Delete all fittings from the fittings list Delete a fitting from the fittings list Delete a fitting from the fittings list FittingIndex = Index of fitting in the fittings list to delete FittingName = Name of fitting defined in the pipe fittings database IPipe, read only

DeleteFittingByIndex(FittingIndex As Integer)

DeleteFittingByName(FittingName As String, Optional Count As Integer = 1)

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 13 Automation The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

253

Count = Number of fittings of this type to delete Disconnect(conidx as fntPipeEnd) GetFittingCount() As Integer Disconnect from a node Get number of fittings in the fitting list Get name of indeded pipe fitting FittingIndex = Index of fitting in the fittings list to retreive name for conidx = Connection on

GetFittingName(FittingIndex As Integer) As String

Properties
Name PropertyByName(wh as String, [sc as Variant], [ph as Variant], [en as Variant]) Description Property value for a named property Attributes Variant, read /write Arguments wh = Property name sc = Scenario Index as Name (String) or Number (Integer/Long) ph = Phase Index (fntFluidPhase) en = Pipe end (fntPipeEnd) PropertyNames Variant array of Variant, all the property read only names Flag to indicate Boolean, if a fittings list read/write is used instead of loss coefficients

UseFittings

Named Properties For PropertyByName()


Name AccelerationPressureDrop AmbientTemperature CanSize MoleFractions Density Duty ElevationChange ElevationPressureDrop Emissivity Energy Enthalpy Entropy
3

Units bar C

Attributes Double, read only Double, read only fntYesNo, read/write Double(1 To ?), read only

kg/m3 kJ/hr m bar kJ/hr kJ/kgmole kJ/kgmole/K

Double, read only Double, read only Double, read/write Double, read only Double, read only Double, read only Double, read only Double, read only

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

continued Name EquivalentLength ExternalDuty ExternalHeatTransferCoefficient ExternalRadiativeHeatTransferCoefficient ExternalTemperature FittingsLossConstant FittingsLossMultiplier FittingsPressureDrop FlowRegime FrictionFactor FrictionPressureDrop HeatCapacity HeatTransfer Ignored IgnoreHeadRecovery InsulationName InsulationThickness InsulationThermalConductivity InternalDiameter Length LengthMultiplier Location MachNumber MassFlow Material MolecularWeight MolarFlow Name Noise NominalDiameter OutletTemperatureSpecification OverallHeatTransferCoefficient UsePipeClass PhaseFraction PressureDrop RatedMassFlow ReynoldsNumber RhoV2 Roughness StaticPressure Schedule kg/m/s2 mm bar abs bar kg/hr C W/m2/K dB kgmole/hr kg/hr mm W/m/K mm m bar kJ/kgmole/K kJ/hr bar Units m W W/m2/K W/m2/K C Attributes Double, read only Double, read/write Double, read only Double, read only Double, read only Double, read only Double, read only Double, read only fntFlowRegime, read only Double, read only Double, read only Double, read only Double, read only fntYesNo, read/write fntYesNo, read/write String, read/write Double, read/ write Double, read/write Double, read/write Double, read/write Double, read/write String, read/write Double, read only Double, read/write fntPipeMaterial, read/write Double, read only Double, read only String, read/write Double, read only String, read/write Double, read/write Double, read only fntYesNo, read/write Double, read only Double, read only Double, read only Double, read only Double, read only Double, read/write Double, read only String, read/write

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 13 Automation The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

255

SurfaceTension TailPipe Temperature ThermalConductivity TotalPressure VapourFraction Velocity Viscosity WallThermalConductivity Name WallTemperature WallThickness WindSpeed Zfactor

dynes/cm C W/m/K bar abs m/s cP W/m/K Units C mm m/s

Double, read only fntYesNo, read/write Double, read only Double, read only Double, read only Double, read only Double, read only Double, read/write Attributes Double, read only Double, read/write Double, read/write Double, read only

molar fraction Double, read only

Pipes
Description : Collection of pipe Attributes : Methods
Name Add (Optional nm as Variant, Optional x as Single, Optional y as Single) Delete(wh as Variant) Description Add a new pipe Arguments nm = Name. If omitted a new name is automatically generated x = X coordinate on PFD (Twips) y = Y coordinate on PFD (Twips) Delete a pipe wh = Index as Name (String) or Number (Integer/Long)

IPipes

Properties
Name Count Item(wh as Variant) Description Number of items in the collection Indexed item in the collection Attributes Integer, read only IPipe, read only wh = Index as Name (String) or Number (Integer/Long) Arguments

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

ReliefValve
Description : Relief valve node object Attributes : Methods
Name Connect(conidx as fntNodeEnd, pip as IPipe, pipeconidx as fntPipeEnd) Disconnect(conidx as fntNodeEnd) Description Connect to a pipe Arguments conidx = Connection on relief valve pip = Pipe to connect to pipeconidx = Connection on pipe Disconnect from a pipe conidx = Connection on relief valve

IReliefValve, read only

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 13 Automation The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

257

Properties
Name Description Attributes Variant, read/write Arguments wh = Property name sc = Scenario Index as Name (String) or Number (Integer/Long) PropertyByName Property value for a (wh as String, named property [sc as Variant])

PropertyNames

Variant array of all the Variant, read only property names

Named Properties For PropertyByName()


Name Composition CompositionBasis Contingency Energy Enthalpy Entropy FlangeDiameter FluidType HemCd HemLiqCd Ignored Kb Location LockMabp LockReliefPressure LockRatedMassFlow Mabp MassFlow Mawp MechanicalPressure MolecularWeight Name Orifice OutletMachNumber OutletSonicVelocity OutletTemperature OutletTemperatureSpecification OutletVelocity m/s C C m/s bar abs kg/hr bar abs bar abs kJ/hr kJ/kgmole kJ/kgmole/K mm Units fractions Attributes Double (1 To ?), read/write fntCompBasis, read/write fntContingency, read/write Double, read only Double, read only Double, read only Double, read/write fntCompType, read/write Double, read/write Double. Read/write fntYesNo, read/write Double, read/write String, read/write fntYesNo, read/write fntYesNo, read/write fntYesNo, read/write Double, read only Double, read/write Double, read/write Double, read/write Double, read/write String, read/write String, read/write Double, read only Double, read only Double, read only Double, read only Double, read only

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

RatedMassFlow ReliefPressure SizingBackPressure SizingMethod StaticOutletPressure StaticInletPipePressureDrop Temperature TemperatureSpecification

kg/hr bar abs Bar abs bar abs bar C

Double, read/write Double, read only Double, read/write Integer, read/write Double, read only Double, read only Double, read only fntTempSpec, read/write

Name TotalOutletPressure TotalInletPipePressureDrop ValveArea ValveCount ValveType VapourFraction

Units bar abs bar mm2

Attributes Double, read only Double, read only Double, read/write Integer, read/write fntPsvType, read/write

molar fraction Double, read only

ReliefValves
Description : Collection of relief valve node objects Attributes : Methods
Name Add (Optional nm as Variant, Optional x as Single, Optional y as Single) Delete(wh as Variant) Description Add a new relief valve Arguments nm = Name. If omitted a new name is automatically generated x = X coordinate on PFD (Twips) y = Y coordinated on PFD (Twips) Delete a relief valve wh = Index as Name (String) or Number (Integer/Long)

IReleifValves

Properties
Name Count Item(wh as Variant) Description Number of items in the collection Indexed item in the collection Attributes Integer, read only IReliefValve, read only wh = Index as Name (String) or Number (Integer/Long) Arguments

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 13 Automation The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

259

Scenario
Description : Scenario object Attributes : Properties
Name Description Attributes Variant, read/write Arguments wh = Property name PropertyByName Property value for a (wh as String) named property PropertyNames

IScenario, read only

Variant array of all the Variant, read only property names

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Named Properties For PropertyByName()


Name AtmosphericPressure Calculate HeaderLiquidVelocityLimit HeaderMachLimit HeaderNoiseLimit HeaderRhoV2Limit HeaderVapourVelocityLimit Name TailpipeLiquidVelocityLimit TailpipeMachLimit TailpipeNoiseLimit TailpipeRhoV2Limit TailpipeVapourVelocityLimit dB kg/m/s2 m/s m/s dB kg/m/s2 m/s m/s Units bar abs Attributes Double, read/write fntYesNo, read/write Double, read/write Double, read/write Double, read/write Double, read/write Double, read/write String, read/write Double, read/write Double, read/write Double, read/write Double, read/write Double, read/write

Scenarios
Description : Collection of scenario objects Attributes : Methods
Name Add(nm As String, [cl as Integer]) Delete(wh as Variant) Delete a scenario Description Add a new scenario Arguments nm = New scenario name cl = Index of scenario to copy data from for initialization wh = Index as Name (String) or Number (Integer/Long)

IScenarios, read only

Properties
Name Active Active Description Get active scenario Set active scenario Attributes IScenario, read only wh = Index as Name (String) or Number (Integer/Long) Arguments

Count Item(wh as Variant)

Number of items in the Integer, read only collection Indexed item in the collection IScenario, read only wh = Index as Name (String) or Number (Integer/Long)

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 13 Automation The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

261

Solver
Description : Solver object Attributes : Methods
Name Halt Start Description Stop calculations Start calculations Arguments

ISolver, read only

Properties
Name IsActive Description Get calculation status Attributes Boolean, read only Variant, read/write Variant, read only wh = Property name Arguments

PropertyByName(w Property value for a h as String) named property PropertyNames Variant array of all the property names

Named Properties For PropertyByName()


Name AmbientTemperature AtmosphericPressure CalculationMode CheckChokedFlow Elements EnableHeatTransfer EnthalpyMethod InitialPressure KineticEnergyBasis LengthMultiplier LoopIteration LoopIterationLimit LoopTolerance PressureDropMethod PropertyIteration PropertyIterationLimit PropertyTolerance ScenarioMode % % bar abs Units C bar abs Attributes Double, read/write Double, read/write fntCalcMode, read/write fntYesNo, read/write Integer, read/write fntYesNo, read/write fntEnthMethod, read/write Double, read/write fntKeBasis, read/write Double, read/write Integer, read only Integer, read/write Double, read/write fntPresDropMethod(0 to 2), read/write Integer, read only Integer, read/write Double, read/write fntScenarioMode, read/write

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

UnitOperationTolerance UseKineticEnergy UseRatedFlow VleMethod WindSpeed

Double, read/write fntYesNo, read/write fntYesNo, read/write fntVleMethod, read/write Double, read/write

Tee
Description : Tee node object Attributes : Methods
Name Connect(conidx as fntNodeEnd, pip as IPipe, pipeconidx as fntPipeEnd) Description Connect to a pipe Arguments conidx = Connection to tee pip = Pipe to connect to pipeconidx = Connection on pipe Disconnect(conidx as fntNodeEnd) Disconnect from a pipe conidx - Connection on tee

ITee, read only

Properties
Name PropertyByName( wh as String) PropertyNames Description Property value for a named property Variant array of all the property names Attributes Variant, read/write Variant, read only Arguments wh = Property name

Named Properties For PropertyByName()


Name Angle Body Ignored Location Name Units Attributes fntTeeAngle, read/write fntTeeEnd, read/write fntYesNo, read/write String, read/write String, read/write

Tees
Description : Collection of tee node objects Attributes : ITees, read only

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 13 Automation The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

263

Method
Name Add (Optional nm as Variant, Optional x as Single, Optional y as Single) Description Add a new tee Arguments nm = Name. If omitted a new name is automatically generated x = X coordinate on PFD (Twips) y = Y coordinate on PFD (Twips) Delete(wh as Variant) Delete a tee wh = Index as Name (String) or Number (Integer/Long)

Properties
Name Count Item(wh as Variant) Description Number of items in the collection Indexed item in the collection Attributes Integer, read only IConnector, read only wh = Index as Name (String) Or Number (Integer/Long) Arguments

Tip
Description : Flare tip node object Attributes : Methods
Name AddCurve() Description Add a pressure drop curve wh = Index of curve Arguments

ITip, read only

AddCurvePoint(w Append a point to a h as Integer) pressure drop curve DeleteCurve(wh as Integer) DeleteCurvePoint (wh as Integer, id as Integer)

Delete a pressure drop wh = Index of curve curve wh = Index of curve id = Index of point

Properties
Name CurveMolwt(wh as Integer) Description Molecular weight of indexed pressure drop curve Attributes Arguments Double, read/write wh = Curve index

CurvePointMassF Mass flow of point on a Double, read/write wh = Index of curve pressure drop curve low(Wh as id = Index of point (kg/hr) Integer, id as Integer)
3

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

CurvePointPressu Pressure drop of point on a pressure drop reDrop(Wh as curve (bar) Integer, id as Integer) PropertyByName Property value for a (wh as String) named property PropertyNames

Double, read/write wh = Index of curve id = Index of point Variant, read/write wh = Property name

Variant array of all the Variant, read only property names

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 13 Automation The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

265

Named Properties For PropertyByName()


Name Diameter Ignored K Kbasis Location Name Reference Temperature UseCurves Units mm Attributes Double, read/write fntYesNo, read/write Double, read/write fntKbasis, read/write String, read/write String, read/write Double, read/write fntYesNo, read/write

Tips
Description : Collection of flare tip node objects Attributes : Methods
Name Add (Optional nm as Variant, Optional x as Single, Optional y as Single) Description Add a new tip Arguments nm = Name. If omitted a new name is automatically generated x = X coordinate on PFD (Twips) y = Y coordinate on PFD (Twips) Delete(wh as Variant) Delete a tip wh = Index as Name (String) or Number (Integer/Long)

ITip, read only

Properties
Name Count Item(What as Variant) Description Number of items in the collection Indexed item in the collection Attributes Integer, read only IConnector, read only What = Index as Name (String) Or Number (Integer/Long) Arguments

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

VerticalSeparator
Description : Vertical separator node object Attributes : Methods
Name Connect(conidx as fntNodeEnd, pip as IPipe, pipeconidx as fntPipeEnd) Description Connect to a pipe Arguments conidx = Connection on vertical separator pip = Pipe to connect to pipeconidx = Connection on pipe Disconnect(conidx as fntNodeEnd) Disconnect from a pipe conidx - Connection on vertical separator

IVerticalSeparator, read only

Properties
Name Description Attributes Variant, read/write Arguments wh = Property name PropertyByName Property value for a (wh as String) named property PropertyNames

Variant array of all the Variant, read only property names

Named Properties For PropertyByName()


Name Diameter Ignored Location Name Units mm Attributes Double, read/write Boolean, read/write String, read/write String, read/write

VerticalSeparators
Description : Collection of vertical separator node objects Attributes : Methods
Name Add (Optional nm as Variant, Optional x as Single, Optional y as Single) Description Add a new vertical separator Arguments nm = Name. If omitted a new name is automatically generated x = X coordinate on PFD (Twips)

IVerticalSeparators, read only

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 13 Automation The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

267

y = Y coordinate on PFD (Twips) Delete(wh as Variant) Delete a vertical separator wh = Index as Name (String) or Number (Integer/Long)

Properties
Name Count Item(What as Variant) Description Number of items in the collection Indexed item in the collection Attributes Integer, read only IHorizontalSepara What = Index as Name tor, read only (String) Or Number (Integer/Long) Arguments

Example Automation In Visual Basic


This complete example has also been pre-built and is located in the Flarenet\Samples \Ole\Vb\Bounds directory This example will show how that Flare System Analyzer can be used as an automation server by a program that analyses a Flare System Analyzer model to search for the maximum and minimum values of a user defined named property within all the pipes. Note: Although Visual Basic 6 is recommended for this example, you may create the Automation application in the Visual Basic editor provided in Microsoft Excel 97 and Microsoft Word 97. 1 Open a new project in Visual Basic 6 and from the New tab of the New Project property view select the Standard EXE icon and press the Open button. Your screen should appear similar to Figure 16.6. Fig 12.6

By default you should have a form associated with the project. Begin, by giving the form a name. In the Name field of the Properties Window give the form the name:frmBounds. Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

3 4

In the Caption field type: Flare System Analyzer Model Pipe Property Bounds. This caption should now appear in the title bar of the form. Before adding objects to the forn, resize the view to accommodate the different objects that will be required.. In the Width filed found in the Properties Window change the width of the form to 4500 or to any value such that the from is sufficiently wide to fully display the caption. From the Tool Box select the Text Box button and create a text box on the forma as shown in Figure 16.7. Fig 12.7

Ensure that the text box is the active control. This can be done in one of two ways:
o o

Select the text box on the form so that the object guides appear around the object. From the drop down list found at the top of the properties windows select the name of the text box you have just created.

In the Properties windows, set the name of the text box as ebModelName in the Name field. If you wish, you may also change the default text that appears inside the edit box by entering a new name in the Text field. You may add a label to the form. i.e. to identify the object from others, by selecting the Label tool and drawing the label on the form just above the text box you have just created. Ensuring that the label control is active using one of the methods suggested in step 6, go to the Properties Window and change the text in the Caption field to Model Name.

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 13 Automation The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

269

Fig 12.8

10 Add the following objects to the form using the previously described methods. Fig 12.9

11 Only two more objects are required on the form. Select the Command Button control from the tool bar and add two buttons to the form as shown in Figure 12.10

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Fig 12.10

12 You are now ready to begin defining the events behind the form and objects. You may enter the code environment using a number of methods:
o o o

Click the View Code button. Select the Code option from the View menu. Double click the frmBounds form.

Fig 12.11 The Private Sub Form_Load() method definition will only be visible if you enter the code environment by double clicking the form.

13 Begin by declaring the following variables under the Option Explicit Declaration.

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 13 Automation The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

271

Fig 12.12

14 Add a reference to the Flare System Analyzer type library to allow access to predefined constants by selecting References from the Project menu. Fig 12.13

15 The first subroutine should already be declared. The Form_Load subroutine is the first subroutine called once the program is run. It is usually used to initialize the variables and objects used by the program. Enter the following code into the Form_Load subroutine.
Code Private Sub Form_Load() Explanation Signifies the start of the form load subroutine. You do not have to add as it should already be there Clears all the text fields

ebModelName.Text = "" ebPropertyName.Text = "" ebMinValue.Text = "" ebMaxValue.Text = ""


End Sub

Signifies the end of the initialization subroutine. This line does not need to be added.

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

16 The next section of code to be added is what will occur when the name of the model is changed in the ebModelName box.
Code Private Sub ebModelName_Validate(Cancel As Boolean) Explanation Signifies the start of the subroutine.

ModelName = ebModelName.Text
End Sub

Copies the entered name for the model to the String Variable ModelName Signifies the end of the subroutine.

17 The next section of code to be added is what will occur when the desired property is changed in the ebPropertyName box.
Code Private Sub ebPropertyName_Validate(Cancel As Boolean) Explanation Signifies the start of the subroutine.

PropertyName = ebPropertyName.Text
End Sub

Copies the entered name for the property to the String Variable PropertyName Signifies the end of the subroutine.

18 The final two routines define the actions of the two buttons: btnUpdate and btnExit.
Code Private Sub btnUpdate_Click() Explanation Signifies the start of the subroutine. Declare work variables

Dim MaxVal As Double Dim MinVal As Double Dim Pipe As Flare System Analyzer.IPipe Dim WorkVal As Double On Error Resume Next If Trim$(ModelName) = "" Then Set FnApp = GetObject(, "Flare System Analyzer.Application") Else Set FnApp = CreateObject("Flare System Analyzer.Application") FnApp.OpenModel ModelName End If If Not FnApp Is Nothing Then

Prevents an error from being raised if for example an invalid name for the property is selected If a model name is defined then opens the model defined by the String variable ModelName otherwise connects to the currently running instance of Flare System Analyzer.

Ensure successful connection to the Application object

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 13 Automation The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

273

MaxVal = -10000000000# MinVal = 10000000000# For Each Pipe In FnApp.Pipes WorkVal = Pipe.PropertyByName(PropertyNam e)
Code

Initializes the maximum and minimum values to values outside the range of possible values. Loop through all the pipes in the model Get the property named and stores in the String variable PropertyName

Explanation Check for an unknown value. Do not consider the value further if it is unknown. Update maximum value Update minimum value End of loop and value update

If WorkVal <> fntUnknownValue Then If WorkVal > MaxVal Then MaxVal = WorkVal If WorkVal < MinVal Then MinVal = WorkVal End If Next ebMinValue.Text = Format$(MinVal, "0.000e+00") ebMaxValue.Text = Format$(MaxVal, "0.000e+00") Set FnApp = Nothing End If End Sub

Update the displayed values in the ebMinValue and ebMaxValue Text boxes.

Disconnect the Application object

Signifies the end of the subroutine.

Code Private Sub btnExit_Click()

Explanation Signifies the start of the subroutine. Releases the connection to Flare System Analyzer Unload the form and end the program

Set FnApp = Nothing Unload Me End


End Sub

Signifies the end of the subroutine.

19 You are now ready to compile and run the program. Before you begin, please ensure that you have a copy of Flare System Analyzer on the computer. 20 To compile the program do one of the following:
o o o

Click the Start button... Select Start from the Run menu. Press <F5> from the keyboard. Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Visual Basic will inform you of any errors that occur during compile time.

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com 13 Automation The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

275

A Theoretical Basis

Pressure Drop
Pipe Pressure Drop Method
Vapor Phase Pressure Drop Methods
Pressure drop can be calculated either from the theoretically derived equation for isothermal flow of a compressible fluid in a horizontal pipe2:
2 2 L G G P1 M P2 P1 + + 2 f f = 0 In a 2 RT a P2 2

A.1

where : G = Mass flow a = Cross sectional area of pipe P1 = Upstream pressure P2 = Downstream pressure R = Universal gas constant f f = Fanning friction factor

= Internal diameter
L = Equivalent length T = Temperature M = Molecular weight

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Or from the theoretically derived equation for adiabatic flow of a compressible fluid in a horizontal pipe2:
2 L - 1 P1 a V1 + 1 Af f = 2 V1 G V2 2

+1 V In 2 V 1

A.2

where : G = Mass flow a = Cross sectional area of pipe P1 = Upstream pressure R = Universal gas constant V1 = Upstream specific volume V2 = Downstream specific volume f f = Fanning friction factor

= Internal diameter
L = Equivalent length = Ratio of specific heats
The friction factor is calculated using an equation appropriate for the flow regime. These equations correlate the friction factor to the pipe diameter, Reynolds number and roughness of the pipe4: Turbulent Flow (Re > 4000) The friction factor may be calculated from either the Round equation:

1 ff
A.3

Re = 3.61 log e 0.135 Re + 6.5

where : f f = Fanning friction factor Re = Reynolds number = Internal diameter e = Absolute pipe roughness

www.cadfamily.comBasis EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com A Theoretical The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

277

Or from the Chen21 equation:

1 ff
A.4

0.8981 1.1098 e / 5.0452 (e / ) 7.149 = 4 log + log 2.8257 Re Re 3.7065

where : f f = Fanning friction factor Re = Reynolds number = Internal diameter e = Absolute pipe roughness
Transition Flow (2100 Re 4000)

1 ff
A.5

e 5.02 e e 5.02 13.0 = 4.0 log log log 3.7 Re 3.7 Re 3.7 Re

where : f f = Fanning friction factor Re = Reynolds number = Internal diameter e = Absolute pipe roughness
Laminar Flow (Re < 2100)

ff =
A.6

16 Re

where : f f = Fanning friction factor Re = Reynolds number


The Moody friction factor is related to the Fanning friction factor by:

fm = 4 f f
A.7

where : f f = Fanning friction factor f m = Moody friction factor

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

2-Phase Pressure Drop


Although the Beggs and Brill method was not intended for use with vertical pipes, it is nevertheless commonly used for this purpose, and is therefore included as an option for vertical pressure drop methods.

Beggs and Brill


The Beggs and Brill9 method is based on work done with an air-water mixture at many different conditions, and is applicable for inclined flow. In the Beggs and Brill correlation, the flow regime is determined using the Froude number and inlet liquid content. The flow map used is based on horizontal flow and has four regimes: segregated, intermittent, distributed and transition. Once the flow regime has been determined, the liquid hold-up for a horizontal pipe is calculated, using the correlation applicable to that regime. A factor is applied to this hold-up to account for pipe inclination. From the hold-up, a two-phase friction factor is calculated and the pressure gradient determined. Fig A.1

The boundaries between regions are defined in terms of two constants and the Froude number10:

L1 = exp( 4.62 3.757 x 0.481x 2 0.0207 x 3 )

A.8

L2 = exp(1.061 4.602 x 1.609 x 2 0.0179 x 3 + 0.000625 x 5 )

A.9

www.cadfamily.comBasis EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com A Theoretical The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

279

where : x = In( ) = Input liquid content = qliquid / (qliquid + q gas ) q = In situ volumetric flowrate

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

According to Beggs and Brill: 1 2 3 If the Froude number is less than L1, the flow pattern is segregated. If the Froude number is greater than both L1 and L2, the flow pattern is distributed. If the Froude number is greater than L1 and smaller than L2 the flow pattern is intermittent.

Dukler Method
The Dukler10 method breaks the pressure drop into three components Friction, Elevation and Acceleration. The total pressure drop is the sum of the pressure drop due to these components:

PTotal = PF + PE + PA
A.10

where : PTotal = Total change in pressure PF = Change in pressure due to friction PE = Change in pressure due to elevation PA = Change in pressure due to acceleration
The pressure drop due to friction is:
2

2 f LV m m PF = TP 144 g c D
A.11

where : f TP = Two phase friction factor ( determined empirically ) L = Equivalent length of the pipeline ( ft ) Vm = Velocity of the two phase mixture in pipeline assuming equal velocity ( ft / s ) m = Density of two phase mixture (lb / ft 3 ) g c = Gravitational constant (32.2lbm ft / lbf s 2 ) D = Inside diameter of pipe ( ft )

www.cadfamily.comBasis EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com A Theoretical The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

281

The pressure drop due to elevation is as follows:

PE =
A.12

Eh L H 144

where : E h = Liquid head factor (determined empirically ) L = Liquid density

H = Sum of

elevation changes

The pressure drop due to acceleration is usually very small in oil/gas distribution systems, but becomes significant in flare systems:

PA =
A.13

1 144 g c A 2

2 g QGPL Q 2 + L LPL 1 RL RL

2 Q2 g GPL + L QLPL cos RL DS 1 RL US

where : A = Cross sectional area g = Gas density QGPL = Volume of gas flowing at pipeline temperature and pressure ( ft 3 / hr ) Q LPL = Volume of liquid flowing at pipeline temperature and pressure ( ft 3 / hr ) R L = Liquid holdup in pipeline as a percentage of pipeline capacity = Angle of the pipe bend

Orkiszewski Method
The Orkiszewski11,12 method assumes there are four different flow regimes existing in vertical two-phase flow - bubble, slug, annular-slug transition and annular-mist. The bubble flow regime consists mainly of liquid with a small amount of a free-gas phase. The gas phase consists of small, randomly distributed gas bubbles with varying diameters. The gas phase has little effect on the pressure gradient (with the exception of its density). In the slug flow regime, the gas phase is most pronounced. The gas bubbles coalesce and form stable bubbles of approximately the same size and shape. The gas bubbles are separated by slugs of a continuous liquid phase. There is a film of liquid around the gas bubbles. The gas bubbles move faster than the liquid phase. At high flow velocities, the liquid can become entrained in the gas bubbles. The gas and liquid phases may have significant effects on the pressure gradient. Transition flow is the regime where the change from a continuous liquid phase to a continuous gas phase occurs. In this regime, the gas phase becomes more dominant, with a significant amount of liquid becoming entrained in the
3

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

gas phase. The liquid slug between the gas bubbles virtually disappears in the transition regime. In the annular-mist regime, the gas phase is continuous and is the controlling phase. The bulk of the liquid is entrained and carried in the gas phase. Orkiszewski defined bubble flow, slug flow, mist flow and gas velocity numbers which are used to determine the appropriate flow regime. If the ratio of superficial gas velocity to the non-slip velocity is less than the bubble flow number, then bubble flow exists, for which the pressure drop is:

VsL R L P = f tp L 2gc D
A.14

where : P = Pressure drop (lb / ft 2 per foot of length) f tp = Two phase friction factor L = Liquid density (lb / ft 3 ) VsL = Superficial liquid velocity ( ft / s ) R L = Dimensionless factor dependent on non slip velocity g c = Gravitational constant (32.2 lbm ft / lbf s 2 ) D = Hydraulic diameter ( ft )
If the ratio of superficial gas velocity to the non-slip velocity is greater than the bubble flow number, and the gas velocity number is smaller than the slug flow number, then slug flow exists. The pressure drop in this case is:
2 f tp LVns P = 2g c D

VsL + Vr + Vns + Vr

A.15

where : Vns = Non slip velocity Vr = Bubble rise velocity = Constant

www.cadfamily.comBasis EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com A Theoretical The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

283

The pressure drop calculation for mist flow is as follows:

P = f tp g
A.16

(V )
sg

2gc D

where : V sg = Superficial gas velocity ( ft / s ) g = Gas density (lb / ft 3 )


The pressure drop for transition flow is:

P = Ps + (1 x )Pm
A.17

where : Ps = Pressure drop for slug flow Pm = Pressure drop for mixed flow x = Weighting factor , dependent on mist flow, slug flow, and gas velocity numbers
The pressure drop calculated by the previous equations, are for a one-foot length of pipe. These are converted to total pressure drop by:

Ptotal =

PL Qtotal G f 144 1 2 4637 PA p

A.18

where : = Density of the flowing regime (lb / ft 3 ) Qtotal = Mass rate of combined liquid / gas (lb / s ) G f = Gas flow rate ( ft 3 / s ) A p = Cross sectional area of pipe ( ft 2 ) p = Average pressure in segment ( psia ) P = Unit pressure drop (as calculated above) L = Length of line segment ( ft )

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Fittings Pressure Change Methods


The correlations used for the calculation of the pressure change across a fitting are expressed using either the change in static pressure or the change in total pressure. Static pressure and total pressure are related by the relationship:

Pt = Ps +
A.19

v 2 2

In this equation and all subsequent equations, the subscript t refers to total pressure and the subscript s refers to the static pressure.

Enlargers/Contractions
The pressure change across an enlargement or contraction may be calculated using either incompressible or compressible methods. For two phase systems a correction factor that takes into account the effect of slip between the phases may be applied. Figure A.2 and A.3 define the configurations for enlargements and contractions. In these figures the subscript 1 always refers to the fitting inlet and subscript 2 always refers to the fitting outlet.

Fig A.2 Fig A.3

www.cadfamily.comBasis EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com A Theoretical The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

285

Incompressible Single Phase Flow


The total pressure change across the fitting is given by:

Pt = K1 +
A.20

1v12 2

where : p = Total pressure change K = Fittings loss coefficient = Mass density v = Velocity
Sudden and Gradual Enlargement For an enlarger the fittings loss coefficient is calculated from the ratio of the smaller diameter to the larger diameter, .

d1 d2

A.21 The fitting loss coefficients are defined by Crane26 If < 45

K1 = 2.6 sin 1 2 2
A.22 Otherwise

K1 = 1 2
A.23

Sudden and Gradual Contraction For a contraction the fittings loss coefficient is calculated from ratio of the smaller area to the larger area, .

d = 2 d 1
3

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

A.24

www.cadfamily.comBasis EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com A Theoretical The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

287

The fittings loss coefficients are defined by HTFS27

K t = 19.2211 2 + 8.54038 2.5 + 14.242651.5 4.5385 + 0.39543 0.5 + 0.57806


A.25

K1 =
A.26

K t Cc 2

The contraction coefficient, is defined by If = 180 (Abrupt contraction)

Cc =
A.27

1 1 + 0.41(1 - )

Otherwise

Cc = 0.0179le 9.6240' + 0.03614(' (1 + '))


A.28

4.79028 0.25

where : ' = /180 o


Incompressible Two Phase Flow
Sudden and Gradual Enlargement The static pressure change across the fitting is given by HTFS27

1 2 K1 1 + 2 m1 2 Ps = LO 2 l
A.29
2 x g l (1 x g ) = + g g 1- g 2

2 LO

A.30

where : m = Mass flux = Phase mass density = Phase void fraction x = Phase mass fraction
Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Sudden and Gradual Contraction The static pressure change across the fitting is given by HTFS27

Ps =
A.31

(K

2 + 1 2 m2 2 LO 2 l

2 2 LO = L (1 x g )2

A.32
2 L = 1 +

C 1 + 2 X X
g l
0.5

A.33

1 xg X = x g
A.34

C = l g
A.35

0.5

+ g l

0.5

where : m = Mass flux = Phase mass density = Phase void fraction x = Phase mass fraction
Compressible Single Phase Flow
Sudden and Gradual Enlargement The static pressure change across the fitting is given by HTFS27

Ps =
A.36

m12 1 1 1 2

where : m = Mass flux = Phase mass density

www.cadfamily.comBasis EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com A Theoretical The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

289

Sudden and Gradual Contraction The static pressure change across the fitting is calculated using the two-phase method given in Compressible Two Phase Flow below. The single-phase properties are used in place of the two-phase properties.

Compressible Two Phase Flow


Sudden and Gradual Enlargement The static pressure change across the fitting is given by HTFS27

Ps =
A.37

m12 vE 2 v E1

where : vE = Equivalent specific volume given by


(1 xg ) 1 + (uR 1)2 vE = (x g v g + u R (1 x g )vl ) x g + u R v g 0.5 v 1 l
A.38

v uR = H v l
A.39

0.5

vH = x g v g + (1 x g )vl

A.40

where : m = Mass flux = Phase mass density x = Phase mass fraction


Sudden and Gradual Contraction The pressure loss comprises two components. These are the contraction of the fluid as is passed from the inlet to the vena contracta plus the expansion of the fluid as it passes from the vena contracta to the outlet. In the following equations the subscript t refers to the condition at the vena contracta.

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

For the flow from the inlet to the vena conracta, the pressure change is modeled in accordance with HTFS27 by:

2 m12 vE1 vEt 1 vE d = 1 v (C )2 v E1 2 P E1 1 c

A.41

P P 1

A.42 For the flow from the vena contracta to the outlet the pressure change is modeled used the methods for Sudden and Gradual Expansion given above.

Tees
Tees can be modeled either by using a flow independent loss coefficient for each flow path or by using variable loss coefficients that are a function of the volumetric flow and area for each flow path as well as the branch angle. The following numbering scheme is used to reference the flow paths. Fig A.4

Constant Loss Coefficients The following static pressure loss coefficients values are suggested by the API23:

<90o 90o

K 13
0.76 1.37

K 23
0.50 0.38

K 12
1.37 1.37

K 31
0.76 1.37

K 32
0.50 0.38

K 21
1.37 1.37

The selection of the coefficient value is dependant on the angle and the direction of flow through the tee. For flow into the run, the loss coefficient for tee is:

90o <>90o

K 13
0.38 0.50

K 12
1.37 1.37

www.cadfamily.comBasis EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com A Theoretical The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

291

For flow into the branch, the loss coefficient for tee is:

90o <>90o

K 21
1.37 1.37

K 23
1.37 0.76

For flow into the tail, the loss coefficient for tee is:

90o <>90o

K 31
0.38 0.50

K 23
1.37 0.76

where : Reference numbers 1,2 and 3 are assigned as shown in Figure A.4
The static pressure change across the fitting is given by:

Ps = K
A.43

v 2 2

Variable Loss Coefficients The loss coefficients are a function of the branch angle, branch area to total flow area ratio and branch volumetric flow to total volumetric flow ratio. These values have been graphically represented by Miller25. Using these charts the static pressure changes are calculated from: Combing Flow

1v12 v2 + P 3 3 + P3 1 2 2 K13 = 3 3v3 2


A.44
2 1v2 v2 + P2 3 3 + P3 2 2 K 23 = 3 3v3 2

A.45

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Dividing Flow
2 3v3 1v12 + P3 + P 1 2 2 K 31 = 3 3v3 2

A.46
2 3v3 v2 + P3 2 2 + P2 2 2 K 32 = 3 3v3 2

A.47 A typical chart for K 23 in combining flow is shown. Fig A.5

Orifice Plates
Orifice plates can be modeled either as a sudden contraction from the inlet pipe size to the orifice diameter followed by a sudden expansion from the orifice diameter to the outlet pipe size or by using the HTFS equation for a thin orifice plate.

Ps =
A.48

0.08956 m2 2.825 (1 2 )1.5082 21 4 1

See Incompressible Single Phase Flow on Page 263 for a definition of the symbols.

www.cadfamily.comBasis EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com A Theoretical The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

293

Vertical Separators
The Pressure change across the separator comprises the following components: Expansion of the multiphase inlet from the inlet diameter, d1, to the body diameter dbody. Contraction of vapor phase outlet from the body diameter, dbody, to the outlet diameter, d2

Friction losses are ignored. Fig A.6

Horizontal Separators
The Pressure change across the separator comprises the following components calculated using the methods described in Incompressible Single Phase Flow on Page 263: Expansion of the multiphase inlet from the inlet diameter, d1, to the vapor space characterized by equivalent diameter of the vapor area. Contraction of vapor phase outlet from the vapor space characterized by the equivalent diameter of the vapor area, to the outlet diameter, d2

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Friction losses are ignored. Fig A.7

Vapor-Liquid Equilibrium
Compressible Gas
The PVT relationship is expressed as:

PV = ZRT
A.49

where : P = Pressure V = Volume Z = Compressibility factor R = Gas constant T = Temperature


The compressibility factor Z is a function of reduced temperature and pressure. The overall critical temperature and pressure are determined using applicable mixing rules.

Vapor Pressure
The following equations are used for estimating the vapor pressure, given the component critical properties3:

Inp * r = Inp * r
A.50

)( ) + (Inp )( )
0 * 1

www.cadfamily.comBasis EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com A Theoretical The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

295

(Inp )( ) = 5.92714 6.09648 1.28862InT T


* 0

+ 0.169347Tr6

A.51

6875 (Inp )( ) = 15.2518 16.T 13.4721InT


* 1

+ 0.43577Tr6

A.52

where :
* pr = Reduced vapour pressure ( p * / pc )

p * = Vapour pressure ( psi abs) pc = Critical pressure ( psi abs) = Acentric factor Tr = Reduced temperature (T / Tc ) T = Temperature ( oR) Tc = Critical temperature ( oR)
This equation is restricted to reduced temperatures greater than 0.30, and should not be used below the freezing point. Its use was intended for hydrocarbons, but it generally works well with water.

Soave Redlich Kwong


It was noted by Wilson (1965, 1966) that the main drawback of the RedlichKwong equation of state was its inability of accurately reproducing the vapor pressures of pure component constituents of a given mixture. He proposed a modification to the RK equation of state using the acentricity as a correlating parameter, but this approach was widely ignored until 1972, when Soave (1972) proposed a modification of the SRK equation of this form:

P=

a(T , Tc , ) RT V b V (V + b )

A.53 The a term was fitted in such a way as to reproduce the vapor pressure of hydrocarbons using the acentric factor as a correlating parameter. This led to the following development:

P=

ac RT V b V (V + b ) R 2Tc2 ( a the same as RK ) Pc

A.54

ac = a

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

A.55

= 1 + S 1 Tr0.5
A.56

S = 0.480 + 1.574 - 0.176 2


A.57 The reduced form is:

Pr =
A.58

3Tr 3.8473 Vr 0.2559 Vr (Vr + 0.2599 )

The SRK equation of state can represent with good accuracy the behavior of hydrocarbon systems for separation operations, and since it is readily converted into computer code, its usage has been extensive in the last twenty years. Other derived thermodynamic properties, like enthalpies and entropies, are reasonably accurate for engineering work, and the SRK equation enjoys wide acceptance in the engineering community today.

Peng Robinson
Peng and Robinson (1976) noted that although the SRK was an improvement over the RK equation for VLE calculations, the densities for the liquid phase were still in considerable disagreement with experimental values due to a universal critical compressibility factor of 0.3333, which was still too high. They proposed a modification to the RK equation which reduced the critical compressibility to about 0.307, and which would also represent the VLE of natural gas systems accurately. This improved equation is represented by:

P=

ac RT V b V (V + b ) + b(V b ) R 2Tc2 Pc

A.59

ac = 0.45724
A.60

b = 0.07780
A.61

RTc Pc

They used the same functional dependency for the term as Soave:

= 1 + S 1 Tr0.5
A.62

S = 0.37464 + 1.5422 - 0.26992 2

www.cadfamily.comBasis EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com A Theoretical The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

297

A.63

Pr =
A.64

3.2573Tr 4.8514 2 Vr 0.2534 Vr + 0.5068Vr 0.0642

The accuracy of the SRK and PR equations of state are roughly the same (except for density calculations).

Physical Properties
Vapor Density
Vapor density is calculated using the compressibility factor calculated from the Berthalot equation5. This equation correlates the compressibility factor to the pseudo reduced pressure and pseudo reduced temperature.

P Z = 1.0 + 0.0703 r Tr
A.65

6.0 1.0 2 Tr

PM ZRT

A.66

Liquid Density
Saturated liquid volumes are obtained using a corresponding states equation developed by R. W. Hankinson and G. H. Thompson14 which explicitly relates the liquid volume of a pure component to its reduced temperature and a second parameter termed the characteristic volume. This method has been adopted as an API standard. The pure compound parameters needed in the corresponding states liquid density (COSTALD) calculations are taken from the original tables published by Hankinson and Thompson, and the API data book for components contained in Flare System Analyzer's library. The parameters for hypothetical components are based on the API gravity and the generalized Lu equation. Although the COSTALD method was developed for saturated liquid densities, it can be applied to sub-cooled liquid densities, i.e., at pressures greater than the vapor pressure, using the Chueh and Prausnitz correction factor for compressed fluids. The COSTALD model was modified to improve its accuracy to predict the density for all systems whose pseudoreduced temperature is below 1.0. Above this temperature, the equation of state compressibility factor is used to calculate the liquid density.

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Vapor Viscosity
Vapor viscosity is calculated from the Golubev3 method. These equations correlate the vapor viscosity to molecular weight, temperature and the pseudo critical properties. Tr > 1.0

3.5M 0.5 Pc0.667Tr( 0.71+ 0.29 / Tr ) = 10000.0Tc0.167


A.67 Tr 1.0

3.5M 0.5 Pc0.667Tr( 0.965) 10000.0Tc0.167

A.68

Liquid Viscosity
Flare System Analyzer will automatically select the model best suited for predicting the phase viscosities of the system under study. The model selected will be from one of the three available in Flare System Analyzer: a modification of the NBS method (Ely and Hanley), Twu's model, and a modification of the Letsou-Stiel correlation. Flare System Analyzer will select the appropriate model using the following criteria:
Chemical System Lt Hydrocarbons (NBP < 155 F) Hvy Hydrocarbons (NBP > 155 F) Non-Ideal Chemicals Liquid Phase Methodology Mod Ely & Hanley Twu Mod Letsou-Stiel

All the models are based on corresponding states principles and have been modified for more reliable application. These models were selected since they were found from internal validation to yield the most reliable results for the chemical systems shown. Viscosity predictions for light hydrocarbon liquid phases and vapor phases were found to be handled more reliably by an inhouse modification of the original Ely and Hanley model, heavier hydrocarbon liquids were more effectively handled by Twu's model, and chemical systems were more accurately handled by an in-house modification of the original Letsou-Stiel model. A complete description of the original corresponding states (NBS) model used for viscosity predictions is presented by Ely and Hanley in their NBS publication16. The original model has been modified to eliminate the iterative procedure for calculating the system shape factors. The generalized LeechLeland shape factor models have been replaced by component specific

www.cadfamily.comBasis EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com A Theoretical The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

299

models. Flare System Analyzer constructs a PVT map for each component and regresses the shape factor constants such that the PVT map can be reproduced using the reference fluid. Note: The PVT map is constructed using the COSTALD for the liquid region. The shape factor constants for all the library components have already been regressed and are stored with the pure component properties. Pseudo component shape factor constants are regressed when the physical properties are supplied. Kinematic or dynamic viscosity versus temperature curves may be supplied to replace Flare System Analyzer's internal pure component viscosity correlations. Flare System Analyzer uses the viscosity curves, whether supplied or internally calculated, with the physical properties to generate a PVT map and regress the shape factor constants. Pure component data is not required, but if it is available it will increase the accuracy of the calculation. The general model employs methane as a reference fluid and is applicable to the entire range of non-polar fluid mixtures in the hydrocarbon industry. Accuracy for highly aromatic or naphthenic oil will be increased by supplying viscosity curves when available, since the pure component property generators were developed for average crude oils. The model also handles water and acid gases as well as quantum gases. Although the modified NBS model handles these systems very well, the Twu method was found to do a better job of predicting the viscosities of heavier hydrocarbon liquids. The Twu model18 is also based on corresponding states principles, but has implemented a viscosity correlation for n-alkanes as its reference fluid instead of methane. A complete description of this model is given in the paper18 titled "Internally Consistent Correlation for Predicting Liquid Viscosities of Petroleum Fractions". For chemical systems the modified NBS model of Ely and Hanley is used for predicting vapor phase viscosities, whereas a modified form of the LetsouStiel model15 is used for predicting the liquid viscosities. This method is also based on corresponding states principles and was found to perform satisfactorily for the components tested. The parameters supplied for all Flare System Analyzer pure library components have been fit to match existing viscosity data over a broad operating range. Although this will yield good viscosity predictions as an average over the entire range, improved accuracy over a more narrow operating range can be achieved by supplying viscosity curves for any given component. This may be achieved either by modifying an existing library component through Flare System Analyzer's component librarian or by entering the desired component as a hypothetical and supplying its viscosity curve.

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Liquid Phase Mixing Rules for Viscosity


The estimates of the apparent liquid phase viscosity of immiscible Hydrocarbon Liquid - Aqueous mixtures are calculated using the following "mixing rules": If the volume fraction of the hydrocarbon phase is greater than or equal to 0.33, the following equation is used19:

eff = oil e 3.6(1voil )


A.69

where : eff = Apparent viscosity oil = Viscosity of Hydrocarbon phase voil = Volume fraction Hydrocarbon phase
If the volume fraction of the hydrocarbon phase is less than 0.33, the following equation is used20:

oil + 0.4 H 2O eff = 1 + 2.5voil oil + H O H 2O 2


A.70

where : eff = Apparent viscosity oil = Viscosity of Hydrocarbon phase H 2O = Viscosity of Aqueous phase voil = Volume fraction Hydrocarbon phase
The remaining properties of the pseudo phase are calculated as follows:

mweff = xi mwi
A.71

(molecular weight )

eff = 1 / ( ( xi / pi )) (mixture density )


A.72

Cpeff = xi Cpi
A.73

(misture specific heat )

www.cadfamily.comBasis EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com A Theoretical The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

301

Thermal Conductivity
As in viscosity predictions, a number of different models and component specific correlations are implemented for prediction of liquid and vapor phase thermal conductivities. The text by Reid, Prausnitz and Polings15 was used as a general guideline in determining which model was best suited for each class of components. For hydrocarbon systems the corresponding states method proposed by Ely and Hanley16 is generally used. The method requires molecular weight, acentric factor and ideal heat capacity for each component. These parameters are tabulated for all library components and may either be input or calculated for hypothetical components. It is recommended that all of these parameters be supplied for non-hydrocarbon hypotheticals to ensure reliable thermal conductivity coefficients and enthalpy departures. The modifications to the method are identical to those for the viscosity calculations. Shape factors calculated in the viscosity routines are used directly in the thermal conductivity equations. The accuracy of the method will depend on the consistency of the original PVT map. The Sato-Reidel method15 is used for liquid phase thermal conductivity predictions of glycols and acids, the Latini et al. Method15 is used for esters, alcohols and light hydrocarbons in the range of C3 - C7, and the Missenard and Reidel method15 is used for the remaining components. For vapor phase thermal conductivity predictions, the Misic and Thodos, and Chung et al. 15 methods are used. The effect of higher pressure on thermal conductivities is taken into account by the Chung et al. method. As in viscosity, the thermal conductivity for two liquid phases is approximated by using empirical mixing rules for generating a single pseudo liquid phase property.

Enthalpy
Ideal Gas
The ideal gas enthalpy is calculated from the following equation:

H ideal = Ai + BiT + CiT 2 + DiT 3 + EiT 4


A.74

where : H = Ideal enthalpy T = Temperature A, B, C , D, E = Ideal gas heat capacity terms

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Lee-Kesler
The Lee-Kesler enthalpy method corrects the ideal gas enthalpy for temperature and pressure.

H = H ideal + H dep
A.75
s r H dep H dep H dep RT = RT + r RT c c c

H dep RT c


k 3c3 k c2 2 T k r + d 2 + 3E 2TrVr2 5TrVr5

A.76
k k 2b k 3b4 k b2 3 + 2 T T r t = Tr Z k 1.0 TrVr

H dep RT c
A.77

k c4 E= 3 k 2Tr

k k Vr2 k + 1.0 + 1 + 2 e Vr
k

A.78

where : Tc = Critical temperature H = Specific enthalpy = Acentric factor r = Reference fluid s = Simple fluid H ideal = Ideal enthalpy b, c, d , , = Lee Kesler terms H dep = Ideal gas departure enthalpy

www.cadfamily.comBasis EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com A Theoretical The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

303

Equations of State
The Enthalpy and Entropy calculations are performed rigorously using the following exact thermodynamic relations:
V 1 P H H ID = Z 1+ T T V P dV RT RT

A.79
V 1 P S S oID 1 P = InZ In o + dV R P R T V V

A.80 For the Peng Robinson Equation of State, we have:

H H ID 1 = Z 1 1.5 RT 2 bRT
A.81

da V + (20.5 + 1)b a T In dt V + (20.5 1)b

S S oID P A Tda Z + (20.5 + 1)B = In(Z B ) In o + 1.5 In R P 2 B adT Z (20.5 1)B


A.82

where : a = xi x j (ai a j ) (1 kij )


N N 0.5 i =1 j =1

A.83 For the SRK Equation of State:

H H ID 1 = Z 1 RT bRT
A.84

da b a T dt In1 + V

S S oID P A Tda B = In(Z B ) In o + In1 + R P B adT Z


A.85

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

A and B term definitions are provided below:


Term Peng-Robinson Soave-Redlich-Kwong

bi ai aci

0.077796 aci i

RTci Pci

0.08664 aci i

RTci Pci

(RTci )2 0.457235
1 + mi 1 Tri0.5

i mi

Pci

(RTci )2 0.42748
1 + mi 1 Tri0.5

Pci

0.37646 + 1.54226i 0.26992i2

0.48 + 1.57i 0.176i2

where : a = xi x j (ai a j ) (1 kij )


N N 0.5 i =1 j =1

A.86

and b = xi bi
i =1 N

A.87

ID = Ideal gas
o

= Reference state R = Ideal gas constant H = Enthalpy S = Entropy

www.cadfamily.comBasis EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com A Theoretical The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

305

Noise
The sound pressure level at a given distance from the pipe is calculated from the following equations. In these equations the noise producing mechanism is assumed to be solely due to the pressure drop due to friction.

P Wm = 1.36 L 4
A.88

1013 Wm L SPLr = 10 log 4r 2 t


A.89

where : L = Equivalent length SPL = Sound pressure level r = Distance from pipe = Internal diameter = Acoustic efficiency P = Change in pressure t = Pipe wall transmission loss v = Average fluid velocity

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

The acoustical efficiency is calculated from the following graph. Fig A.8
10 - 3

10 - 4

1 0-5

Aco us tical Efficien cy

10 - 6

10 - 7

10 - 8 pt = 1 0.0 10 - 9 p t = 1.0 10 - 10 p t = 0. 1 10 - 11 0 .0 0.2 0 .4 M ach N um b er 0 .6 0. 8 1.0

P T pt = 1 2 P T 2 1
A.90

The transmission loss due to the pipe wall is calculated from:

0.5mv t = 17.0 36.0


A.91

where : m = Pipe wall mass per unit area

= Internal diameter
v = Average fluid velocity

www.cadfamily.comBasis EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com A Theoretical The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

307

B File Format

Import/Export Details
This section provides further details of the import and export capabilities of Flare System Analyzer.

Process Descriptions
Import Wizard
The purpose of this section of the documentation is to describe step by step the operation of the import wizard.

End of Step 1
At this stage the import process verifies that the specified import file exists and opens it. If an Excel file is being imported this step starts Excel as a background process then asks it to load the file. The import wizard is then configured for the appropriate file type. Any errors are reported.

End of Step 2
At this stage the import process opens the specified import definition file or the default or new import definition file as specified in Preferences as appropriate. A check is made that the import definition file type matches the file type specified in step 1. The version of the import definition file is then checked and data object and data item elements are added to update to the current Flare System Analyzer version if required. The next step is to process the file to build the object selector tree view for Step 3. Any problems in reading the import definition file are reported.

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Step 3
During this step, the Import Wizard extracts Source tab data and Field Details for each data item as different data objects are selected. Whenever a new data object is selected the data on the Source tab is validated and any problems are reported.

End of Step 4
The first action taken is to save the import definition file if required, prompting for the file name to be used. The import process proper then begins. In detail the steps are: 1 2 3 Clear current results Open log file if required Read components one by one. For each component check to see if it already exists in the current Flare System Analyzer case. If not add component to list. For database components use information from database, otherwise use the data values from file. Read binary interaction parameter data. Read data for pipes, connector nodes and source nodes one object type at a time, updating the progress view as appropriate. As each instance of a particular object type is read check if it already exists. If so use the data read to update it otherwise create a new instance of the appropriate object type. Make connections between pipes and nodes. Processing allows for only one end of the connection to be read. Read scenario data. Existing scenarios will be updated and new ones created if required. Read Solver options.

4 5 6

7 8 9

10 Update automatic calculations to reflect new data values. 11 Refresh all views. 12 Close log file and then close Import Data File. Any background copy of Excel will be closed at this point. 13 Close Import Wizard view and finish.

General Data Object Import Procedure


For each object type that is read the detailed import procedure is as follows: 1 2 Check to see if import of this object type is required. Quit reading this type of data object if not. Process the data object definition data from the Import Definition File. Search for and open the specified source object. Quit if any errors are encountered. Search the source data object for an instance of the appropriate object type using the defined select criteria if required. For Access imports this will be a row in the specified table; for Excel imports this will be a row or column range in the specified worksheet where cell offset 1,1 is not blank; for XML imports this will be an item element within the specified group element.

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com B File Format The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

309

4 5 6

Repeat steps 2 and 3 to open any sub section data objects. Read data items from source one by one. Update counters for number of instances read and search data source for next object instance. For an Access imports this will be the next row, for Excel imports the next row or column range, for XML imports the next item element. Selection criteria will apply if specified. Quit if the next instance cannot be found. Repeat steps 5 and 6 until all instances have been read.

Export Process
The purpose of this section of the documentation is to describe step by step the operation of the export wizard.

End of Step 1
At this stage the export process checks to see if the target export file exists. If so it opens it otherwise the file is created. If an Excel file is being exported this step starts Excel as a background process then asks it to load any existing file. The Export Wizard is then configured for the appropriate file type. Any errors are reported.

End of Step 2
At this stage the export process opens the specified export definition file or the default or new export definition file specified in Preferences as appropriate. A check is made that the export definition file type matches the file type specified in step 1. The version of the export definition file is then checked and data object and data item elements are added to update it to the current Flare System Analyzer version if required. The next step is to process the file to build the object selector tree view for Step 3. Any problems in reading the export definition file are reported.

Step 3
During this step, the Export Wizard extracts Target tab data and Field Details for each data item as different data objects are selected. Whenever a new data object is selected the data on the Target tab is validated and any problems are reported.

End of Step 4
The first action taken is to save the export definition file if required, prompting for the file name to be used. The export process proper then begins. In detail the steps are: 1 2 3 4
3

Clear existing data from export file if requested by the user. Write components data Write binary interaction parameter data Write pipe data Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

5 6 7 8 9

Write connector node and source node data working through each type of node in turn Write scenario data for scenarios that are selected for calculation. Write results data for scenarios that are selected for calculation. Write solver options. Save export file. Any background copy of Excel will be closed at this point.

10 Close Export Wizard view.

General Data Object Export Procedure


For each object type that is written the detailed export procedure is as follows: 1 2 Check that export of this data object type is required. Quit if not. Create target data object using information from export definition file. For Access export this will create a table with the correct fields; for Excel export a worksheet with the correct name; for XML export a group tag with the correct name. Quit if any errors are encountered. Create target data objects as required for any data subsections. For each instance of the data object to be written search the output file to see if this instance already exists. If so select this to be overwritten. Otherwise create a new instance for the data object in the output file. For Access export this will be a new row in that target table, for Excel export the next row or column range where cell offset 1,1 is blank, for XML export a new item element. Quit if the new target instance cannot be found. Write the values to the target object instance. Update counters for number of items read and mark target instance as complete. Repeat steps 4 to 6 for until each instance of this data object has been written.

3 4

5 6 7

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com B File Format The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

311

Definition File Formats


The import and export definition files are XML formatted data files that describe how the various Flare System Analyzer data objects and their corresponding data items should be read from or written to the supported external file formats. This section of the documentation describes the layout of these files.

Import File Formats


File Header
The top level element of an import definition file must have the tag name FlarenetImport and contain the following attributes:
Attribute LastModified FlarenetVersion FileType Description This is a date string that indicates the date that the file was last updated. This indicates the version of Flare System Analyzer that the file is applicable to in the format N.NN. This indicates the type of external file import that is described in this definition file. Valid values are Access, Excel or XML

Data Object Elements


The child elements of the FlarenetImport tag define the various data objects that may be imported by Flare System Analyzer. These parent data object elements may contain child data object elements that describe data subsections that may be imported from a different location to the parent data object. For example a pipe data object has a data subsection defined for the PFD layout information. A data object element has the following attributes:
Attribute ObjectName Description This defines the source of the data object in the external file. Its usage depends on the type of external file as follows: Access The entry defines a database table Excel The entry defines a worksheet XML The entry defines the tag name of a group element Import Select This indicates whether this object type is to be imported. Valid values are Yes or No. This defines any selection criteria to be used when selecting instances of data objects from the external file. Its usage depends on the type of external file but data substitution codes can be defined in the selection criteria for child data object elements in all cases. Access A valid SQL statement for the database table specified under ObjectName.
3

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Excel A statement of the form R#,C#=criteria where R#,C# is a cell offset in the specified worksheet and criteria is either a value or a substitution code. Multiple statements can be entered, separated by the word AND. XML A statement of the form item tag=criteria where item tag is a data item element in the specified group element and criteria is either a value or a substitution code. Attribute Contained Description This indicates whether the data for this object is contained in the same external data source as the parent object. Valid values are Yes or No. This setting is always No for a parent data object. This entry appears in Excel import definition files only. It defines how the data for this object is organized. Valid values are Row, Column or Sheet. This entry appears in Excel import definition files only. When DataBy is set to Row or Column it defines the starting row or column for the data. When DataBy is set to Sheet it defines the tag by which worksheets of the requisite layout can be identified. This entry appears in Excel import definition files only. It defines the number of rows or columns occupied by a single instance of a data object, including any spacing, when DataBy is set to Row or Column. This entry appears in XML import definition files only. It defines the element tag name used to identify each instance of a data object within the group tag name defined in the ObjectName attribute.

DataBy

StartAt

PerItem

ItemTag

A list of valid Data Object elements names is given in Data Objects List.

Data Item Elements


Each data object element contains data item elements that define the location of the individual data item in the external data source. A data item element contains the following attributes:
Attribute Import Offset Description This indicates whether the item is to be imported. Valid values are Yes or No. This defines the location of the data value in the external file. Its usage depends on the type of external file but data substitution codes can be defined for the offset in all cases see Data Substitution Codes. Access The entry defines a field within the database table for the object. Excel The entry defines a cell within the worksheet for the object. The cell is defined either by a single row or column offset or by a row, column offset. XML The entry defines the tag name of an element within the item tag element for the object.

A list of the data item elements that are recognized for each data object is given in Data Items List.

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com B File Format The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

313

Export File Formats


File Header
The top level element of an export definition file must have the tag name FlarenetExport and contain the following attributes:
Attribute LastModified FlarenetVersion FileType Description This is a date string that indicates the date that the file was last updated. This indicates the version of Flare System Analyzer that the file is applicable to in the format N.NN. This indicates the type of external file export that is described in this definition file. Valid values are Access, Excel or XML.

Data Object Elements


The child elements of the FlarenetExport tag define the various data objects that may be exported by Flare System Analyzer. These parent data object elements may contain child data object elements that describe data subsections that may be exported to a different location to the parent data object. A data object element has the following attributes:
Attribute ObjectName Description This defines the name of the data object that will be created and written to in the external file. Its usage depends on the type of external file as follows: Access The entry defines a database table. Excel The entry defines a worksheet, XML The entry defines the tag name of a group element. Export Contained This indicates whether this object type is to be exported. Valid values are Yes or No. This indicates whether the data for this object is to be written to the same external data source as the parent object. Valid values are Yes or No. This setting is always No for a parent data object. This entry appears in Excel export definition files only. It defines how the data for this object is organized. Valid values are Row, Column or Sheet. This entry appears in Excel export definition files only. When DataBy is set to Row or Column it defines the starting row or column for the data. When DataBy is set to Sheet it defines the name of the worksheet that will be copied to create a worksheet for each instance of the data object. This name must begin with a % character. This entry appears in Excel export definition files only. It defines the number of rows or columns occupied by a single instance of a data object, including any spacing, when DataBy is set to Row or Column This entry appears in XML export definition files only. It defines the element tag name used to identify each instance of a data object within the group tag name defined in the ObjectName attribute.

DataBy

StartAt

PerItem

ItemTag

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

A list of valid Data Object elements names is given in Data Objects List.

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com B File Format The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

315

Data Item Elements


Each data object element contains data item elements that define how an individual data item is to be written to the external data source. A data item element contains the following attributes:
Attribute Export Offset Description This indicates whether the item is to be exported. Valid values are Yes or No. This defines the location where the data value will be written in the external file. Its usage depends on the type of external file Its usage depends on the type of external file but data substitution codes can be defined for the offset in all cases see Data Substitution Codes. Access The entry defines a field within the database table for the object. Excel The entry defines a cell within the worksheet for the object. The cell is defined either by a single row or column offset or by a row, column offset. XML The entry defines the tag name of an element within the item tag element for the object. Type This appears in Access export definition files only. It defines the data type of the field to be created for this item. Valid values are Text for text strings, Long for integer values, Double for floating point values. This appears in Access export definition files only. It defines the length of the field to be created. For fields of type Text it defines the length of the text string in characters. For fields of type Long and Double it is set to 0 and will be ignored though it must be present.

Length

A list of the data item elements that are recognized for each data object is given in Data Items List.

Data Substitution Codes


As indicated in the above data substitution codes may be defined in the Select attribute for import data objects and the Offset attribute for item import and export data items. The details of these codes are as follows:

Select Codes
The code .itemname where itemname is the tag name of a data item element is recognized when processing the Select attribute for import definition files. The code .itemname will be replaced in the selection criteria by the current value of that item in the parent data object. Therefore it follows that this code cannot be defined for parent data objects; only child data objects that describe data subsections. Multiple .itemname codes are allowed in a single select criteria. For example consider the default import definition file for Access files DefAccess.fni. This file is set up to assume that the PFD layout information for each node is contained in a separate table to the node data. Thus a select code is needed to identify the appropriate row in this table as each node is
3

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

read. Taking a tee as an example node, the relevant lines of the import definition file are: 1 <Tees ObjectName="Tees" Import="Yes" Select="" Contained="No"> The data in this line specifies the following: The ObjectName attribute says that the data for tee nodes lies in a database table called Tees. The Import attribute says tee node data is to be imported. The Select attribute is blank which implies that all the entries in the Tees database table will be treated as tee nodes. The Contained attribute is No since this is a parent data object element (i.e. directly beneath the FlarenetImport element). 2 <Name Import="Yes" Offset="Name"/> (as found directly below line 1 as a data item element within the Tees element)

The data in this line specifies how to read the Name data item from the Tees table. The attribute Import says that the name of the tee is to be imported. The Offset attributes says that the name of the tee will be found in a field called Name within the Tees database table. 3 <PFDLayout ObjectName="PFDLayout" Import="Yes" Select="ItemName=.Name" Contained="No"> (as found within the Tees element)

The data in this line specifies where to find the PFD layout information for the tee. The ObjectName attribute says that it will be found in a table called PFDLayout. The attribute Import says that the layout information should be imported. The Select attribute includes a substitution code that says that the data will be found in the row of the table where the field ItemName has the same value as the name of the tee we are importing. I.e. when we are importing the tee with the name TeeXYZ the substitution code will evaluate to TeeXYZ and the PFDLayout table will be searched for the row with the criteria ItemName=TeeXYZ. The Contained attribute states that the data for this object will be found in a different table (PFDLayout) to that of the parent object (Tees). A further example can be taken from the default Excel definition file DefExcel.fni. C This expects source data for all scenarios to be held on a dedicated worksheet. The SourceData data object element within the Scenarios data object element is as follows: 4 <SourceData ObjectName="SourceData" Import="Yes" Select="1=.Name" Contained="No" DataBy="Row" PerItem="1" StartAt="1">

This identifies the worksheet as SourceData, and that import of this data is required. The layout is defined as being in rows (DataBy) with 1 row per source data object (PerItem) starting at row 1 (StartAt). The Select attribute says that the data for the current scenario is to be found in rows where column 1 contains the name of the scenario.

Offset Codes
The following codes are recognized and processed in the Offset attribute in both import and export definition files. %ObjectName where ObjectName is the name of a data object element, will be replaced by a value that iterates as successive instances of that type of object are

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com B File Format The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

317

read or written for this instance of the parent data object. It is used to provide a value that iterates through repeated data items e.g. component data or pipe fitting data. ObjectName may refer to any data object element that is a parent of the data item. The code is usually used in conjunction with a + symbol to add the iteration value to some constant value. In an Access or XML import or export definition file the + symbol means that the iteration value is concatenated with the constant value. E.g. Frac+%Composition will be expanded to Frac1, Frac2 etc. In an Excel import or export definition file*, -, and / symbols as well as the + symbol are recognized to combine the iteration value with a constant value to calculate a cell address. E.g. 2,2+%Composition will be expanded to the cell references 2,3 then 2,4 etc. See the CurveMassFlow data item in the TipCurveData data object in the definition file DefExcel.fni for a more complicated example. #ObjectName where ObjectName is the name of a data object element, will be replaced by the total number of instances of that type of data object that have been read. ObjectName may refer to any data object element that is a child of the current data object element. The value returned is usually combined with some constant value through a + or other symbols as for the %ObjectName code. ?Composition is a special code that is used exactly as it stands. ?Composition will be replaced by each component name or offset in turn as successive component composition data items are read or written It is generally used in conjunction with a + symbol to each component name or offset to some constant value. In an Access or XML import or export definition file ?Composition will return component names in turn from the master component list e.g. Frac+?Composition will be evaluated as FracMethane, FracEthane etc. In an Excel import or export definition ?Composition will return the index number of a component in the master component list to allow it to be used to calculate a cell offset. In both cases the master component list is the union of the components in the current Flare System Analyzer case and the import or export definition files. Essentially this code allows unambiguous specification of a component identity when merging of the component lists between a Flare System Analyzer case and an import or export definition file.

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Recognized Objects and Items


Data Objects List
Data object elements for the following data objects and sub-sections are recognized in import and export definition files.
Element Tag Components BIPs Connectors ControlValves FlowBleeds HorizontalSeparators OrificePlates Pipes Fittings ReliefValves Tees Tips TipCurves TipCurveData VerticalSeparators Scenarios SolverOptions WarningMsgs PFDLayout SourceData Composition PipeEstimates PFSummary Sub Section Data Object Elements None None PFDLayout PFDLayout SourceData PFDLayout PFDLayout PFDLayout PFDLayout Fittings None PFDLayout SourceData PFDLayout PFDLayout TipCurves TipCurveData None PFDLayout SourceData WarningMsgs None None Composition None None EndResults CompResults StreamProps PhaseProps EndResults CompResults None None End specific results for each pipe. Export definition files only. Composition results for each pipe. Export definition files only. Tip pressure drop curves Data points in tip pressure drop curve Vertical separator nodes PipeEstimates Scenario data Calculation option data Warning message flags PFD layout information Scenario specific source data Component composition data Scenario specific flow estimates for tear streams Summary results data for each pipe. Export definition files only. Tee nodes Flare tip nodes Fitting data for pipes Relief valve source nodes Flow bleed nodes Horizontal separator nodes Orifice plate nodes Pipes Description Component data Binary interaction parameters Connector nodes Control valve source nodes

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com B File Format The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

319

StreamProps PhaseProps

None None

Stream properties at each end of each pipe. Export definition files only. Properties for each phase at each end of each pipe. Export definition files only.

Data Items List


The data items that can be read for each data object are as follows:

Components
Attribute ID Name Type MolWt StdDensity NBP WatsonK Pc Tc Vc Vchar Omega Omega Ha Hb Hc Hd He Hf S ViscA ViscB Description The component id number, -1 for hypotheticals The component name (30 chars) The component type (8 chars) The component molecular weight The component standard density (kg/m3) The component boiling point (K) The component Watson K value The component critical pressure (bar a) The component critical temperature (K) The component critical volume (m3/kgmole) The component characteristic volume (m3/kgmole) The component acentric factor The component SRK acentric factor The enthalpy A coefficient (kJ/kgmole) The enthalpy B coefficient (kJ/kgmole/K) The enthalpy C coefficient (kJ/kgmole/K2) The enthalpy C coefficient (kJ/kgmole/K3) The enthalpy C coefficient (kJ/kgmole/K4) The enthalpy C coefficient (kJ/kgmole/K5) The entropy coefficient The viscosity A parameter The viscosity B parameter

BIPs
Attribute PropPkg Description The code for the property package: 0 Vapor pressure 1 Peng Robinson 2 Soave Redlich Kwong 3 Compressible Gas IPType The code for the interaction parameter type -1 None 0 Kij or Aij

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

1 Bij 2 Cij Comp1 Comp2 Kij12 Kij21 The name of the first component (30 chars) The name of the second component (30 chars) Value of interaction parameter for comp1 / comp2 Value of interaction parameter for comp2 / comp1

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com B File Format The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

321

Connectors
Attribute Name Location Ignored UpstreamConnection UpstreamConnectionAt Description The connector name (30 chars) The location text (30 chars) The ignored flag 0 = not ignored, 1=ignored The name of the upstream pipe (30 chars) The code for the upstream pipe connection point 0 = upstream end, 1 = downstream end DownstreamConnnection DownstreamConnnectionAt The name of the downstream pipe (30 chars) The code for the downstream pipe connection point 0 = upstream end, 1 = downstream end Length Theta FittingLossMethod TwoPhaseCorrectionOption SwageMethod Length of the swage (mm) The internal angle of the swage (radians) Code for the fitting loss method 0 = ignored, 1 = calculated Code for two phase correction option 0 = No, 1 = Yes Code for size change calculation method 0 = Compressible, 1 = Incompressible, 2 = Transition CompressibleTransition IsothermalDPOption DP percent of inlet pressure for transition (%) Code for enabling isothermal pressure drop calcs 0 = No, 1 = Yes

ControlValves
Attribute Name Location DownstreamConnnection DownstreamConnnectionAt FlangeID Length ElevationChange MaterialCode Roughness Description The control valve name (30 chars) The location text (30 chars) The name of the downstream pipe (30 chars) The code for the downstream pipe connection point 0 = upstream end, 1 = downstream end Internal diameter of flange (mm) The length of the inlet piping (m) The elevation change of the inlet piping (m) The code for the inlet pipe material 0 = Carbon Steel, 1 = Stainless steel The inlet pipe roughness (mm)

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

NominalDiameter PipeSchedule InternalDiameter UsePipeClass FittingLossOffset FittingLossFactor

The inlet pipe nominal diameter (20 char text) The inlet pipe schedule (20 char text) The inlet pipe diameter (mm) Code for enabling pipe class usage 0 = No, 1 = Yes Fittings loss offset for inlet pipe Fittings loss Ft factor for inlet pipe

FlowBleeds
Attribute Name Location Ignored UpstreamConnection UpstreamConnectionAt DownstreamConnnection DownstreamConnnectionAt PressureDrop FlowOffset FlowMultiplier FlowMinimum FlowMaximum TwoPhaseCorrectionOption SwageMethod CompressibleTransition IsothermalDPOption Description The flow bleed name (30 chars) The location text (30 chars) The ignored flag 0 = not ignored, 1=ignored The name of the upstream pipe (30 chars) The code for the upstream pipe connection point 0 = upstream end, 1 = downstream end The name of the downstream pipe (30 chars) The code for the downstream pipe connection point 0 = upstream end, 1 = downstream end Pressure drop over bleed (bar) Bleed flow offset (kg/h) Flow bleed multiplier Minimum bleed flow (kg/h) Maximum bleed flow (kg/h) Code for two phase correction option 0 = No, 1 = Yes Code for size change calculation method 0 = Compressible, 1 = Incompressible, 2 = Transition DP percent of inlet pressure for transition (%) Code for enabling isothermal pressure drop calcs 0 = No, 1 = Yes

HorizontalSeparators
Attribute Name Location Ignored PrimaryInlet PrimaryInletAt SecondaryInlet SecondaryInletAt Description The horizontal separator name (30 chars) The location text (30 chars) The ignored flag 0 = not ignored, 1=ignored The name of the primary inlet pipe (30 chars) The code for the primary inlet pipe connection point 0 = upstream end, 1 = downstream end The name of the secondary inlet pipe (30 chars) The code for the secondary inlet pipe connection point 0 = upstream end, 1 = downstream end

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com B File Format The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

323

VapourOutlet VapourOutletAt Diameter LiquidLevel FittingLossMethod TwoPhaseCorrectionOption SwageMethod CompressibleTransition Attribute IsothermalDPOption BodyDimension

The name of the vapor outlet pipe (30 chars) The code for the vapor outlet pipe connection point 0 = upstream end, 1 = downstream end The vessel diameter (mm) The liquid level (mm) Code for fittings loss calculation 0 = Ignored, 1 = Calculated Code for two phase correction option 0 = No, 1 = Yes Code for size change calculation method 0 = Compressible, 1 = Incompressible, 2 = Transition DP percent of inlet pressure for transition (%) Description Code for enabling isothermal pressure drop calcs 0 = No, 1 = Yes Code for body area usage 0 = Full body area, 1 = Partial body area on flow

OrificePlates
Attribute Name Location Ignored UpstreamConnection UpstreamConnectionAt DownstreamConnnection DownstreamConnnectionAt OrificeDiameter UpstreamDiameterRatio DownstreamDiameterRatio FittingLossMethod TwoPhaseCorrectionOption SwageMethod CompressibleTransition IsothermalDPOption Description The orifice plate name (30 chars) The location text (30 chars) The ignored flag 0 = not ignored, 1=ignored The name of the upstream pipe (30 chars) The code for the upstream pipe connection point 0 = upstream end, 1 = downstream end The name of the downstream pipe (30 chars) The code for the downstream pipe connection point 0 = upstream end, 1 = downstream end Diameter of orifice (mm) Ratio of orifice to upstream diameter Ratio of orifice to downstream diameter Code for pressure loss method 0 = Ignored, 1 = Thin Plate, 2 = Contraction/Expansion Code for two phase correction option 0 = No, 1 = Yes Code for size change calculation method 0 = Compressible, 1 = Incompressible, 2 = Transition= DP percent of inlet pressure for transition (%) Code for enabling isothermal pressure drop calcs 0 = No, 1 = Yes

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Pipes
Attribute Name Location Ignored UpstreamConnection UpstreamConnectionAt DownstreamConnnection DownstreamConnnectionAt TailPipe Length ElevationChange Description The flow bleed name (30 chars) The location text (30 chars) The ignored flag 0 = not ignored, 1=ignored The name of the upstream node (30 chars) The code for the upstream node connection point 0,1,2 depending on upstream node The name of the downstream node (30 chars) The code for the downstream pipe connection point 0,1,2 depending on downstream node Code to identify tailpipe 0 = No, 1 = Yes Pipe length (m) Pipe elevation change (m)

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com B File Format The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

325

continued Attribute MaterialCode ThermalCond Roughness InternalDiameter NominalDiameter WallThickness PipeSchedule UsePipeClass Sizeable LengthMultiplier FittingLossOffset FittingLossFactor AmbientTemperature WindSpeed HeatTransfer OutletTemperature Duty InsulationType InsulationThickness InsulationConductivity VLEMethod Description Code for pipe material 0 = Carbon steel, 1 = Stainless steel Pipe material thermal conductivity (W/m/C) Pipe absolute roughness (mm) Pipe internal diameter (mm) Pipe nominal diameter (20 char text) Pipe wall thickness (mm) Pipe schedule (20 char text) Code for pipe class usage 0 = No, 1 = Yes Code for indicating sizeable pipe 0 = No, 1 = Yes Multiplier for pipe length Fittings loss offset Fittings loss Ft factor Temperature outside pipe (C) Wind speed (m/s) Code to enable heat transfer calcs 0 = No, 1 = Yes Temperature leaving pipe (C) Heat transferred (kJ/h) Insulation description (30 chars) Insulation thickness (mm) Insulation thermal conductivity (W/m/C) Code for VLE method 0 = Default, 1 = Compressible Gas, 2 = Peng Robinson, 3 = Soave Redlich Kwong, 4 = Vapor Pressure HorizontalPipeMethod Code for DP method for horizontal pipes 0 = Default, 1 = Isothermal gas, 2 Adiabatic gas, 3 = Beggs&Brill, 4 = Dukler InclinedPipeMethod Code for DP method for inclined pipes 0 = Default, 1 = Isothermal gas, 2 Adiabatic gas, 3 = Beggs&Brill, 4 = Dukler VerticalPipeMethod Code for DP method for vertical pipes 0 = Default, 1 = Isothermal gas, 2 Adiabatic gas, 3 = Beggs&Brill, 4 = Dukler, 5 = Orkisewski TwoPhaseElements FrictionFactorMethod DampingFactor FittingsCount Number of elements for pipe calculation Code for friction factor method 0 = Default, 1 = Round, 2 = Chen Damping factor Number of fittings linked to this pipe

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Fittings
Attribute ItemName FittingDesc FittingKOffset FittingKMultiplier Description The name of the fitting (30 chars) Description of the fitting (50 chars) Fitting loss constant Fitting loss Ft factor

ReliefValves
Attribute Name Location DownstreamConnnection DownstreamConnnectionAt FlangeID MAWP ValveType ValveCount AreaPerValve MechanicalPressure OrificeType Length ElevationChange MaterialCode Roughness NominalDiameter PipeSchedule InternalDiameter UsePipeClass FittingLossOffset FittingLossFactor Description The relief valve name (30 chars) The location text (30 chars) The name of the downstream pipe (30 chars) The code for the downstream pipe connection point 0 = upstream end, 1 = downstream end Internal diameter of flange (mm) Maximum allowable working pressure (bar a) Type code for valve 0 = Balanced, 1 = Conventional Number of valves Area of each valve orifice (mm2) Mechanical pressure limit (bar a) Standard type code for orifice (5 char text) The length of the inlet piping (m) The elevation change of the inlet piping (m) The code for the inlet pipe material 0 = Carbon Steel, 1 = Stainless steel The inlet pipe roughness (mm) The inlet pipe nominal diameter (20 char text) The inlet pipe schedule (20 char text) The inlet pipe diameter (mm) Code for enabling pipe class usage 0 = No, 1 = Yes Fittings loss offset for inlet pipe Fittings loss Ft factor for inlet pipe

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com B File Format The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

327

Tees
Attribute Name Location Ignored UpstreamConnection UpstreamConnectionAt BranchConnection BranchConnectionAt DownstreamConnection DownstreamConnectionAt AngleIndex FittingLossMethod BodyType TwoPhaseCorrectionOption SwageMethod Description The tee name (30 chars) The location text (30 chars) The ignored flag 0 = not ignored, 1=ignored The name of the upstream pipe (30 chars) The code for the upstream pipe connection point 0 = upstream end, 1 = downstream end The name of the branch pipe (30 chars) The code for the branch pipe connection point 0 = upstream end, 1 = downstream end The name of the downstream pipe (30 chars) The code for the downstream pipe connection point 0 = upstream end, 1 = downstream end Code for branch angle 0 = 30 deg, 1 = 45 deg, 2 = 60 deg, 3 = 90 deg Code for fittings loss calculation 0 = Ignored, 1 = Simple, 2 = Miller Code for body type 0 = Run, 1 = Tail, 2 = Branch, 3 = Auto Code for two phase correction option 0 = No, 1 = Yes Code for size change calculation method 0 = Compressible, 1 = Incompressible, 2 = Transition CompressibleTransition IsothermalDPOption BodyDimension ConnectorIfIncomplete DP percent of inlet pressure for transition (%) Code for enabling isothermal pressure drop calcs 0 = No, 1 = Yes Code for body area usage 0 = Full body area, 1 = Partial body area on flow Code to use connector calc 0 = No, 1 = Yes

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Tips
Attribute Name Location Ignored UpstreamConnection UpstreamConnectionAt Diameter FittingLoss FittingLossBasis TwoPhaseCorrectionOption SwageMethod CompressibleTransition IsothermalDPOption UseCurves ReferenceTemperature NumCurves Description The tip name (30 chars) The location text (30 chars) The ignored flag 0 = not ignored, 1=ignored The name of the upstream pipe (30 chars) The code for the upstream pipe connection point 0 = upstream end, 1 = downstream end Diameter of flare (mm) Fittings loss coefficient Code for fittings loss basis 0 = Total pressure, 1 = static pressure Code for two phase correction option 0 = No, 1 = Yes Code for size change calculation method 0 = Compressible, 1 = Incompressible, 2 = Transition DP percent of inlet pressure for transition (%) Code for enabling isothermal pressure drop calcs 0 = No, 1 = Yes Code for curve usage 0 = No, 1 = Yes Reference temperature for curve data (C) Number of pressure drop curves

TipCurves
Attribute TipName CurveMolWt CurveNumPoints Description The name of the top (30 chars) The reference molecular weight for the curve The number of points in the curve

TipCurveData
Attribute CurveMolWt CurveDataPointNo CurveMassFlow CurvePressureDrop Description The mole weight of the curve The number of the curve data point The mass flow for the curve data point (kg/h) The pressure drop for the curve data point (bar)

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com B File Format The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

329

VerticalSeparators
Attribute Name Location Ignored PrimaryInlet PrimaryInletAt VapourOutlet VapourOutletAt Diameter FittingLossMethod TwoPhaseCorrectionOption SwageMethod CompressibleTransition IsothermalDPOption Description The vertical separator name (30 chars) The location text (30 chars) The ignored flag 0 = not ignored, 1=ignored The name of the primary inlet pipe (30 chars) The code for the primary inlet pipe connection point 0 = upstream end, 1 = downstream end The name of the vapor outlet pipe (30 chars) The code for the vapor outlet pipe connection point 0 = upstream end, 1 = downstream end The vessel diameter (mm) Code for fittings loss calculation 0 = Ignored, 1 = Calculated Code for two phase correction option 0 = No, 1 = Yes Code for size change calculation method 0 = Compressible, 1 = Incompressible, 2 = Transition DP percent of inlet pressure for transition (%) Code for enabling isothermal pressure drop calcs 0 = No, 1 = Yes

Scenarios
Attribute Name Pressure HeaderMach HeaderVapVel HeaderLiqVel HeaderRV2 HeaderNoise TailPipeMach TailPipeVapVel TailPipeLiqVel TailPipeRV2 TailPipeNoise Description The scenario name (30 chars) System back pressure (bar a) Header mach number limit Header vapor velocity limit (m/s) Header liquid velocity limit (m/s) Header momentum limit (kg/m/s2) Header noise limit (dB) Tailpipe mach number limit Tailpipe vapor velocity limit (m/s) Tailpipe liquid velocity limit (m/s) Tailpipe momentum limit (kg/m/s2) Tailpipe noise limit (dB)

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

SolverOptions
Attribute Tag AllScenarios EchoLoops CheckChoke IterationsProperties PresTolProperties MassTol DamperProperties AmbientTemperature AtmosphericPressure WindSpeed LengthMultiplier Mode RatedFlow HeatTransfer Vle Description Fixed text Solver Options Code to indicate which scenarios are calculated 0 Current, 1 All, 2 Selected Are loop calcs echoed 0 = No, 1 = Yes Check for choke flow 0 = No, 1 = Yes Number of iterations in inner (properties) loop Pressure tolerance in properties loop (%) Mass balance tolerance in outer loop (%) Damping factor for inner (properties) loop External temperature (C) Atmospheric pressure (bar a) Wind velocity (m/s) Pipe length multiplication factor Code for calculation mode 0 = Rating, 1 = Design, 2 = Debottleneck Use rated flow for tailpipes 0 = No, 1 = Yes Enable heat transfer calculations 0 = No, 1 = Yes Code for VLE method 0 = Compressible gas, 1 = Peng Robinson, 2 = Soave Redlich Kwong, 3 = Vapor Pressure Enthalpy Code for enthalpy method 0 = Ideal gas, 1 = PengRobinson, 2 = Soave Redlich Kwong, 3 = Lee Kesler Horizontal Code for horizontal pressure drop method 0 = Isothermal gas, 1 = Adiabatic Gas, 2 = Beggs&Brill 3 = Dukler Inclined Code for inclined pressure drop method 0 = Isothermal gas, 1 = Adiabatic Gas, 2 = Beggs&Brill 3 = Dukler Vertical Code for vertical pressure drop method 0 = Isothermal gas, 1 = Adiabatic Gas, 2 = Beggs&Brill 3 = Dukler, 4 = Orkisewski Elements FrictionFactor Choke MinTemp1 Number of elements for two phase calculations Code for friction factor method 0 = Round, 1 = Chen Code for choke calculation method 0 = Simple, 1 = HEM Minimum allowed temperature for carbon steel (C)

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com B File Format The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

331

MinTemp2 MaxTemp1 MaxTemp2 InitPres

Minimum allowed temperature for stainless steel (C) Maximum allowed temperature for carbon steel (C) Maximum allowed temperature for stainless steel (C) Initial pressure for property calculations (bar a)

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

continued Attribute UpdateEstimates PresTolUnitOps PresTolLoops IterationsLoops DamperLoops CalcIgnoredSources IgnoreSizeChange MabpInactive LoopMethod LoopAnalyser UseKineticEnergy KineticEnergyBasis IgnoreSepKineticEnergy Description Update flow estimates from solution 0 = No, 1 = Yes Pressure tolerance for unit operation calculations (%) Pressure tolerance for loop calculations (%) Number of iterations for loop calculations Damping factor for loop calculations Calculate ignored sources as zero flow 0 = No, 1 = Yes Ignore valve flange size change in design calcs 0 = No, 1 = Yes Check MABP for inactive sources 0 = No, 1 = Yes Select loop convergence method 0=Newton Raphson, 1=Broyden, 2=Force Convergent Select analyzer for looped systems 0 = Convergent, 1 = Simultaneous Include kinetic energy 0 = No, 1 = Yes Code for kinetic energy basis 0 = Inlet Pipe Velocity, 1 = Zero velocity Ignore kinetic energy in separators 0 = No, 1 - Yes

SourceData
Attribute ScenarioName SourceName Ignored MassFlow RatedFlow RelievingPressure TemperatureFlag InletTemperatureSpec AllowableBackPressure OutletTemperature VLEMethod Description The name of the scenario (30 chars) The name of the source (30 chars) The ignored flag 0 = not ignored, 1=ignored Mass flow of the source (kg/h) Rated flow of the source (kg/h) Relieving pressure of source (bar a) The code for inlet temperature specification 0 = Actual, 1 = Superheat, 2 = Subcool Inlet temperature value (C) Maximum allowable back pressure (bar a) Outlet temperature (C) Code for VLE method 0 = Model default, 1 = Compressible gas, 2 = Peng Robinson, 3 = Soave Redlich Kwong, 4 = Vapor Pressure FittingLossMethod TwoPhaseCorrectionOption Code for fitting loss calculation 0 = Ignored, 1 = Calculated Code for two phase correction option 0 = No, 1 = Yes

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com B File Format The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

333

SwageMethod CompressibleTransition

Code for size change calculation method 0 = Compressible, 1 = Incompressible, 2 = Transition DP percent of inlet pressure for transition (%)

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

continued Attribute IsothermalDPOption SizingMethod ContingencyFlag HemCd LockRatedFlow LockMABP LockReliefPressure FluidType Description Code for enabling isothermal pressure drop calcs 0 = No, 1 = Yes Code for PSV sizing method 0 = API, 1 = HEM Code for sizing contingency 0 = Operating, 1 = Fire Cd for HEM sizing method Auto update of rated flow 0 = No, 1 = Yes Auto update of MABP 0 = No, 1 = Yes Auto update of relieving pressure 0 = No, 1 = Yes Code for fluid type 0 = HC, 1 = Misc, 2 = Amine, 3 = Alcohol, 4 = Ketone, 5 = Aldehyde, 6 = Ester, 7 = Carbacid, 8 = Halogen, 9 = Nitrile, 10 = Phenol, 11 = Ether MolWt CompositionBasis Fluid mole weight Code for composition input basis 0 = MolWt, 1 = Mole fraction, 2 = Mass fraction

Composition
Attribute ScenarioName SourceName CompositionBasis Fraction ScenarioName SegmentName NoTear Description The name of the scenario (30 chars) The name of the source (30 chars) Code for composition input basis 0 = MolWt, 1 = Mole fraction, 2 = Mass fraction Individual component fraction Name of the scenario (30 chars) Name of the pipe segment (30 chars) Selects whether pipe segment can be a tear object in looped system 0 = No, 1 = Yes FlowEstimate MaxStep MaxFlow MinFlow Estimated flow rate for the pipesegment (kgmole/hr) Maximum change in pipe flow allowed in a single solver iteration (kgmole/hr) Maximum flow allowed for this pipe segment (kgmole/hr) Minimum flow allowed for this pipe segment (kgmole/hr)

PFDLayout
Attribute ItemName XPosition YPosition Description The name of the PFD item (30 chars) The X coordinate of the item The Y coordinate of the item

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com B File Format The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

335

LabelXPosition LabelYPosition Rotation

The X coordinate of the item label The X coordinate of the item label Code for icon rotation 0 = None, 1 = Rotate 90, 2 = Rotate 180, 3 = Rotate 270, 4 = Flip X, 5 = Rotate 90 + Flip Y, 6 = Flip Y, 7 = Rotate 90 + Flip X

PFSummary
Attribute ScenarioName SegmentName MassFlow RatedFlow MoleFlow PressureDrop SourcePressure DPFriction DPElevation DPAcceleration DPFittings Noise FrictionFactor ReynoldsNo EquivalentLength Duty HTC HTCExternal HTCInternal WallTemperature Description The name of the scenario (30 chars) The name of the pipe segment (30 chars) The mass flow (kg/h) The rated flow (kg/h) The mole flow (kgmole/h) Pressure drop over pipe (bar) Pressure of attached source node (bar a) Pressure drop due to friction (bar) Pressure drop due to elevation change (bar) Pressure drop due to acceleration (bar) Pressure drop due to fittings (bar) Noise (dB) Friction factor Reynolds number Equivalent length (m) Heat transferred (kJ/h) Overall heat transfer coefficient (W/m2/C) External heat transfer coefficient (W/m2/C) Internal heat transfer coefficient (W/m2/C) Temperature of pipe wall (C)

EndResults
Attribute ScenarioName SegmentName UpstreamPressure UpstreamTemperature UpstreamVelocity UpstreamMach UpstreamRhoV2 UpstreamEnergy UpstreamFlowRegime DownstreamPressure
3

Description The name of the scenario (30 chars) The name of the pipe segment (30 chars) Pressure at upstream end of pipe (bar a) Temperature at upstream end of pipe (C) Velocity at upstream end of pipe (m/s) Mach number at upstream end of pipe Momentum at upstream end of pipe (kg/m/s2) Energy at upstream end of pipe (kJ/h) Flow regime at upstream end of pipe (20 chars) Pressure at downstream end of pipe (bar a)

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

DownstreamTemperature DownstreamVelocity DownstreamMach DownstreamRhoV2 DownstreamEnergy DownstreamFlowRegime

Temperature at downstream end of pipe (C) Velocity at downstream end of pipe (m/s) Mach number at downstream end of pipe Momentum at downstream end of pipe (kg/m/s2) Energy at downstream end of pipe (kJ/h) Flow regime at downstream end of pipe (20 chars)

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com B File Format The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

337

CompResults
Attribute ScenarioName SegmentName MolWt Fraction Description The name of the scenario (30 chars) The name of the pipe segment (30 chars) The molecular weight of the fluid The mole fraction of each component

StreamProps
Attribute ScenarioName SegmentName UpstreamDensity UpstreamEnthalpy UpstreamEntropy UpstreamHeatCapacity UpstreamMolWt UpstreamSurfaceTension UpstreamThermConductivity UpstreamViscosity UpstreamZFactor DownstreamDensity DownstreamEnthalpy DownstreamEntropy DownstreamHeatCapacity DownstreamMolWt DownstreamSurfaceTension DownstreamThermConductivity DownstreamViscosity DownstreamZFactor Description The name of the scenario (30 chars) The name of the pipe segment (30 chars) Density at upstream end of pipe (kg/m3) Energy at upstream end of pipe (kJ/kgmole) Entropy at upstream end of pipe (kJ/kgmole/K) Heat capacity at upstream end of pipe (kJ/kgmole/K) Mol Wt at upstream end of pipe Surface tension at upstream end of pipe (dyne/cm) Thermal cond. at upstream end of pipe (W/m/K) Viscosity at upstream end of pipe (cP) Z Factor at upstream end of pipe Density at downstream end of pipe (kg/m3) Energy at downstream end of pipe (kJ/kgmole) Entropy at downstream end of pipe (kJ/kgmole/K) Heat capacity at downstream end of pipe (kJ/kgmole/K) Mol Wt at downstream end of pipe Surface tension at downstream end of pipe (dyne/cm) Thermal cond. at downstream end of pipe (W/m/K) Viscosity at downstream end of pipe (cP) Z Factor at downstream end of pipe

PhaseProps
Attribute ScenarioName SegmentName SegmentEnd Phase Density Enthalpy Entropy Description The name of the scenario (30 chars) The name of the pipe segment (30 chars) End of the pipe segment Phase description (25 chars) Density of the phase (kg/m3) Energy of the phase (kJ/kgmole) Entropy of the phase (kJ/kgmole/K)

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Phase Fraction HeatCapacity MolWt SurfaceTension ThermConductivity Viscosity ZFactor

Fraction of the phase Heat capacity of the phase (kJ/kgmole/K) Mol Wt of the phase Surface tension of the phase (dyne/cm) Thermal conductivity of the phase (W/m/K) Viscosity of the phase (cP) Z Factor of the phase

FMT Files Format


The printouts can be customized to a limited extent using a series of ASCII text files with the extension .fmt. These files may be edited using any ASCII text editor such as the NOTEPAD application distributed with Microsoft Windows. The default .fmt files for each printed report are:
Report Component Data Component Database Compositions Fittings Database Messages Node Data Pipes Data Physical Properties Pipe Schedule Database Pressure/Flow Summary Scenarios Data Scenarios Summary Source Data .fmt file Comps.fmt DbComps.fmt MoleFrac.fmt DbFittings.fmt Messages.fmt Node.fmt Pipes.fmt Properties.fmt DbSchedules.fmt Summary.fmt Scenarios.fmt ScenSum.fmt Sources.fmt

By default, these files are located in the Flare System Analyzer program directory. You can change the location and .fmt file for each report on the Reports tab on the Preferences Editor view. Fig B.1

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com B File Format The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

339

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

These files confirm to the following format, here shown for part of the DbSchedules.fmt file.
Variable version 1 5 6 Arial schedule,20.0,0 nominal,20.0,1 internal,20.0,1 wall,20.0,1 group,20.0,1 Description File format version. DO NOT CHANGE. Number of variables to display Font Size (Point) Font Name Variable Name,width (mm), repeat flag (0 = All panes, 1 = Once only), extend flag (0 = no, 1 = yes), alignment flag (0 = left, 1 = center, 2 = right)

The following defines which variable may be printed with each report:

DbSchedules.fmt

Properties.fmt

DbFittings.fmt

MoleFracs.fmt

Scenarios.fmt

Summary.fmt

Messages.fmt

ambient angle backpres basis calcloss

Ambient Temperature Angle To Horizontal Back Pressure Composition Basis Autocalculated Fittings Loss Equation Node Run, Branch and Tail Segment Pipe Class Mole Fractions Number Of Items Damping Factor Standard Liquid Density x x x x x

x x

calculations

class comps connections count damp density

x x

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com B File Format The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

341

Sources.fmt

Comps.fmt

Nodes.fmt

Pipes.fmt

Variable Name

Variable Description

ScenSum.fmt

DbComps.fmt

densitydown

Downstream Density

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

continued DbSchedules.fmt

Properties.fmt

DbFittings.fmt

MoleFracs.fmt

Scenarios.fmt

Summary.fmt

Messages.fmt

densityup desc dsn duty elevation energy energydown energyup enthalpy enthalpydow n enthalpyup entropy entropydown entropyup equivlength factor fitloss fittingsa fittingsb fittingsuse flange flow fractiondown fractionup frictionfracto

Upstream Density Description Downstream Node Heat Loss Elevation Change Energy Downstream Energy Flow Upstream Energy Flow Enthalpy Downstream Enthalpy Upstream Enthalpy Entropy Downstream Entropy Upstream Entropy Equivalent Length Rated Flow factor Fittings Loss Equation Fitting Loss A Fitting Loss B Flange Diameter Mass flow Downstream Phase Fraction Upstream Phase Fraction Friction Factor x x x x x x

x x x x x x x x x

x x x

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com B File Format The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

343

Sources.fmt

Comps.fmt

Nodes.fmt

Pipes.fmt

Variable Name

Variable Description

ScenSum.fmt

DbComps.fmt

r group headmach Item Group Header Mach No. x x

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

continued DbSchedules.fmt

Properties.fmt

DbFittings.fmt

MoleFracs.fmt

Scenarios.fmt

Summary.fmt

Messages.fmt

headvelvap headvelliq headrhov2 headnoise heatcapdown heatcapup hia hib hic hid hie hif htc htcoverall htcexternal htcinternal id ignored insname insthick insconductivi ty internal length

Header Vapor Velocity Header Liquid Velocity Header Rho V2 Header Noise Downstream Heat Capacity Upstream Heat Capacity Enthalpy A Coefficient Enthalpy B Coefficient Enthalpy C Coefficient Enthalpy D Coefficient Enthalpy E Coefficient Enthalpy F Coefficient Heat Transfer Coefficient Overall HTC External HTC Internal HTC Item ID Item Ignored Insulation Description Insulation Thickness Insulation Conductivity Internal Diameter Segment Length x x x x x x x x x x x x x x x x x x x x x x x x x x

x x x x

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com B File Format The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

345

Sources.fmt

Comps.fmt

Nodes.fmt

Pipes.fmt

Variable Name

Variable Description

ScenSum.fmt

DbComps.fmt

lmultiply location machdown

Length Multiplier Segment Location Downstream Mach Number

x x x

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

continued DbSchedules.fmt

Properties.fmt

DbFittings.fmt

MoleFracs.fmt

Scenarios.fmt

Summary.fmt

Messages.fmt

machup massflow material methoddamp ing methoddp methodelem ents methodfrictio n methodfitlos methodhord p

Upstream Mach Number Mass Flow Material Of Construction Damping Factor Pressure Drop Method Twp Phase Elements Friction Factor Fittings Loss Method Horizontal 2 Phase Pressure Drop Method Inclined Pressure Drop Vertical 2 Phase Pressure Drop Method VLE method Molar Flow Source Molar Flow Molecular Weight Downstream Molecular Weight Upstream Molecular Weight Text Message Fittings Equation Multiplier x x x x x x x x x x

x x x

methodincdp methodverd p

x x

methodvle molarflow moleflow molwt molwtdown

x x

molwtup

msg multiply

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com B File Format The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

347

Sources.fmt

Comps.fmt

Nodes.fmt

Pipes.fmt

Variable Name

Variable Description

ScenSum.fmt

DbComps.fmt

name nbp node noise

Item Name Normal Boiling Point Node Noise continued

x x

x x

x x

Properties.fmt

DbFittings.fmt

MoleFracs.fmt

DbSchedules.fmt

Messages.fmt

Scenarios.fmt

Summary.fmt

Comps.fmt

Nodes.fmt

nominal number offmaximum offminimum offmultiply offrate offset

Nominal Pipe Diameter Index Number Maximum Flow Offtake Minimum Flow Offtake Offtake Flow Multiplier Offtake Flow Offset Fittings Equation Offset Acentric Factor SRK Acentric Factor Critical Pressure Phase Label Source Plant Location Static Source Back Pressure Allowable Back Pressure Downstream Static Pressure Pressure Drop Static Pipe Friction Loss Static Pipe Acceleration x x x x x x x x

Pipes.fmt

omega omegasrk pc phase plant pressource presallow presdown

x x x

presdrop presdropfrict ion presdropacc eleration

x x x

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Sources.fmt

Variable Name

Variable Description

DbComps.fmt

ScenSum.fmt

Loss presdropelev ation presdropfitti ngs presin presup Static Pipe Elevation Loss Static Pipe Fittings Loss Inlet Pressure Upstream Static Pressure Property Description Rated Mass Flow Literature Reference x x x x x

property ratedflow refer

x x

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com B File Format The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

349

continued DbSchedules.fmt

Properties.fmt

DbFittings.fmt

MoleFracs.fmt

Scenarios.fmt

Summary.fmt

Messages.fmt

regime resize reynolds rhov2up rhov2down roughness scenario schedule seg1 seg2 seg3 separate si source status surftendn

Flow Regime Resizable Flag Reynolds Number Upstream Rho V2 Downstream Rho V2 Wall roughness Scenario Name Pipe Schedule Node Run Segment Node Branch Segment Node Tail Segment Separator Flag Entropy Coefficient Source Name Ignored Status Flag Downstream Surface Tension Upstream Surface Tension Tailpipe Mach No. Tailpipe Noise Tailpipe Flag Tailpipe Rho V2 Tailpipe Liquid Velocity Tailpipe Vapor x x x x x x x x x x

x x x x

surftenup

tailmach tailnoise tailpipe tailrhov2 tailvelliq tailvelvap


3

x x x x x

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Sources.fmt

Comps.fmt

Nodes.fmt

Pipes.fmt

Variable Name

Variable Description

ScenSum.fmt

DbComps.fmt

Velocity tc temp tempcalc Critical Temperature Temperature Inlet Temperature Calculations x x x

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com B File Format The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

351

continued DbSchedules.fmt

Properties.fmt

DbFittings.fmt

MoleFracs.fmt

Scenarios.fmt

Summary.fmt

Messages.fmt

tempdown tempout tempspec

Downstream Temperature Outlet Temperature Inlet Temperature Specification Upstream Temperature Downstream Thermal Conductivity Upstream Thermal Conductivity Item Type Upstream Node Source Vapor Fraction Critical volume Characteristic Volume Downstream Velocity Upstream Velocity Viscosity A Coefficient Viscosity B Coefficient Downstream Viscosity Upstream Viscosity Pipe volume Wall Thickness Watson Characterisati on Parameter x x x x x x x x x x x x x x x x x x x x

x x x

tempup thermconddn

thermcondup

type usn vapourfrac vc vchar veldn velup visca viscb viscdown viscup volume wall watson

x x

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Sources.fmt

Comps.fmt

Nodes.fmt

Pipes.fmt

Variable Name

Variable Description

ScenSum.fmt

DbComps.fmt

wind zfactordown

Wind Velocity Downstream Compressibilit y Factor Upstream Compressibilit y Factor

x x

zfactorup

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com B File Format The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

353

C References

1 2 3 4 5 6 7

GPSA Engineering Data Book. chemical Engineering Volume 1, 2nd Edition, J. M Coulson and J. F. Richardson, Pergamon Press. Viscosity of Gases And Mixtures, I. F. Golubev, National Technical Information Services, TT7050022, 1959. "Chemical Process Computations 1, Chemical Engineering-Data Processing", Raman, Raghu, Elsevier Applied Science Publishers Ltd, 1985. "Journal Of Physics", 3 ,263 , D. J. Berthalot. "Technical Data Book-Petroleum Refining", American Petroleum Institute, 1977. Ely, J.F. and Hanley, H.J.M., "A Computer Program for the Prediction of Viscosity and Thermal Conductivity in Hydrocarbon Mixtures", NBS Technical Note 1039 (1983). Hankinson, R.W., and Thompson, G.H., AIChE J., 25, 653 (1979). Beggs, H.D., and Brill, J.P., "A Study of Two-Phase Flow in Inclined Pipes", J. Petrol. Technol., p. 607, May (1973).

8 9

10 Gas Conditioning and Processing, Volume 3, Robert N. Maddox and Larry L. Lilly, 1982 by Campbell Petroleum Series (second edition, 1990). 11 Orkiszewski, J., Journal of Petroleum Technology, B29-B38, June, 1967. 12 Gas Conditioning and Processing, Volume 3, Robert N. Maddox and Larry L. Lilly, 1982 by Campbell Petroleum Series (second edition, 1990). 13 API Technical Data Book - Volume 1 , 1983, American Petroleum Institute. 14 Hankinson, R.W. and Thompson, G.H., A.I.Ch.E. Journal, 25, No. 4, p.653 (1979). 15 Reid, R.C., Prausnitz, J.M., Poling, B.E., "The Properties of Gases &Liquids", McGraw-Hill, Inc., 1987. 16 Ely, J.F. and Hanly, H.J.M., "A Computer Program for the Prediction of Viscosity and Thermal Conductivity in Hydrocarbon Mixtures", NBS Technical Note 1039. 17 Pausnitz, J.M., Lichtenthaler, R.N., Azevedo, E.G., "Molecular Thermodynamics of Fluid Phase Equilibria", 2nd. Ed., McGraw-Hill, Inc. 1986. 18 Twu, C.H., IEC. Proc Des & Dev, 24, p. 1287 (1985).

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

19 Woelfin, W., "Viscosity of Crude-Oil Emulsions", presented at the spring meeting, Pacific Coast District, Division of Production, Los Angeles, Calif., Mar. 10, 1942. 20 Gambill, W.R., Chem Eng., March 9, 1959. 21 Chen, N.H., "An Explicit Equation for Friction Factor in Pipe", Ind. Eng. Chem. Fund., 18, 296, 1979. 22 API Recommended Practice 520, Sizing, Selection, and Installation of Pressure - Relieving Devices in Refineries, Part I, 6th. Ed., American Petroleum Institute, March, 1993 23 API Recommended Practice 521, Guide for Pressure-Relieving and Depressuring Systems, 3rd. Ed., American Petroleum Institute, November, 1990 24 Leung, J.C., "Easily Size Relief Devices and Piping for Two-Phase Flow", Chem. Eng. Prog., p. 28, December, 1996. 25 Miller, D.M., "Internal Flow Systems", 2nd. Ed., BHR Group Limited, 1990. 26 Flow of Fluids Through Valves, Fittings and Pipe Crane Technical Paper 410M. 1988. 27 PIPE 3, Single and Two-Phase Pressure Drop Calculations in Pipeline Systems, HTFS Design Report 38, 1996.

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com C References The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

355

D Glossary of Terms

Adiabatic Flow
Adiabatic flow is the constant enthalpy flow of a fluid in a pipe.

Choked Flow
The velocity of a fluid in a pipe of constant cross sectional area cannot exceed the sonic velocity of the fluid. If the flow of fluid in a pipe is great enough that the sonic velocity is reached, then a pressure discontinuity is seen at the exit end of the pipe.

Critical Pressure
The critical pressure is the pressure at which the vapor density and liquid density of a substance may be the same.

Critical Temperature
The critical temperature is the temperature at which the vapor density and liquid density of a substance may be the same.

Dongle
See Security Device.

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Equivalent Length
The equivalent length of a pipe is the straight length of pipe which would create the same pressure drop as the actual pipe length plus losses due to bends and fittings.

Isothermal Flow
Isothermal flow is the constant temperature flow of a fluid in a pipe. In general when the pressure of a gas reduces, there is a small change in temperature. This assumption leads to a small error in the calculated pressure profile. In practice for pipes of length at least 1000 diameters, this difference does not exceed 5% and in fact never exceeds 20%.

MABP
The Maximum Allowable Back Pressure on a relief device is the maximum pressure that can exist at the outlet of the device without affecting the capacity of the device. In general the MABP for a conventional pressure relief valve should not exceed 10% of the set pressure at 10% overpressure. In general the MABP for a balanced pressure relief valve should not exceed 40% of the set pressure at 10% overpressure.

Mach Number
Mach number is the ratio of the fluid velocity to the sonic velocity in the fluid.

Node
Nodes define the connection points between pipes, and pipes with sources. Each node must have a unique name.

Reduced Pressure
Reduced pressure is the ratio of the absolute pressure to the critical pressure of the fluid.

www.cadfamily.comTerms EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com D Glossary of The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

357

Reduced Temperature
Reduced temperature is the ratio of the absolute temperature to the critical temperature of the fluid.

Scenario
A scenario represents a set of flow and compositional data for all sources in the system. It may also represent a particular set of limiting operating conditions.

Schedule
The schedule of a pipe defines a standard thickness for a given nominal pipe size. In general, flare and vent systems are constructed from schedule 40 or 80 pipe.

Security Device
The hardware device that is connected to the parallel port of the computer.

Source
A source refers to a fluid entering the piping network regardless of the type of pipe fitting from which it enters. the fluid is defined in terms of its composition, mass flowrate, pressure and temperature.

Static Pressure
The pressure acting equally in all directions at a point in the fluid. Physical properties are calculated at the static pressure condition.

Tailpipe
The section of pipe between the discharge flange of the source valve and the main collection header is generally referred to as a tailpipe.

Total Pressure
The sum of the static and velocity pressures.
3

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Velocity Pressure
Given by

U 2 , also called the kinematic pressure. 2

www.cadfamily.comTerms EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com D Glossary of The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

359

Index

A Acentric Factor 248, 252 Adiabatic Flow definition 288 Automation 194 B Berthalot Equation 249 Toolbar 11 C Calculation Options Editor 93 General tab 93 Methods tab 96 Warnings tab 98 Calculation Problems group 99 Sizing Status group 99 Calculations 93 Case opening an existing 24 saving a 25 Case Description View 21 Changing Column Order 13 Chen Equation 233 Choked Flow definition 288 Column Order changing 13 Column Width changing 13 Comma Separated Values 155 Component list 26 selecting 26
3

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

matching name string 26 selection filter 27 sorting 31 swapping 31 type 26 Component Editor View estimating unknown properties 30 Component Manager View 26 Components 26 Control Valve 73 Control Valve Editor Connections tab 73, 80 COSTALD Calculations 249 Creating and Saving Cases 21 Critical Pressure definition 288 Critical Temperature definition 288 CSV See Comma Separated Values 155 D Darcy Friction Factor 233 Data sources 115 viewing 113 Database Editor component 111 fittings 111 pipe schedule 109 Database Features adding/deleting data 108 selection filter 108 Dongle

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com Index The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

361

See Security Device 288 E Equation Berthalot 249 Chen 233 Round 232 SRK 248 Equivalent Length definition 289 Export Wizard 170 Export Data Layouts 170 Step 1 171 Step 2 173 Step 3 174 Step 4 177 Using 170 F Flare Tip Editor Calculations tab 89, 91 Flow laminar 233 mist 238 transition 233, 236, 238 turbulent 232 Flow Bleed Editor Connections tab 58 FMT Files 156 Froude Number 234 H Horizontal Separator Editor Connections tab 60 Hysim 154 I Import Wizard Importing Source Data 165 Step 1 158 Step 3 160 Step 4 163 Using 158 Import/Export Examples 179 Importing ASCII text files 165 from HYSIM 165 HYSYS source data 169 Importing HYSYS Source Data 169 Interface 7
3

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

Terminology 8 Tool Bar 11 Isothermal Flow definition 289 M MABP definition 289 Mach Number definition 289 Moody Friction Factor 232 Multiple Editing 52 N Network rating an existing 104 Node definition 289 Node Manager 53 Node Types flare tip 88 flow bleed 58 sources 73 tee 66 vertical separator 70 Nodes 53 Noise 255 acoustical efficiency 256 O Orifice Plate Editor Connections tab 63 P Password setting the 109 PFD 144 changing view options 153 connecting objects 151 icons 145 installing objects 149 manipulating the 151 moving objects 152 object inspection 146 printing 152 regenerate 152 saving 152 selecting objects 151 method one 151 method two 151

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com Index The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

363

toolbar 146 unselecting objects 151 view 146 Physical Properties 249 mixing rules 251 thermal conductivity 251 vapour density 249 vapour viscosity 250 Golubev method 250 Physical Prperties enthalpy 252 Equations of State 253 ideal gas 252 Pipe multiple editing 52 Pipe Network 41 Pipe Tools pipe class editor 52 Preferences Editor General tab 15 Import tab 19 Reports tab 17 Pressure Drop 231 Printing 155 location-specific 157 Printing, Importing and Exporting 153 PVT Relationship 247 R Reduced Pressure definition 289 Reduced Temperature definition 289 Refresh Source Temperatures 88 Results messages 117 physical properties 121 viewing 113 Round Equation 232 S Scenario definition 289 Scenario Editor General tab 36 Sources tab 38 Scenario Management 33 Scenario Manager View 35 Scenario Tools 40 Scenarios adding single source 40
3

Flare System Analyzer

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

adding/editing 36 General tab 36 Sources tab 37 Schedule definition 289 Security Device definition 290 Source definition 290 Source Tools 88 adding single source scenarios 88 updating downstream temperatures 88 Source Types control valve 73 SRK Equation 248 SRK Equation of State 253 Status Bar 12 T Tab Separated Values 155 Terminology 8 Tool Bar 11 TSV See Tab Separated Values 155 Two-Phase Pressure Drop 233 Beggs and Brill 233 Dukler method 235 Orkiszewski method 236 V Vaour Phase Pressure Drop methods 231 Vapour-Liquid Equilibrium 247 compressible gas 247 Peng Robinson 249 Soave Redlich Kwong 248 vapour pressure 247 Vertical Separator Editor Connections tab 70 Viewing Data and Results 113

www.cadfamily.com EMail:cadserv21@hotmail.com Index The document is for study only,if tort to your rights,please inform us,we will delete

365

Você também pode gostar